gdb:
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @copying
47 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
48 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
49 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
50
51 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
52 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
53 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
54 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
55 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
56 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
57
58 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
59 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
60 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
61 @end copying
62
63 @ifnottex
64 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
65
66 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
67 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
68 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
69 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
70 @end ifset
71 Version @value{GDBVN}.
72
73 @insertcopying
74 @end ifnottex
75
76 @titlepage
77 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
82 @sp 1
83 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
84 @end ifset
85 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
86 @page
87 @tex
88 {\parskip=0pt
89 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
90 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
91 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
92 }
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
97 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
98 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
99 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
100
101 @insertcopying
102 @page
103 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
104 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
105 software in general. We will miss him.
106 @end titlepage
107 @page
108
109 @ifnottex
110 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
111
112 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
113
114 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
115
116 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
117 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
118 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
119 @end ifset
120 Version @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
137 * Stack:: Examining the stack
138 * Source:: Examining source files
139 * Data:: Examining data
140 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
141 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
142 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
143
144 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
145
146 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
147 * Altering:: Altering execution
148 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
149 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
150 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
151 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
152 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
153 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
154 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
155 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
156 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
157 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
158 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
159
160 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
161
162 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
163 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
164 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
165 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
166 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
167 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
168 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
169 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
170 @value{GDBN}
171 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
172 the operating system
173 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
174 how you can copy and share GDB
175 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
176 * Index:: Index
177 @end menu
178
179 @end ifnottex
180
181 @contents
182
183 @node Summary
184 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
185
186 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
187 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
188 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
189
190 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
191 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
192
193 @itemize @bullet
194 @item
195 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
196
197 @item
198 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
199
200 @item
201 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
202
203 @item
204 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
205 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
206 @end itemize
207
208 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
209 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
210 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
211
212 @cindex Modula-2
213 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
214 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
215
216 @cindex Pascal
217 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
218 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
219 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
220 syntax.
221
222 @cindex Fortran
223 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
224 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
225 underscore.
226
227 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
228 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
229
230 @menu
231 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
232 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
233 @end menu
234
235 @node Free Software
236 @unnumberedsec Free Software
237
238 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
239 General Public License
240 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
241 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
242 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
243 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
244 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
245 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
246
247 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
248 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
249 from anyone else.
250
251 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
252
253 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
254 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
255 include with the free software. Many of our most important
256 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
257 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
258 when an important free software package does not come with a free
259 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
260 gaps today.
261
262 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
263 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
264 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
265 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
266 them from the free software world.
267
268 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
269 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
270 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
271 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
272 contract to make it non-free.
273
274 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
275 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
276 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
277 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
278 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
279 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
280 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
281
282 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
283 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
284 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
285 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
286
287 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
288 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
289 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
290 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
291 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
292 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
293 community.
294
295 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
296 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
297 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
298 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
299 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
300 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
301 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
302 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
303 of the manual.
304
305 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
306 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
307 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
308 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
309 manual to replace it.
310
311 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
312 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
313 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
314 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
315 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
316 the free software community.
317
318 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
319 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
320 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
321 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
322 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
323 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
324 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
325 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
326 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
327
328 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
329 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
330 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
331 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
332 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
333 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
334 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
335 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
336
337 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
338 published by other publishers, at
339 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
340
341 @node Contributors
342 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
343
344 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
345 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
346 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
347 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
348 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
349 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
350 blow-by-blow account.
351
352 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
353
354 @quotation
355 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
356 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
357 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
358 @end quotation
359
360 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
361 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
362 releases:
363 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
364 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
365 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
366 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
367 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
368 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
369 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
370 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
371 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
372
373 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
374 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
375
376 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
377 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
378 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
379 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
380 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
381
382 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
383 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
384 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
385
386 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
387 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
388
389 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
390
391 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
392 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
393 support.
394 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
395 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
396 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
397 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
398 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
399 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
400 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
401 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
402 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
403 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
404 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
405 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
406 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
407 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
408 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
409 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
410
411 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
412
413 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
414 libraries.
415
416 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
417 about several machine instruction sets.
418
419 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
420 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
421 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
422 and RDI targets, respectively.
423
424 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
425 command-line editing and command history.
426
427 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
428 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
429
430 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
431 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
432 symbols.
433
434 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
435 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
436
437 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
438
439 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
440 processors.
441
442 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
443
444 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
445
446 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
447
448 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
449 watchpoints.
450
451 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
452
453 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
454
455 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
456 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
457
458 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
459 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
460 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
461 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
462 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
463 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
464 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
465
466 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
467 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
468
469 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
470 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
471 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
472 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
473 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
474 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
475 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
476 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
477 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
478 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
479 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
480 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
481 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
482 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
483 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
484
485 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
486 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
487
488 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
489 Hat.
490
491 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
492 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
493 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
494 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
495 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
496 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
497
498 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
499 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
500 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
501 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
502 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
503 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
504 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
505 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
506 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
507 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
508 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
509 Weigand.
510
511 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
512 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
513 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
514 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
515
516 @node Sample Session
517 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
518
519 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
520 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
521 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
522
523 @iftex
524 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
525 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
526 @end iftex
527
528 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
529 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
530
531 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
532 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
533 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
534 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
535 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
536 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
537 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
538 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
539 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
540
541 @smallexample
542 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
543 $ @b{./m4}
544 @b{define(foo,0000)}
545
546 @b{foo}
547 0000
548 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
549
550 @b{bar}
551 0000
552 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
553
554 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
555 @b{baz}
556 @b{Ctrl-d}
557 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
558 @end smallexample
559
560 @noindent
561 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
562
563 @smallexample
564 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
565 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
566 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
567 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
568 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
569 the conditions.
570 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
571 for details.
572
573 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
574 (@value{GDBP})
575 @end smallexample
576
577 @noindent
578 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
579 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
580 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
581 that examples fit in this manual.
582
583 @smallexample
584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
585 @end smallexample
586
587 @noindent
588 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
589 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
590 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
591 @code{break} command.
592
593 @smallexample
594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
595 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
600 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
601 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
602
603 @smallexample
604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
605 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
606 @b{define(foo,0000)}
607
608 @b{foo}
609 0000
610 @end smallexample
611
612 @noindent
613 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
614 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
615 context where it stops.
616
617 @smallexample
618 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
619
620 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
621 at builtin.c:879
622 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
627 the next line of the current function.
628
629 @smallexample
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
632 : nil,
633 @end smallexample
634
635 @noindent
636 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
637 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
638 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
639 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
643 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
644 at input.c:530
645 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
646 @end smallexample
647
648 @noindent
649 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
650 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
651 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
652 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
653 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
654 stack frame for each active subroutine.
655
656 @smallexample
657 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
658 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
659 at input.c:530
660 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
661 at builtin.c:882
662 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
663 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
664 at macro.c:71
665 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
666 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
671 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
672 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
678 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
679 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
682 : xstrdup(rq);
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
684 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
685 @end smallexample
686
687 @noindent
688 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
689 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
690 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
691 (@code{print}) to see their values.
692
693 @smallexample
694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
695 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
697 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
698 @end smallexample
699
700 @noindent
701 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
702 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
703 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
704
705 @smallexample
706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
707 533 xfree(rquote);
708 534
709 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
710 : xstrdup (lq);
711 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
712 : xstrdup (rq);
713 537
714 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
715 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
716 540 @}
717 541
718 542 void
719 @end smallexample
720
721 @noindent
722 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
723 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
724
725 @smallexample
726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
727 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
729 540 @}
730 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
731 $3 = 9
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
733 $4 = 7
734 @end smallexample
735
736 @noindent
737 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
738 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
739 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
740 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
741 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
742 assignments.
743
744 @smallexample
745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
746 $5 = 7
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
748 $6 = 9
749 @end smallexample
750
751 @noindent
752 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
753 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
754 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
755 example that caused trouble initially:
756
757 @smallexample
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
759 Continuing.
760
761 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
762
763 baz
764 0000
765 @end smallexample
766
767 @noindent
768 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
769 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
770 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
771
772 @smallexample
773 @b{Ctrl-d}
774 Program exited normally.
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @noindent
778 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
779 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
780 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
784 @end smallexample
785
786 @node Invocation
787 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
788
789 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
790 The essentials are:
791 @itemize @bullet
792 @item
793 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
794 @item
795 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
796 @end itemize
797
798 @menu
799 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
800 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
801 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
802 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
803 @end menu
804
805 @node Invoking GDB
806 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
807
808 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
809 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
810
811 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
812 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
813
814 The command-line options described here are designed
815 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
816 options may effectively be unavailable.
817
818 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
819 specifying an executable program:
820
821 @smallexample
822 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
823 @end smallexample
824
825 @noindent
826 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
827 specified:
828
829 @smallexample
830 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
831 @end smallexample
832
833 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
834 to debug a running process:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
838 @end smallexample
839
840 @noindent
841 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
842 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
843
844 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
845 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
846 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
847 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
848 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
849
850 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
851 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
852 option processing.
853 @smallexample
854 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
855 @end smallexample
856 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
857 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
858
859 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
860 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} -silent
864 @end smallexample
865
866 @noindent
867 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
868 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
869
870 @noindent
871 Type
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} -help
875 @end smallexample
876
877 @noindent
878 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
879 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
880
881 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
882 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
883 @samp{-x} option is used.
884
885
886 @menu
887 * File Options:: Choosing files
888 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
889 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
890 @end menu
891
892 @node File Options
893 @subsection Choosing Files
894
895 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
896 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
897 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
898 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
899 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
900 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
901 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
902 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
903 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
904 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
905 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
906 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
907 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
908
909 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
910 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
911 argument and ignore it.
912
913 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
914 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
915 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
916 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
917 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
918
919 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
920 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
921 @c it.
922
923 @table @code
924 @item -symbols @var{file}
925 @itemx -s @var{file}
926 @cindex @code{--symbols}
927 @cindex @code{-s}
928 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
929
930 @item -exec @var{file}
931 @itemx -e @var{file}
932 @cindex @code{--exec}
933 @cindex @code{-e}
934 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
935 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
936
937 @item -se @var{file}
938 @cindex @code{--se}
939 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
940 file.
941
942 @item -core @var{file}
943 @itemx -c @var{file}
944 @cindex @code{--core}
945 @cindex @code{-c}
946 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
947
948 @item -pid @var{number}
949 @itemx -p @var{number}
950 @cindex @code{--pid}
951 @cindex @code{-p}
952 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
953
954 @item -command @var{file}
955 @itemx -x @var{file}
956 @cindex @code{--command}
957 @cindex @code{-x}
958 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
959 Files,, Command files}.
960
961 @item -eval-command @var{command}
962 @itemx -ex @var{command}
963 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
964 @cindex @code{-ex}
965 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
966
967 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
968 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
969
970 @smallexample
971 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
972 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
973 @end smallexample
974
975 @item -directory @var{directory}
976 @itemx -d @var{directory}
977 @cindex @code{--directory}
978 @cindex @code{-d}
979 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
980
981 @item -r
982 @itemx -readnow
983 @cindex @code{--readnow}
984 @cindex @code{-r}
985 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
986 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
987 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
988
989 @end table
990
991 @node Mode Options
992 @subsection Choosing Modes
993
994 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
995 batch mode or quiet mode.
996
997 @table @code
998 @item -nx
999 @itemx -n
1000 @cindex @code{--nx}
1001 @cindex @code{-n}
1002 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1003 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1004 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1005 Files}.
1006
1007 @item -quiet
1008 @itemx -silent
1009 @itemx -q
1010 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1011 @cindex @code{--silent}
1012 @cindex @code{-q}
1013 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1014 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1015
1016 @item -batch
1017 @cindex @code{--batch}
1018 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1019 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1020 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1021 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1022 in the command files.
1023
1024 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1025 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1026 make this more useful, the message
1027
1028 @smallexample
1029 Program exited normally.
1030 @end smallexample
1031
1032 @noindent
1033 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1034 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1035 mode.
1036
1037 @item -batch-silent
1038 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1039 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1040 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1041 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1042 for an interactive session.
1043
1044 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1045 messages, for example.
1046
1047 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1048 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1049
1050 @item -return-child-result
1051 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1052 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1053 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1054
1055 @itemize @bullet
1056 @item
1057 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1058 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1059 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1060 @item
1061 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1062 @item
1063 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1064 the exit code will be -1.
1065 @end itemize
1066
1067 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1068 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1069 interface.
1070
1071 @item -nowindows
1072 @itemx -nw
1073 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1074 @cindex @code{-nw}
1075 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1076 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1077 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1078
1079 @item -windows
1080 @itemx -w
1081 @cindex @code{--windows}
1082 @cindex @code{-w}
1083 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1084 used if possible.
1085
1086 @item -cd @var{directory}
1087 @cindex @code{--cd}
1088 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1089 instead of the current directory.
1090
1091 @item -fullname
1092 @itemx -f
1093 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1094 @cindex @code{-f}
1095 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1096 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1097 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1098 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1099 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1100 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1101 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1102 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1103 frame.
1104
1105 @item -epoch
1106 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1107 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1108 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1109 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1110 separate window.
1111
1112 @item -annotate @var{level}
1113 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1114 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1115 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1116 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1117 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1118 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1119 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1120 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1121 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1122
1123 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1124 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1125
1126 @item --args
1127 @cindex @code{--args}
1128 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1129 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1130 This option stops option processing.
1131
1132 @item -baud @var{bps}
1133 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1134 @cindex @code{--baud}
1135 @cindex @code{-b}
1136 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1137 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1138
1139 @item -l @var{timeout}
1140 @cindex @code{-l}
1141 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1142 for remote debugging.
1143
1144 @item -tty @var{device}
1145 @itemx -t @var{device}
1146 @cindex @code{--tty}
1147 @cindex @code{-t}
1148 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1149 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1150
1151 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1152 @item -tui
1153 @cindex @code{--tui}
1154 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1155 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1156 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1157 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1158 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1159 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1160 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1161
1162 @c @item -xdb
1163 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1164 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1165 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1166 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1167 @c systems.
1168
1169 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1170 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1171 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1172 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1173 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1174 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1175
1176 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1177 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1178 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1179 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1180 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1181 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1182
1183 @item -write
1184 @cindex @code{--write}
1185 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1186 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1187 (@pxref{Patching}).
1188
1189 @item -statistics
1190 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1191 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1192 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1193
1194 @item -version
1195 @cindex @code{--version}
1196 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1197 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1198
1199 @end table
1200
1201 @node Startup
1202 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1203 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1204
1205 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1206
1207 @enumerate
1208 @item
1209 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1210 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1211
1212 @item
1213 @cindex init file
1214 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1215 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1216 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1217 that file.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1221 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1222 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1223 that file.
1224
1225 @item
1226 Processes command line options and operands.
1227
1228 @item
1229 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1230 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1231 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1232 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1233 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1234 @value{GDBN}.
1235
1236 @item
1237 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1238 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1239
1240 @item
1241 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1242 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1243 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1244 @end enumerate
1245
1246 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1247 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1248 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1249 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1250 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1251 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1252
1253 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1254 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1255
1256 @cindex init file name
1257 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1258 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1259 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1260 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1261 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1262 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1263 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1264 the file to the standard name.
1265
1266
1267 @node Quitting GDB
1268 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1269 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1270 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1271
1272 @table @code
1273 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1274 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1275 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1276 @itemx q
1277 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1278 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1279 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1280 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1281 error code.
1282 @end table
1283
1284 @cindex interrupt
1285 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1286 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1287 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1288 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1289 until a time when it is safe.
1290
1291 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1292 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1293 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1294
1295 @node Shell Commands
1296 @section Shell Commands
1297
1298 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1299 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1300 just use the @code{shell} command.
1301
1302 @table @code
1303 @kindex shell
1304 @cindex shell escape
1305 @item shell @var{command string}
1306 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1307 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1308 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1309 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1310 @end table
1311
1312 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1313 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1314 @value{GDBN}:
1315
1316 @table @code
1317 @kindex make
1318 @cindex calling make
1319 @item make @var{make-args}
1320 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1321 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1322 @end table
1323
1324 @node Logging Output
1325 @section Logging Output
1326 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1327 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1328
1329 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1330 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1331
1332 @table @code
1333 @kindex set logging
1334 @item set logging on
1335 Enable logging.
1336 @item set logging off
1337 Disable logging.
1338 @cindex logging file name
1339 @item set logging file @var{file}
1340 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1341 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1342 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1343 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1344 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1345 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1346 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1347 @kindex show logging
1348 @item show logging
1349 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1350 @end table
1351
1352 @node Commands
1353 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1354
1355 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1356 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1357 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1358 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1359 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1360
1361 @menu
1362 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1363 * Completion:: Command completion
1364 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1365 @end menu
1366
1367 @node Command Syntax
1368 @section Command Syntax
1369
1370 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1371 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1372 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1373 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1374 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1375 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1376
1377 @cindex abbreviation
1378 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1379 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1380 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1381 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1382 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1383 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1384 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1385
1386 @cindex repeating commands
1387 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1388 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1389 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1390 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1391 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1392 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1393 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1394
1395 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1396 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1397 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1398
1399 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1400 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1401 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1402 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1403 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1404
1405 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1406 @cindex comment
1407 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1408 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1409 Files,,Command Files}).
1410
1411 @cindex repeating command sequences
1412 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1413 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1414 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1415 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1416 for editing.
1417
1418 @node Completion
1419 @section Command Completion
1420
1421 @cindex completion
1422 @cindex word completion
1423 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1424 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1425 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1426 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1427
1428 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1429 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1430 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1431 enter it). For example, if you type
1432
1433 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1434 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1435 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1436 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1437 @smallexample
1438 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1439 @end smallexample
1440
1441 @noindent
1442 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1443 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1444
1445 @smallexample
1446 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1447 @end smallexample
1448
1449 @noindent
1450 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1451 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1452 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1453 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1454 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1455 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1456
1457 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1458 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1459 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1460 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1461 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1462 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1463 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1464 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1465 example:
1466
1467 @smallexample
1468 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1469 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1470 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1471 make_abs_section make_function_type
1472 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1473 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1474 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1475 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1476 @end smallexample
1477
1478 @noindent
1479 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1480 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1481 command.
1482
1483 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1484 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1485 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1486 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1487 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1488
1489 @cindex quotes in commands
1490 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1491 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1492 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1493 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1494 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1495 @value{GDBN} commands.
1496
1497 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1498 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1499 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1500 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1501 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1502 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1503 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1504 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1505 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1506 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1507 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1508
1509 @smallexample
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1511 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1513 @end smallexample
1514
1515 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1516 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1517 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1518 place:
1519
1520 @smallexample
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1522 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1524 @end smallexample
1525
1526 @noindent
1527 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1528 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1529 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1530
1531 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1532 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1533 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1534 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1535
1536 @cindex completion of structure field names
1537 @cindex structure field name completion
1538 @cindex completion of union field names
1539 @cindex union field name completion
1540 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1541 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1542 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1543 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1544 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1545 left-hand-side:
1546
1547 @smallexample
1548 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1549 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1550 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1555 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1556 follows:
1557
1558 @smallexample
1559 struct ui_file
1560 @{
1561 int *magic;
1562 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1563 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1564 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1565 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1566 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1567 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1568 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1569 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1570 void *to_data;
1571 @}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574
1575 @node Help
1576 @section Getting Help
1577 @cindex online documentation
1578 @kindex help
1579
1580 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1581 using the command @code{help}.
1582
1583 @table @code
1584 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1585 @item help
1586 @itemx h
1587 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1588 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1589
1590 @smallexample
1591 (@value{GDBP}) help
1592 List of classes of commands:
1593
1594 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1595 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1596 data -- Examining data
1597 files -- Specifying and examining files
1598 internals -- Maintenance commands
1599 obscure -- Obscure features
1600 running -- Running the program
1601 stack -- Examining the stack
1602 status -- Status inquiries
1603 support -- Support facilities
1604 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1605 stopping the program
1606 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1607
1608 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1609 commands in that class.
1610 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1611 documentation.
1612 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1613 (@value{GDBP})
1614 @end smallexample
1615 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1616
1617 @item help @var{class}
1618 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1619 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1620 help display for the class @code{status}:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1624 Status inquiries.
1625
1626 List of commands:
1627
1628 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1629 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1630 info -- Generic command for showing things
1631 about the program being debugged
1632 show -- Generic command for showing things
1633 about the debugger
1634
1635 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1636 documentation.
1637 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1638 (@value{GDBP})
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @item help @var{command}
1642 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1643 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1644
1645 @kindex apropos
1646 @item apropos @var{args}
1647 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1648 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1649 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1650
1651 @smallexample
1652 apropos reload
1653 @end smallexample
1654
1655 @noindent
1656 results in:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 @c @group
1660 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1661 multiple times in one run
1662 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1663 multiple times in one run
1664 @c @end group
1665 @end smallexample
1666
1667 @kindex complete
1668 @item complete @var{args}
1669 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1670 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1671 command you want completed. For example:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 complete i
1675 @end smallexample
1676
1677 @noindent results in:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 @group
1681 if
1682 ignore
1683 info
1684 inspect
1685 @end group
1686 @end smallexample
1687
1688 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1689 @end table
1690
1691 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1692 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1693 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1694 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1695 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1696 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1697
1698 @c @group
1699 @table @code
1700 @kindex info
1701 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1702 @item info
1703 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1704 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1705 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1706 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1707 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1708 @w{@code{help info}}.
1709
1710 @kindex set
1711 @item set
1712 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1713 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1714 @code{set prompt $}.
1715
1716 @kindex show
1717 @item show
1718 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1719 @value{GDBN} itself.
1720 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1721 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1722 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1723 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1724
1725 @kindex info set
1726 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1727 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1728 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1729 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1730 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1731 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1732 @end table
1733 @c @end group
1734
1735 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1736 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1737
1738 @table @code
1739 @kindex show version
1740 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1741 @item show version
1742 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1743 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1744 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1745 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1746 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1747 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1748 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1749 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1750 @value{GDBN}.
1751
1752 @kindex show copying
1753 @kindex info copying
1754 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1755 @item show copying
1756 @itemx info copying
1757 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1758
1759 @kindex show warranty
1760 @kindex info warranty
1761 @item show warranty
1762 @itemx info warranty
1763 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1764 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1765
1766 @end table
1767
1768 @node Running
1769 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1770
1771 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1772 debugging information when you compile it.
1773
1774 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1775 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1776 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1777 kill a child process.
1778
1779 @menu
1780 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1781 * Starting:: Starting your program
1782 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1783 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1784
1785 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1786 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1787 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1788 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1789
1790 * Inferiors:: Debugging multiple inferiors
1791 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1792 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1793 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1794 @end menu
1795
1796 @node Compilation
1797 @section Compiling for Debugging
1798
1799 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1800 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1801 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1802 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1803 and addresses in the executable code.
1804
1805 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1806 the compiler.
1807
1808 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1809 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1810 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1811 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1812 executables containing debugging information.
1813
1814 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1815 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1816 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1817 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1818 in pushing your luck.
1819
1820 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1821 @cindex debugging optimized code
1822 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1823 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1824 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1825 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1826 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1827 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1828
1829 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1830 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1831 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1832 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1833 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1834
1835 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1836 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1837 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1838
1839 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1840 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1841 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1842 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1843 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1844 provides macro information if you specify the options
1845 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1846 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1847 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1848 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1849 @option{-g} alone.
1850
1851 @need 2000
1852 @node Starting
1853 @section Starting your Program
1854 @cindex starting
1855 @cindex running
1856
1857 @table @code
1858 @kindex run
1859 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1860 @item run
1861 @itemx r
1862 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1863 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1864 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1865 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1866 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1867
1868 @end table
1869
1870 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1871 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1872 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1873 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1874 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1875 message like this one:
1876
1877 @smallexample
1878 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1879 Try "help target" or "continue".
1880 @end smallexample
1881
1882 @noindent
1883 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1884 first (@pxref{load}).
1885
1886 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1887 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1888 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1889 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1890 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1891 divided into four categories:
1892
1893 @table @asis
1894 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1895 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1896 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1897 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1898 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1899 the arguments.
1900 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1901 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1902 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1903
1904 @item The @emph{environment.}
1905 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1906 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1907 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1908 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1909
1910 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1911 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1912 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1913 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1914
1915 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1916 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1917 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1918 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1919 set a different device for your program.
1920 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1921
1922 @cindex pipes
1923 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1924 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1925 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1926 wrong program.
1927 @end table
1928
1929 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1930 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1931 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1932 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1933 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1934
1935 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1936 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1937 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1938 your current breakpoints.
1939
1940 @table @code
1941 @kindex start
1942 @item start
1943 @cindex run to main procedure
1944 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1945 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1946 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1947 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1948 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1949 procedure, depending on the language used.
1950
1951 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1952 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1953 the @samp{run} command.
1954
1955 @cindex elaboration phase
1956 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1957 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1958 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1959 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1960 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1961 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1962 will remain to halt execution.
1963
1964 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1965 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1966 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1967 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1968 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1969
1970 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1971 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1972 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1973 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1974 elaboration code before running your program.
1975
1976 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1977 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1978 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1979 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1980 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1981 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1982 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1983 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1984 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1985 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1986 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1987
1988 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1989 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1990 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1991 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1992
1993 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1994 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1995 environment:
1996
1997 @smallexample
1998 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1999 (@value{GDBP}) run
2000 @end smallexample
2001
2002 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2003 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2004
2005 @kindex set disable-randomization
2006 @item set disable-randomization
2007 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2008 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2009 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2010 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2011 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2012
2013 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2014 behavior using
2015
2016 @smallexample
2017 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2018 @end smallexample
2019
2020 @item set disable-randomization off
2021 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2022 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2023 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2024 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2025 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2026 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2027
2028 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2029 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2030 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2031 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2032 a code at its expected addresses.
2033
2034 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2035 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2036 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2037 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2038 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2039 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2040 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2041 a randomly chosen address.
2042
2043 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2044 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2045 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2046 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2047 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2048
2049 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2050 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2051
2052 @item show disable-randomization
2053 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2054 the virtual address space of the started program.
2055
2056 @end table
2057
2058 @node Arguments
2059 @section Your Program's Arguments
2060
2061 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2062 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2063 @code{run} command.
2064 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2065 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2066 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2067 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2068 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2069
2070 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2071 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2072 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2073 the program, not by the shell.
2074
2075 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2076 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2077
2078 @table @code
2079 @kindex set args
2080 @item set args
2081 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2082 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2083 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2084 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2085 it again without arguments.
2086
2087 @kindex show args
2088 @item show args
2089 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2090 @end table
2091
2092 @node Environment
2093 @section Your Program's Environment
2094
2095 @cindex environment (of your program)
2096 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2097 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2098 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2099 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2100 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2101 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2102 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2103
2104 @table @code
2105 @kindex path
2106 @item path @var{directory}
2107 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2108 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2109 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2110 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2111 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2112 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2113 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2114
2115 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2116 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2117 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2118 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2119 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2120 @var{directory} to the search path.
2121 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2122 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2123
2124 @kindex show paths
2125 @item show paths
2126 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2127 environment variable).
2128
2129 @kindex show environment
2130 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2131 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2132 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2133 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2134 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2135
2136 @kindex set environment
2137 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2138 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2139 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2140 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2141 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2142 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2143 null value.
2144 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2145 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2146
2147 For example, this command:
2148
2149 @smallexample
2150 set env USER = foo
2151 @end smallexample
2152
2153 @noindent
2154 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2155 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2156 are not actually required.)
2157
2158 @kindex unset environment
2159 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2160 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2161 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2162 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2163 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2164 @end table
2165
2166 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2167 the shell indicated
2168 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2169 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2170 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2171 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2172 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2173 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2174 @file{.profile}.
2175
2176 @node Working Directory
2177 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2178
2179 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2180 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2181 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2182 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2183 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2184 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2185
2186 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2187 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2188 Specify Files}.
2189
2190 @table @code
2191 @kindex cd
2192 @cindex change working directory
2193 @item cd @var{directory}
2194 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2195
2196 @kindex pwd
2197 @item pwd
2198 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2202 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2203 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2204 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2205 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2206 current working directory of the debuggee.
2207
2208 @node Input/Output
2209 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2210
2211 @cindex redirection
2212 @cindex i/o
2213 @cindex terminal
2214 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2215 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2216 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2217 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2218 running your program.
2219
2220 @table @code
2221 @kindex info terminal
2222 @item info terminal
2223 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2224 program is using.
2225 @end table
2226
2227 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2228 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2229
2230 @smallexample
2231 run > outfile
2232 @end smallexample
2233
2234 @noindent
2235 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2236
2237 @kindex tty
2238 @cindex controlling terminal
2239 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2240 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2241 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2242 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2243 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2244
2245 @smallexample
2246 tty /dev/ttyb
2247 @end smallexample
2248
2249 @noindent
2250 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2251 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2252 that as their controlling terminal.
2253
2254 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2255 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2256 terminal.
2257
2258 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2259 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2260 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2261 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2262
2263 @cindex inferior tty
2264 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2265 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2266 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2267 program.
2268
2269 @table @code
2270 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2271 @kindex set inferior-tty
2272 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2273
2274 @item show inferior-tty
2275 @kindex show inferior-tty
2276 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2277 @end table
2278
2279 @node Attach
2280 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2281 @kindex attach
2282 @cindex attach
2283
2284 @table @code
2285 @item attach @var{process-id}
2286 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2287 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2288 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2289 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2290 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2291
2292 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2293 executing the command.
2294 @end table
2295
2296 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2297 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2298 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2299 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2300
2301 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2302 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2303 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2304 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2305 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2306 Specify Files}.
2307
2308 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2309 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2310 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2311 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2312 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2313 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2314 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2315
2316 @table @code
2317 @kindex detach
2318 @item detach
2319 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2320 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2321 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2322 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2323 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2324 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2325 executing the command.
2326 @end table
2327
2328 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2329 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2330 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2331 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2332 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2333 Messages}).
2334
2335 @node Kill Process
2336 @section Killing the Child Process
2337
2338 @table @code
2339 @kindex kill
2340 @item kill
2341 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2342 @end table
2343
2344 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2345 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2346 is running.
2347
2348 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2349 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2350 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2351 outside the debugger.
2352
2353 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2354 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2355 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2356 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2357 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2358 breakpoint settings).
2359
2360 @node Inferiors
2361 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2362
2363 Some @value{GDBN} targets are able to run multiple processes created
2364 from a single executable. This can happen, for instance, with an
2365 embedded system reporting back several processes via the remote
2366 protocol.
2367
2368 @cindex inferior
2369 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2370 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2371 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2372 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2373 may (in future) be retained after a process exits. Each run of an
2374 executable creates a new inferior, as does each attachment to an
2375 existing process. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are
2376 different from process ids, and may optionally be named as well.
2377 Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space,
2378 although some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in
2379 different parts of a single space.
2380
2381 Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
2382
2383 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @code{info inferiors}:
2384
2385 @table @code
2386 @kindex info inferiors
2387 @item info inferiors
2388 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2389
2390 @kindex set print inferior-events
2391 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2392 @item set print inferior-events
2393 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2394 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2395 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2396 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2397 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2398 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2399
2400 @kindex show print inferior-events
2401 @item show print inferior-events
2402 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2403 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2404 @end table
2405
2406 @node Threads
2407 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2408
2409 @cindex threads of execution
2410 @cindex multiple threads
2411 @cindex switching threads
2412 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2413 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2414 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2415 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2416 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2417 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2418 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2419
2420 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2421 programs:
2422
2423 @itemize @bullet
2424 @item automatic notification of new threads
2425 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2426 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2427 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2428 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2429 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2430 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2431 messages on thread start and exit.
2432 @end itemize
2433
2434 @quotation
2435 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2436 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2437 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2438 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2439 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2440 like this:
2441
2442 @smallexample
2443 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2444 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2445 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2446 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2447 @end smallexample
2448 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2449 @c doesn't support threads"?
2450 @end quotation
2451
2452 @cindex focus of debugging
2453 @cindex current thread
2454 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2455 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2456 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2457 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2458 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2459
2460 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2461 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2462 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2463 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2464 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2465 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2466 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2467 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2468 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2469 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2470
2471 @smallexample
2472 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2473 @end smallexample
2474
2475 @noindent
2476 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2477 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2478 further qualifier.
2479
2480 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2481 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2482 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2483 @c program?
2484 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2485 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2486 @c threads ab initio?
2487
2488 @cindex thread number
2489 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2490 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2491 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2492
2493 @table @code
2494 @kindex info threads
2495 @item info threads
2496 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2497 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2498
2499 @enumerate
2500 @item
2501 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2502
2503 @item
2504 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2505
2506 @item
2507 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2508 @end enumerate
2509
2510 @noindent
2511 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2512 indicates the current thread.
2513
2514 For example,
2515 @end table
2516 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2517
2518 @smallexample
2519 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2520 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2521 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2522 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2523 at threadtest.c:68
2524 @end smallexample
2525
2526 On HP-UX systems:
2527
2528 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2529 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2530 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2531 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2532 thread in your program.
2533
2534 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2535 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2536 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2537 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2538 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2539 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2540 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2541 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2542 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2543 HP-UX, you see
2544
2545 @smallexample
2546 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2547 @end smallexample
2548
2549 @noindent
2550 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2551
2552 @table @code
2553 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2554 @item info threads
2555 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2556 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2557
2558 @enumerate
2559 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2560
2561 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2562
2563 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2564 @end enumerate
2565
2566 @noindent
2567 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2568 indicates the current thread.
2569
2570 For example,
2571 @end table
2572 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2576 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2577 at quicksort.c:137
2578 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2579 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2580 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2581 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2582 @end smallexample
2583
2584 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2585 Solaris-specific command:
2586
2587 @table @code
2588 @item maint info sol-threads
2589 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2590 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2591 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @table @code
2595 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2596 @item thread @var{threadno}
2597 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2598 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2599 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2600 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2601 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2602
2603 @smallexample
2604 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2605 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2606 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2607 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2608 @end smallexample
2609
2610 @noindent
2611 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2612 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2613 threads.
2614
2615 @kindex thread apply
2616 @cindex apply command to several threads
2617 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2618 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2619 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2620 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2621 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2622 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2623 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2624 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2625
2626 @kindex set print thread-events
2627 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2628 @item set print thread-events
2629 @itemx set print thread-events on
2630 @itemx set print thread-events off
2631 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2632 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2633 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2634 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2635 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2636
2637 @kindex show print thread-events
2638 @item show print thread-events
2639 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2640 have started and exited.
2641 @end table
2642
2643 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2644 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2645 programs with multiple threads.
2646
2647 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2648 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2649
2650 @node Processes
2651 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2652
2653 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2654 @cindex multiple processes
2655 @cindex processes, multiple
2656 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2657 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2658 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2659 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2660 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2661 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2662 will cause it to terminate.
2663
2664 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2665 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2666 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2667 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2668 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2669 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2670 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2671 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2672 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2673 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2674
2675 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2676 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2677 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2678 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2679
2680 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2681 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2682
2683 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2684 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2685
2686 @table @code
2687 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2688 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2689 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2690 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2691 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2692
2693 @table @code
2694 @item parent
2695 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2696 unimpeded. This is the default.
2697
2698 @item child
2699 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2700 unimpeded.
2701
2702 @end table
2703
2704 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2705 @item show follow-fork-mode
2706 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2707 @end table
2708
2709 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2710 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2711 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2715 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2716 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2717 retain debugger control over them both.
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @item on
2721 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2722 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2723 independently. This is the default.
2724
2725 @item off
2726 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2727 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2728 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2729 is held suspended.
2730
2731 @end table
2732
2733 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2734 @item show detach-on-fork
2735 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2736 @end table
2737
2738 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2739 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2740 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2741 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2742 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex info forks
2746 @item info forks
2747 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2748 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2749 position (program counter) of the process.
2750
2751 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2752 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2753 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2754 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2755 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2756
2757 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2758 @item process @var{process-id}
2759 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2760 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2761 @samp{info forks}.
2762
2763 @end table
2764
2765 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2766 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2767 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2768 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2769
2770 @table @code
2771 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2772 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2773 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2774 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2775 allowed to run independently.
2776
2777 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2778 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2779 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2780 and remove it from the fork list.
2781
2782 @end table
2783
2784 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2785 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2786 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2787 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2788 the child process's @code{main}.
2789
2790 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2791 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2792
2793 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2794 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2795 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2796 argument.
2797
2798 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2799 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2800 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2801
2802 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2803 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2804
2805 @cindex checkpoint
2806 @cindex restart
2807 @cindex bookmark
2808 @cindex snapshot of a process
2809 @cindex rewind program state
2810
2811 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2812 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2813 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2814 later.
2815
2816 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2817 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2818 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2819 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2820 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2821
2822 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2823 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2824 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2825 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2826 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2827 start again from there.
2828
2829 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2830 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2831
2832 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2833
2834 @table @code
2835 @kindex checkpoint
2836 @item checkpoint
2837 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2838 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2839 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2840
2841 @kindex info checkpoints
2842 @item info checkpoints
2843 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2844 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2845 listed:
2846
2847 @table @code
2848 @item Checkpoint ID
2849 @item Process ID
2850 @item Code Address
2851 @item Source line, or label
2852 @end table
2853
2854 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2855 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2856 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2857 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2858 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2859 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2860 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2861
2862 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2863 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2864 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2865 the debugger.
2866
2867 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2868 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2869 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2870
2871 @end table
2872
2873 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2874 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2875 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2876 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2877 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2878 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2879 previously read data can be read again.
2880
2881 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2882 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2883 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2884 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2885 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2886 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2887
2888 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2889 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2890 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2891 different execution path this time.
2892
2893 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2894 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2895 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2896 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2897 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2898 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2899 potentially pose a problem.
2900
2901 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2902
2903 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2904 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2905 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2906 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2907 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2908 next.
2909
2910 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2911 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2912 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2913 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2914 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2915
2916 @node Stopping
2917 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2918
2919 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2920 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2921 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2922
2923 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2924 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2925 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2926 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2927 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2928 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2929 explicitly request this information at any time.
2930
2931 @table @code
2932 @kindex info program
2933 @item info program
2934 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2935 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2936 @end table
2937
2938 @menu
2939 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2940 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2941 * Signals:: Signals
2942 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2943 @end menu
2944
2945 @node Breakpoints
2946 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2947
2948 @cindex breakpoints
2949 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2950 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2951 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2952 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2954 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2955 program.
2956
2957 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2958 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2959 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2960 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2961 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2962 call).
2963
2964 @cindex watchpoints
2965 @cindex data breakpoints
2966 @cindex memory tracing
2967 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2968 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2969 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2970 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2971 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2972 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2973 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2974 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2975 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2976 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2977 same commands.
2978
2979 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2980 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2981 Automatic Display}.
2982
2983 @cindex catchpoints
2984 @cindex breakpoint on events
2985 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2986 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2987 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2988 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2989 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2990 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2991 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2992
2993 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2994 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2995 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2996 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2997 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2998 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2999 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3000 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3001 enable it again.
3002
3003 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3004 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3005 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3006 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3007 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3008 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3009 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3010
3011 @menu
3012 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3013 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3014 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3015 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3016 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3017 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3018 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3019 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3020 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3021 @end menu
3022
3023 @node Set Breaks
3024 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3025
3026 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3027 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3028 @c
3029 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3030
3031 @kindex break
3032 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3033 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3034 @cindex latest breakpoint
3035 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3036 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3037 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3038 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3039 convenience variables.
3040
3041 @table @code
3042 @item break @var{location}
3043 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3044 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3045 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3046 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3047 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3048
3049 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3050 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3051 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3052 that situation.
3053
3054 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3055 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3056 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3057
3058 @item break
3059 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3060 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3061 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3062 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3063 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3064 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3065 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3066 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3067 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3068 inside loops.
3069
3070 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3071 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3072 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3073 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3074 existed when your program stopped.
3075
3076 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3077 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3078 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3079 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3080 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3081 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3082 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3083
3084 @kindex tbreak
3085 @item tbreak @var{args}
3086 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3087 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3088 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3089 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3090
3091 @kindex hbreak
3092 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3093 @item hbreak @var{args}
3094 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3095 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3096 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3097 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3098 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3099 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3100 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3101 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3102 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3103 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3104 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3105 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3106 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3107 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3108 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3109 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3110 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3111 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3112
3113 @kindex thbreak
3114 @item thbreak @var{args}
3115 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3116 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3117 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3118 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3119 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3120 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3121 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3122 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3123
3124 @kindex rbreak
3125 @cindex regular expression
3126 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3127 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3128 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3129 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3130 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3131 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3132 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3133 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3134 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3135
3136 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3137 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3138 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3139 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3140 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3141 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3142
3143 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3144 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3145 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3146 classes.
3147
3148 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3149 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3150 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3151
3152 @smallexample
3153 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3154 @end smallexample
3155
3156 @kindex info breakpoints
3157 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3158 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3159 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3160 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3161 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3162 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3163 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3164 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3165
3166 @table @emph
3167 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3168 @item Type
3169 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3170 @item Disposition
3171 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3172 @item Enabled or Disabled
3173 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3174 that are not enabled.
3175 @item Address
3176 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3177 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3178 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3179 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3180 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3181 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3182 @item What
3183 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3184 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3185 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3186 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3187 @end table
3188
3189 @noindent
3190 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3191 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3192 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3193 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3194 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3195 valid location.
3196
3197 @noindent
3198 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3199 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3200 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3201 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3202 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3203
3204 @noindent
3205 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3206 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3207 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3208 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3209 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3210 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3211 @end table
3212
3213 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3214 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3215 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3216 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3217
3218 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3219 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3220 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3221 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3222
3223 @itemize @bullet
3224 @item
3225 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3226 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3227
3228 @item
3229 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3230 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3231
3232 @item
3233 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3234 several places where that function is inlined.
3235 @end itemize
3236
3237 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3238 the relevant locations@footnote{
3239 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3240 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3241 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3242 info with line numbers for them.}.
3243
3244 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3245 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3246 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3247 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3248 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3249 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3250 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3251
3252 For example:
3253
3254 @smallexample
3255 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3256 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3257 stop only if i==1
3258 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3259 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3260 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3261 @end smallexample
3262
3263 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3264 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3265 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3266 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3267 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3268 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3269 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3270 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3271 that belong to that breakpoint.
3272
3273 @cindex pending breakpoints
3274 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3275 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3276 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3277 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3278 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3279 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3280 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3281 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3282 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3283 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3284 is not yet resolved.
3285
3286 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3287 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3288 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3289 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3290 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3291 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3292
3293 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3294 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3295 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3296 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3297
3298 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3299 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3300 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3301
3302 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3303 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3304 address specification to an address:
3305
3306 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3307 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3308 @table @code
3309 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3310 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3311 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3312
3313 @item set breakpoint pending on
3314 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3315 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3316
3317 @item set breakpoint pending off
3318 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3319 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3320 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3321
3322 @item show breakpoint pending
3323 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3324 @end table
3325
3326 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3327 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3328 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3329
3330 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3331 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3332 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3333 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3334 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3335 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3336 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3337 breakpoints.
3338
3339 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3340
3341 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3342 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3343 @table @code
3344 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3345 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3346 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3347 breakpoint must be used.
3348
3349 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3350 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3351 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3352 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3353 @end table
3354
3355 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3356 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3357 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3358 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3359 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3360 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3361 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3362 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3363 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3364
3365 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3366 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3367 @table @code
3368 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3369 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3370 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3371 removed from the target when it stops.
3372
3373 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3374 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3375 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3376 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3377 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3378
3379 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3380 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3381 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3382 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3383 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3384 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3385 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3386 @end table
3387
3388 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3389 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3390 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3391 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3392 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3393 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3394 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3395 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3396
3397
3398 @node Set Watchpoints
3399 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3400
3401 @cindex setting watchpoints
3402 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3403 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3404 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3405 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3406 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3407
3408 @itemize @bullet
3409 @item
3410 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3411
3412 @item
3413 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3414 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3415 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3416
3417 @item
3418 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3419 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3420 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3421 @end itemize
3422
3423 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3424 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3425 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3426 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3427 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3428 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3429 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3430 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3431 the expression changes.
3432
3433 @cindex software watchpoints
3434 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3435 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3436 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3437 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3438 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3439 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3440 culprit.)
3441
3442 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3443 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3444 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3445
3446 @table @code
3447 @kindex watch
3448 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3449 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3450 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3451 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3452 to watch the value of a single variable:
3453
3454 @smallexample
3455 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3456 @end smallexample
3457
3458 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3459 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3460 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3461 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3462 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3463 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3464
3465 @kindex rwatch
3466 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3467 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3468 by the program.
3469
3470 @kindex awatch
3471 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3472 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3473 or written into by the program.
3474
3475 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3476 @item info watchpoints
3477 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3478 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3479 @end table
3480
3481 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3482 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3483 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3484 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3485 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3486 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3487
3488 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3489 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3490 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3491 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3492 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3493 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3494 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3495 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3496
3497 @table @code
3498 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3499 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3500 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3501
3502 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3503 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3504 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3505 @end table
3506
3507 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3508 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3509 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3510
3511 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3512
3513 @smallexample
3514 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3515 @end smallexample
3516
3517 @noindent
3518 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3519
3520 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3521 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3522 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3523 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3524 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3525 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3526 will print a message like this:
3527
3528 @smallexample
3529 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3530 @end smallexample
3531
3532 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3533 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3534 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3535 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3536 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3537 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3538 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3539 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3540
3541 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3542 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3543 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3544 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3545 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3546 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3547
3548 @smallexample
3549 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3550 @end smallexample
3551
3552 @noindent
3553 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3554
3555 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3556 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3557 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3558 expression with separately allocated resources.
3559
3560 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3561 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3562 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3563
3564 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3565 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3566 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3567 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3568 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3569 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3570 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3571 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3572 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3573
3574 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3575 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3576 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3577 watched expression from every thread.
3578
3579 @quotation
3580 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3581 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3582 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3583 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3584 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3585 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3586 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3587 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3588 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3589 @end quotation
3590
3591 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3592
3593 @node Set Catchpoints
3594 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3595 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3596 @cindex exception handlers
3597 @cindex event handling
3598
3599 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3600 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3601 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3602
3603 @table @code
3604 @kindex catch
3605 @item catch @var{event}
3606 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3607 @table @code
3608 @item throw
3609 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3610 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3611
3612 @item catch
3613 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3614
3615 @item exception
3616 @cindex Ada exception catching
3617 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3618 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3619 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3620 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3621 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3622
3623 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3624 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3625 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3626 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3627 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3628 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3629 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3630 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3631
3632 @item exception unhandled
3633 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3634
3635 @item assert
3636 A failed Ada assertion.
3637
3638 @item exec
3639 @cindex break on fork/exec
3640 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3641 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3642
3643 @item fork
3644 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3645 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3646
3647 @item vfork
3648 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3649 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3650
3651 @end table
3652
3653 @item tcatch @var{event}
3654 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3655 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3656
3657 @end table
3658
3659 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3660
3661 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3662 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3663
3664 @itemize @bullet
3665 @item
3666 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3667 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3668 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3669 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3670 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3671 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3672 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3673 disabled within interactive calls.
3674
3675 @item
3676 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3677
3678 @item
3679 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3680 @end itemize
3681
3682 @cindex raise exceptions
3683 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3684 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3685 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3686 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3687 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3688 out where the exception was raised.
3689
3690 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3691 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3692 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3693 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3694
3695 @smallexample
3696 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3697 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3698 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3699 @end smallexample
3700
3701 @noindent
3702 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3703 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3704 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3705
3706 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3707 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3708 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3709 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3710 raised.
3711
3712
3713 @node Delete Breaks
3714 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3715
3716 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3717 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3718 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3719 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3720 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3721 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3722
3723 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3724 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3725 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3726 their breakpoint numbers.
3727
3728 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3729 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3730 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3731
3732 @table @code
3733 @kindex clear
3734 @item clear
3735 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3736 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3737 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3738 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3739
3740 @item clear @var{location}
3741 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3742 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3743 most useful ones are listed below:
3744
3745 @table @code
3746 @item clear @var{function}
3747 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3748 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3749
3750 @item clear @var{linenum}
3751 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3752 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3753 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3754 @end table
3755
3756 @cindex delete breakpoints
3757 @kindex delete
3758 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3759 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3760 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3761 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3762 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3763 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3764 @end table
3765
3766 @node Disabling
3767 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3768
3769 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3770 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3771 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3772 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3773 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3774
3775 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3776 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3777 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3778 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3779 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3780
3781 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3782 affects all of its locations.
3783
3784 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3785 states of enablement:
3786
3787 @itemize @bullet
3788 @item
3789 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3790 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3791 @item
3792 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3793 @item
3794 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3795 disabled.
3796 @item
3797 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3798 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3799 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3800 @end itemize
3801
3802 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3803 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3804
3805 @table @code
3806 @kindex disable
3807 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3808 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3809 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3810 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3811 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3812 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3813 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3814
3815 @kindex enable
3816 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3817 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3818 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3819
3820 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3821 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3822 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3823
3824 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3825 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3826 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3827 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3828 @end table
3829
3830 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3831 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3832 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3833 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3834 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3835 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3836 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3837 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3838 Stepping}.)
3839
3840 @node Conditions
3841 @subsection Break Conditions
3842 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3843 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3844
3845 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3846 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3847 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3848 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3849 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3850 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3851 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3852 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3853
3854 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3855 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3856 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3857 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3858 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3859
3860 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3861 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3862 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3863 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3864 one.
3865
3866 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3867 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3868 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3869 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3870 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3871 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3872 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3873 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3874 conditions for the
3875 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3876 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3877
3878 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3879 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3880 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3881 with the @code{condition} command.
3882
3883 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3884 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3885 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3886 catchpoint.
3887
3888 @table @code
3889 @kindex condition
3890 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3891 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3892 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3893 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3894 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3895 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3896 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3897 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3898 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3899 prints an error message:
3900
3901 @smallexample
3902 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3903 @end smallexample
3904
3905 @noindent
3906 @value{GDBN} does
3907 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3908 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3909 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3910
3911 @item condition @var{bnum}
3912 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3913 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3914 @end table
3915
3916 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3917 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3918 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3919 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3920 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3921 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3922 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3923 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3924 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3925 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3926 your program reaches it.
3927
3928 @table @code
3929 @kindex ignore
3930 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3931 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3932 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3933 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3934 takes no action.
3935
3936 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3937 a count of zero.
3938
3939 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3940 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3941 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3942 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3943
3944 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3945 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3946 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3947
3948 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3949 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3950 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3951 Variables}.
3952 @end table
3953
3954 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3955
3956
3957 @node Break Commands
3958 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3959
3960 @cindex breakpoint commands
3961 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3962 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3963 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3964 enable other breakpoints.
3965
3966 @table @code
3967 @kindex commands
3968 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3969 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3970 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3971 @itemx end
3972 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3973 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3974 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3975
3976 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3977 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3978
3979 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3980 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3981 recently encountered).
3982 @end table
3983
3984 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3985 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3986
3987 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3988 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3989 that resumes execution.
3990
3991 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3992 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3993 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3994 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3995 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3996
3997 @kindex silent
3998 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3999 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4000 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4001 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4002 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4003 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4004
4005 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4006 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4007 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4008
4009 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4010 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4011
4012 @smallexample
4013 break foo if x>0
4014 commands
4015 silent
4016 printf "x is %d\n",x
4017 cont
4018 end
4019 @end smallexample
4020
4021 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4022 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4023 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4024 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4025 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4026 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4027 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4028
4029 @smallexample
4030 break 403
4031 commands
4032 silent
4033 set x = y + 4
4034 cont
4035 end
4036 @end smallexample
4037
4038 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4039 @node Error in Breakpoints
4040 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4041
4042 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4043 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4044
4045 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4046 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4047 @smallexample
4048 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4049 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4050 @end smallexample
4051
4052 @noindent
4053 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4054 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4055 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4056
4057 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4058 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4059
4060 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4061 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4062 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4063
4064 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4065 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4066 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4067 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4068
4069 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4070 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4071 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4072 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4073 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4074 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4075 first in the bundle.
4076
4077 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4078 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4079 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4080 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4081 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4082 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4083 is hit.
4084
4085 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4086 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4087
4088 @smallexample
4089 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4090 @end smallexample
4091
4092 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4093 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4094 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4095 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4096 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4097 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4098 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4099 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4100
4101 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4102 adjusted breakpoints:
4103
4104 @smallexample
4105 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4106 to 0x00010410.
4107 @end smallexample
4108
4109 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4110 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4111 frequently than expected.
4112
4113 @node Continuing and Stepping
4114 @section Continuing and Stepping
4115
4116 @cindex stepping
4117 @cindex continuing
4118 @cindex resuming execution
4119 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4120 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4121 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4122 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4123 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4124 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4125 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4126 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4127
4128 @table @code
4129 @kindex continue
4130 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4131 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4132 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4133 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4134 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4135 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4136 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4137 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4138 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4139 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4140
4141 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4142 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4143 @code{continue} is ignored.
4144
4145 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4146 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4147 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4148 @code{continue}.
4149 @end table
4150
4151 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4152 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4153 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4154 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4155
4156 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4157 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4158 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4159 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4160 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4161 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4162
4163 @table @code
4164 @kindex step
4165 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4166 @item step
4167 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4168 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4169 abbreviated @code{s}.
4170
4171 @quotation
4172 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4173 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4174 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4175 @c distinction here.
4176 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4177 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4178 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4179 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4180 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4181 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4182 below.
4183 @end quotation
4184
4185 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4186 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4187 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4188 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4189 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4190 called within the line.
4191
4192 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4193 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4194 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4195 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4196 was any debugging information about the routine.
4197
4198 @item step @var{count}
4199 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4200 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4201 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4202
4203 @kindex next
4204 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4205 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4206 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4207 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4208 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4209 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4210 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4211 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4212
4213 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4214
4215
4216 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4217 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4218 @c
4219 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4220 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4221 @c function are executed without stopping.
4222
4223 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4224 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4225 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4226
4227 @kindex set step-mode
4228 @item set step-mode
4229 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4230 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4231 @itemx set step-mode on
4232 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4233 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4234 information rather than stepping over it.
4235
4236 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4237 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4238 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4239
4240 @item set step-mode off
4241 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4242 debug information. This is the default.
4243
4244 @item show step-mode
4245 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4246 source line debug information.
4247
4248 @kindex finish
4249 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4250 @item finish
4251 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4252 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4253 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4254
4255 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4256 ,Returning from a Function}).
4257
4258 @kindex until
4259 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4260 @cindex run until specified location
4261 @item until
4262 @itemx u
4263 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4264 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4265 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4266 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4267 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4268 than the address of the jump.
4269
4270 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4271 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4272 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4273 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4274 through the next iteration.
4275
4276 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4277 stack frame.
4278
4279 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4280 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4281 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4282 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4283 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4284
4285 @smallexample
4286 (@value{GDBP}) f
4287 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4288 206 expand_input();
4289 (@value{GDBP}) until
4290 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4291 @end smallexample
4292
4293 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4294 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4295 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4296 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4297 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4298 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4299 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4300
4301 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4302 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4303 argument.
4304
4305 @item until @var{location}
4306 @itemx u @var{location}
4307 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4308 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4309 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4310 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4311 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4312 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4313 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4314 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4315 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4316 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4317 invocations have returned.
4318
4319 @smallexample
4320 94 int factorial (int value)
4321 95 @{
4322 96 if (value > 1) @{
4323 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4324 98 @}
4325 99 return (value);
4326 100 @}
4327 @end smallexample
4328
4329
4330 @kindex advance @var{location}
4331 @itemx advance @var{location}
4332 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4333 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4334 @ref{Specify Location}.
4335 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4336 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4337 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4338 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4339
4340
4341 @kindex stepi
4342 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4343 @item stepi
4344 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4345 @itemx si
4346 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4347
4348 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4349 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4350 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4351 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4352
4353 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4354
4355 @need 750
4356 @kindex nexti
4357 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4358 @item nexti
4359 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4360 @itemx ni
4361 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4362 proceed until the function returns.
4363
4364 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4365 @end table
4366
4367 @node Signals
4368 @section Signals
4369 @cindex signals
4370
4371 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4372 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4373 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4374 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4375 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4376 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4377 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4378 requested an alarm).
4379
4380 @cindex fatal signals
4381 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4382 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4383 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4384 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4385 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4386 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4387
4388 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4389 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4390 signal.
4391
4392 @cindex handling signals
4393 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4394 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4395 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4396 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4397 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4398
4399 @table @code
4400 @kindex info signals
4401 @kindex info handle
4402 @item info signals
4403 @itemx info handle
4404 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4405 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4406 the defined types of signals.
4407
4408 @item info signals @var{sig}
4409 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4410
4411 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4412
4413 @kindex handle
4414 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4415 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4416 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4417 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4418 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4419 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4420 say what change to make.
4421 @end table
4422
4423 @c @group
4424 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4425 Their full names are:
4426
4427 @table @code
4428 @item nostop
4429 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4430 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4431
4432 @item stop
4433 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4434 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4435
4436 @item print
4437 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4438
4439 @item noprint
4440 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4441 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4442
4443 @item pass
4444 @itemx noignore
4445 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4446 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4447 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4448
4449 @item nopass
4450 @itemx ignore
4451 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4452 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4453 @end table
4454 @c @end group
4455
4456 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4457 program until you
4458 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4459 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4460 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4461 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4462 program sees that signal when you continue.
4463
4464 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4465 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4466 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4467 erroneous signals.
4468
4469 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4470 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4471 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4472 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4473 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4474 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4475 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4476 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4477 Program a Signal}.
4478
4479 @cindex extra signal information
4480 @anchor{extra signal information}
4481
4482 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4483 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4484 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4485 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4486 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4487 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4488 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4489 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4490 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4491 system header.
4492
4493 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4494 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4495
4496 @smallexample
4497 @group
4498 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4499 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4500 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4501 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4502 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4503 type = struct @{
4504 int si_signo;
4505 int si_errno;
4506 int si_code;
4507 union @{
4508 int _pad[28];
4509 struct @{...@} _kill;
4510 struct @{...@} _timer;
4511 struct @{...@} _rt;
4512 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4513 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4514 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4515 @} _sifields;
4516 @}
4517 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4518 type = struct @{
4519 void *si_addr;
4520 @}
4521 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4522 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4523 @end group
4524 @end smallexample
4525
4526 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4527
4528 @node Thread Stops
4529 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4530
4531 @cindex stopped threads
4532 @cindex threads, stopped
4533
4534 @cindex continuing threads
4535 @cindex threads, continuing
4536
4537 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4538 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4539 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4540 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4541 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4542 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4543 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4544 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4545 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4546
4547 @menu
4548 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4549 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4550 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4551 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4552 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4553 @end menu
4554
4555 @node All-Stop Mode
4556 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4557
4558 @cindex all-stop mode
4559
4560 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4561 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4562 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4563 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4564 underfoot.
4565
4566 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4567 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4568 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4569
4570 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4571 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4572 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4573 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4574 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4575 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4576 stops.
4577
4578 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4579 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4580 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4581 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4582
4583 @cindex automatic thread selection
4584 @cindex switching threads automatically
4585 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4586 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4587 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4588 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4589 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4590 thread.
4591
4592 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4593 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4594
4595 @table @code
4596 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4597 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4598 @cindex lock scheduler
4599 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4600 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4601 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4602 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4603 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4604 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4605 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4606 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4607 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4608 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4609 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4610 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4611
4612 @item show scheduler-locking
4613 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4614 @end table
4615
4616 @node Non-Stop Mode
4617 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4618
4619 @cindex non-stop mode
4620
4621 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4622 @c with more details.
4623
4624 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4625 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4626 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4627 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4628 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4629 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4630
4631 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4632 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4633 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4634 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4635 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4636 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4637 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4638 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4639 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4640 independently and simultaneously.
4641
4642 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4643 or attach to your program:
4644
4645 @smallexample
4646 # Enable the async interface.
4647 set target-async 1
4648
4649 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4650 set pagination off
4651
4652 # Finally, turn it on!
4653 set non-stop on
4654 @end smallexample
4655
4656 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4657
4658 @table @code
4659 @kindex set non-stop
4660 @item set non-stop on
4661 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4662 @item set non-stop off
4663 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4664 @kindex show non-stop
4665 @item show non-stop
4666 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4667 @end table
4668
4669 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4670 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4671 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4672 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4673 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4674 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4675 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4676 default.
4677
4678 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4679 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4680 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4681
4682 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4683 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4684 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4685 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4686 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4687
4688 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4689 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4690 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4691 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4692 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4693
4694 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4695
4696 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4697 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4698 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4699 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4700 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4701 previously current thread.
4702
4703 @node Background Execution
4704 @subsection Background Execution
4705
4706 @cindex foreground execution
4707 @cindex background execution
4708 @cindex asynchronous execution
4709 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4710
4711 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4712 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4713 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4714 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4715 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4716 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4717
4718 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
4719 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
4720 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
4721
4722 @table @code
4723 @kindex set target-async
4724 @item set target-async on
4725 Enable asynchronous mode.
4726 @item set target-async off
4727 Disable asynchronous mode.
4728 @kindex show target-async
4729 @item show target-async
4730 Show the current target-async setting.
4731 @end table
4732
4733 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
4734 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4735
4736 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4737 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4738 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4739 are:
4740
4741 @table @code
4742 @kindex run&
4743 @item run
4744 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4745
4746 @item attach
4747 @kindex attach&
4748 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4749
4750 @item step
4751 @kindex step&
4752 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4753
4754 @item stepi
4755 @kindex stepi&
4756 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4757
4758 @item next
4759 @kindex next&
4760 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4761
4762 @item nexti
4763 @kindex nexti&
4764 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
4765
4766 @item continue
4767 @kindex continue&
4768 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4769
4770 @item finish
4771 @kindex finish&
4772 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4773
4774 @item until
4775 @kindex until&
4776 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4777
4778 @end table
4779
4780 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4781 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4782 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4783 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4784 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4785 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4786
4787 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4788 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4789
4790 @table @code
4791 @kindex interrupt
4792 @item interrupt
4793 @itemx interrupt -a
4794
4795 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4796 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4797 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4798 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4799 @end table
4800
4801 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4802 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4803
4804 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4805 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4806 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4807
4808 @table @code
4809 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4810 @cindex thread breakpoints
4811 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4812 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4813 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4814 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4815 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4816 specify some source line.
4817
4818 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4819 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4820 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4821 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4822 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4823
4824 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4825 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4826 program.
4827
4828 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4829 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4830 breakpoint condition, like this:
4831
4832 @smallexample
4833 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4834 @end smallexample
4835
4836 @end table
4837
4838 @node Interrupted System Calls
4839 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4840
4841 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4842 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4843 @cindex premature return from system calls
4844 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4845 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4846 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4847 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4848 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4849 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4850 stop execution.
4851
4852 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4853 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4854 style anyways.
4855
4856 For example, do not write code like this:
4857
4858 @smallexample
4859 sleep (10);
4860 @end smallexample
4861
4862 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4863 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4864
4865 Instead, write this:
4866
4867 @smallexample
4868 int unslept = 10;
4869 while (unslept > 0)
4870 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4871 @end smallexample
4872
4873 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4874 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4875 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4876 @value{GDBN}.
4877
4878 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4879 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4880 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4881 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4882
4883
4884 @node Reverse Execution
4885 @chapter Running programs backward
4886 @cindex reverse execution
4887 @cindex running programs backward
4888
4889 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
4890 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
4891 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
4892 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
4893
4894 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
4895 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
4896 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
4897 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
4898 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
4899 all target environments can support reverse execution.
4900
4901 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
4902 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
4903 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
4904 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
4905 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
4906 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
4907 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
4908 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
4909 prior values@footnote{
4910 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
4911 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
4912 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
4913
4914 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
4915 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
4916 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
4917 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
4918 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
4919 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
4920 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
4921 }.
4922
4923 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
4924 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
4925
4926 @table @code
4927 @kindex reverse-continue
4928 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
4929 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4930 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4931 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
4932 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
4933 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
4934 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
4935
4936 @kindex reverse-step
4937 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
4938 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4939 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
4940 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
4941
4942 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
4943 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
4944 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
4945 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
4946 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
4947 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
4948
4949 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
4950 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
4951
4952 @kindex reverse-stepi
4953 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
4954 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4955 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
4956 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
4957 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
4958 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
4959 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
4960
4961 @kindex reverse-next
4962 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
4963 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4964 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
4965 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
4966 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
4967 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
4968 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
4969 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
4970 line of a function back to its return to its caller
4971 @footnote{Unles the code is too heavily optimized.}.
4972
4973 @kindex reverse-nexti
4974 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
4975 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4976 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
4977 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
4978 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
4979 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
4980 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
4981 frame) is reached.
4982
4983 @kindex reverse-finish
4984 @item reverse-finish
4985 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
4986 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
4987 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
4988 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
4989
4990 @kindex set exec-direction
4991 @item set exec-direction
4992 Set the direction of target execution.
4993 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
4994 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
4995 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
4996 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
4997 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
4998 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
4999 @item set exec-direction forward
5000 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5001 This is the default.
5002 @end table
5003
5004
5005 @node Stack
5006 @chapter Examining the Stack
5007
5008 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5009 stopped and how it got there.
5010
5011 @cindex call stack
5012 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5013 is generated.
5014 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5015 the arguments of the call,
5016 and the local variables of the function being called.
5017 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5018 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5019 stack}.
5020
5021 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5022 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5023
5024 @cindex selected frame
5025 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5026 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5027 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5028 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5029 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5030 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5031
5032 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5033 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5034 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5035
5036 @menu
5037 * Frames:: Stack frames
5038 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5039 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5040 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5041
5042 @end menu
5043
5044 @node Frames
5045 @section Stack Frames
5046
5047 @cindex frame, definition
5048 @cindex stack frame
5049 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5050 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5051 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5052 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5053 which the function is executing.
5054
5055 @cindex initial frame
5056 @cindex outermost frame
5057 @cindex innermost frame
5058 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5059 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5060 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5061 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5062 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5063 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5064 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5065 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5066
5067 @cindex frame pointer
5068 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5069 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5070 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5071 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5072 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5073 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5074
5075 @cindex frame number
5076 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5077 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5078 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5079 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5080 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5081
5082 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5083 @c underflow problems.
5084 @cindex frameless execution
5085 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5086 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5087 @smallexample
5088 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5089 @end smallexample
5090 generates functions without a frame.)
5091 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5092 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5093 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5094 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5095 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5096 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5097 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5098
5099 @table @code
5100 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5101 @cindex current stack frame
5102 @item frame @var{args}
5103 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5104 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5105 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5106 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5107
5108 @kindex select-frame
5109 @cindex selecting frame silently
5110 @item select-frame
5111 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5112 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5113 @code{frame}.
5114 @end table
5115
5116 @node Backtrace
5117 @section Backtraces
5118
5119 @cindex traceback
5120 @cindex call stack traces
5121 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5122 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5123 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5124 stack.
5125
5126 @table @code
5127 @kindex backtrace
5128 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5129 @item backtrace
5130 @itemx bt
5131 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5132 frames in the stack.
5133
5134 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5135 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5136
5137 @item backtrace @var{n}
5138 @itemx bt @var{n}
5139 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5140
5141 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5142 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5143 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5144
5145 @item backtrace full
5146 @itemx bt full
5147 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5148 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5149 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5150 number of frames to print, as described above.
5151 @end table
5152
5153 @kindex where
5154 @kindex info stack
5155 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5156 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5157
5158 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5159 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5160 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5161 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5162 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5163 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5164 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5165 multi-threaded program.
5166
5167 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5168 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5169 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5170 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5171 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5172 line number.
5173
5174 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5175 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5176
5177 @smallexample
5178 @group
5179 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5180 at builtin.c:993
5181 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5182 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5183 at macro.c:71
5184 (More stack frames follow...)
5185 @end group
5186 @end smallexample
5187
5188 @noindent
5189 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5190 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5191 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5192
5193 @noindent
5194 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5195 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5196 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5197 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5198 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5199
5200 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5201 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5202 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5203 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5204 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5205 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5206 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5207 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5208 such a backtrace might look like:
5209
5210 @smallexample
5211 @group
5212 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5213 at builtin.c:993
5214 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5215 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5216 at macro.c:71
5217 (More stack frames follow...)
5218 @end group
5219 @end smallexample
5220
5221 @noindent
5222 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5223 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5224
5225 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5226 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5227 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5228
5229 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5230 @cindex program entry point
5231 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5232 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5233 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5234 @code{main}@footnote{
5235 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5236 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5237 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5238 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5239 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5240 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5241
5242 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5243 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5244
5245 @table @code
5246 @item set backtrace past-main
5247 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5248 @kindex set backtrace
5249 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5250
5251 @item set backtrace past-main off
5252 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5253 default.
5254
5255 @item show backtrace past-main
5256 @kindex show backtrace
5257 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5258
5259 @item set backtrace past-entry
5260 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5261 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5262 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5263 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5264
5265 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5266 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5267 application. This is the default.
5268
5269 @item show backtrace past-entry
5270 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5271
5272 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5273 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5274 @cindex backtrace limit
5275 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5276 unlimited.
5277
5278 @item show backtrace limit
5279 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5280 @end table
5281
5282 @node Selection
5283 @section Selecting a Frame
5284
5285 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5286 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5287 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5288 of the stack frame just selected.
5289
5290 @table @code
5291 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5292 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5293 @item frame @var{n}
5294 @itemx f @var{n}
5295 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5296 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5297 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5298 @code{main}.
5299
5300 @item frame @var{addr}
5301 @itemx f @var{addr}
5302 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5303 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5304 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5305 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5306 switches between them.
5307
5308 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5309 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5310
5311 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5312 pointer and a program counter.
5313
5314 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5315 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5316
5317 @kindex up
5318 @item up @var{n}
5319 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5320 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5321 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5322
5323 @kindex down
5324 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5325 @item down @var{n}
5326 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5327 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5328 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5329 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5330 @end table
5331
5332 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5333 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5334 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5335 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5336
5337 @need 1000
5338 For example:
5339
5340 @smallexample
5341 @group
5342 (@value{GDBP}) up
5343 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5344 at env.c:10
5345 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5346 @end group
5347 @end smallexample
5348
5349 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5350 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5351 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5352 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5353 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5354 for details.
5355
5356 @table @code
5357 @kindex down-silently
5358 @kindex up-silently
5359 @item up-silently @var{n}
5360 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5361 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5362 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5363 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5364 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5365 distracting.
5366 @end table
5367
5368 @node Frame Info
5369 @section Information About a Frame
5370
5371 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5372 stack frame.
5373
5374 @table @code
5375 @item frame
5376 @itemx f
5377 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5378 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5379 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5380 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5381 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5382
5383 @kindex info frame
5384 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5385 @item info frame
5386 @itemx info f
5387 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5388 including:
5389
5390 @itemize @bullet
5391 @item
5392 the address of the frame
5393 @item
5394 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5395 @item
5396 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5397 @item
5398 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5399 @item
5400 the address of the frame's arguments
5401 @item
5402 the address of the frame's local variables
5403 @item
5404 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5405 @item
5406 which registers were saved in the frame
5407 @end itemize
5408
5409 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5410 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5411 the usual conventions.
5412
5413 @item info frame @var{addr}
5414 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5415 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5416 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5417 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5418 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5419 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5420
5421 @kindex info args
5422 @item info args
5423 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5424
5425 @item info locals
5426 @kindex info locals
5427 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5428 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5429 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5430
5431 @kindex info catch
5432 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5433 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5434 @item info catch
5435 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5436 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5437 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5438 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5439 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5440
5441 @end table
5442
5443
5444 @node Source
5445 @chapter Examining Source Files
5446
5447 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5448 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5449 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5450 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5451 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5452 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5453 source files by explicit command.
5454
5455 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5456 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5457 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5458
5459 @menu
5460 * List:: Printing source lines
5461 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5462 * Edit:: Editing source files
5463 * Search:: Searching source files
5464 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5465 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5466 @end menu
5467
5468 @node List
5469 @section Printing Source Lines
5470
5471 @kindex list
5472 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5473 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5474 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5475 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5476 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5477
5478 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5479
5480 @table @code
5481 @item list @var{linenum}
5482 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5483 current source file.
5484
5485 @item list @var{function}
5486 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5487 @var{function}.
5488
5489 @item list
5490 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5491 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5492 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5493 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5494 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5495
5496 @item list -
5497 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5498 @end table
5499
5500 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5501 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5502 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5503
5504 @table @code
5505 @kindex set listsize
5506 @item set listsize @var{count}
5507 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5508 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5509
5510 @kindex show listsize
5511 @item show listsize
5512 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5513 @end table
5514
5515 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5516 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5517 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5518 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5519 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5520
5521 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5522 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5523 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5524 to specify some source line.
5525
5526 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5527
5528 @table @code
5529 @item list @var{linespec}
5530 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5531
5532 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5533 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5534 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5535 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5536 the same source file as the first linespec.
5537
5538 @item list ,@var{last}
5539 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5540
5541 @item list @var{first},
5542 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5543
5544 @item list +
5545 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5546
5547 @item list -
5548 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5549
5550 @item list
5551 As described in the preceding table.
5552 @end table
5553
5554 @node Specify Location
5555 @section Specifying a Location
5556 @cindex specifying location
5557 @cindex linespec
5558
5559 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5560 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5561 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5562 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5563
5564 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5565 @value{GDBN} understands:
5566
5567 @table @code
5568 @item @var{linenum}
5569 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5570
5571 @item -@var{offset}
5572 @itemx +@var{offset}
5573 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5574 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5575 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5576 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5577 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5578 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5579 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5580 linespec.
5581
5582 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5583 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5584
5585 @item @var{function}
5586 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5587 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5588
5589 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5590 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5591 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5592 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5593 functions in different source files.
5594
5595 @item *@var{address}
5596 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5597 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5598 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5599 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5600 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5601 source files.
5602
5603 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5604 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5605 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5606 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5607 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5608 of @var{address}:
5609
5610 @table @code
5611 @item @var{expression}
5612 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5613
5614 @item @var{funcaddr}
5615 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5616 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5617 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5618 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5619 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5620 (although the Pascal form also works).
5621
5622 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5623 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5624
5625 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5626 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5627 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5628 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5629 functions with identical names in different source files.
5630 @end table
5631
5632 @end table
5633
5634
5635 @node Edit
5636 @section Editing Source Files
5637 @cindex editing source files
5638
5639 @kindex edit
5640 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5641 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5642 The editing program of your choice
5643 is invoked with the current line set to
5644 the active line in the program.
5645 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5646 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5647
5648 @table @code
5649 @item edit @var{location}
5650 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5651 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5652 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5653 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5654 command most commonly used:
5655
5656 @table @code
5657 @item edit @var{number}
5658 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5659
5660 @item edit @var{function}
5661 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5662 @end table
5663
5664 @end table
5665
5666 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5667 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5668 @footnote{
5669 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5670 following command-line syntax:
5671 @smallexample
5672 ex +@var{number} file
5673 @end smallexample
5674 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5675 the file where to start editing.}.
5676 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5677 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5678 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5679 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5680 @smallexample
5681 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5682 export EDITOR
5683 gdb @dots{}
5684 @end smallexample
5685 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5686 @smallexample
5687 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5688 gdb @dots{}
5689 @end smallexample
5690
5691 @node Search
5692 @section Searching Source Files
5693 @cindex searching source files
5694
5695 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5696 regular expression.
5697
5698 @table @code
5699 @kindex search
5700 @kindex forward-search
5701 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5702 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5703 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5704 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5705 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5706 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5707 @code{fo}.
5708
5709 @kindex reverse-search
5710 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5711 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5712 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5713 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5714 this command as @code{rev}.
5715 @end table
5716
5717 @node Source Path
5718 @section Specifying Source Directories
5719
5720 @cindex source path
5721 @cindex directories for source files
5722 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5723 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5724 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5725 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5726 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5727 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5728 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5729
5730 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5731 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5732 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5733 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5734 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5735 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5736 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5737 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5738 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5739 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5740 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5741
5742 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5743 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5744 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5745 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5746 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5747 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5748
5749 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5750 source files.
5751
5752 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5753 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5754 each line is in the file.
5755
5756 @kindex directory
5757 @kindex dir
5758 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5759 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5760 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5761
5762 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5763 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5764
5765 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5766 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5767 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5768 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5769 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5770 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5771 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5772 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5773 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5774 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5775 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5776 name to look up the sources.
5777
5778 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5779 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5780 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5781 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5782 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5783 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5784 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5785 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5786
5787 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5788 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5789 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5790 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5791 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5792 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5793 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5794
5795 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5796 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5797 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5798 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5799 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5800 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5801 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5802 command.
5803
5804 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5805 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5806 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5807 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5808 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5809 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5810 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5811
5812 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
5813 @cindex default source path substitution
5814 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
5815 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
5816 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
5817 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
5818 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
5819 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
5820 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
5821 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
5822 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
5823 together.
5824
5825 @table @code
5826 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5827 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5828 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5829 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5830 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5831 part of absolute file names) or
5832 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5833 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5834
5835 @kindex cdir
5836 @kindex cwd
5837 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5838 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5839 @cindex compilation directory
5840 @cindex current directory
5841 @cindex working directory
5842 @cindex directory, current
5843 @cindex directory, compilation
5844 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5845 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5846 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5847 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5848 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5849 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5850
5851 @item directory
5852 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5853
5854 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5855 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5856
5857 @item show directories
5858 @kindex show directories
5859 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5860
5861 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5862 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5863 @kindex set substitute-path
5864 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5865 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5866 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5867
5868 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5869 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5870
5871 @smallexample
5872 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5873 @end smallexample
5874
5875 @noindent
5876 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5877 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5878 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5879
5880 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5881 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5882 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5883 the substitution.
5884
5885 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5886
5887 @smallexample
5888 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5889 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5890 @end smallexample
5891
5892 @noindent
5893 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5894 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5895 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5896 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5897
5898
5899 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5900 @kindex unset substitute-path
5901 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5902 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5903 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5904
5905 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5906
5907 @item show substitute-path [path]
5908 @kindex show substitute-path
5909 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5910 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5911
5912 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5913 rules.
5914
5915 @end table
5916
5917 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5918 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5919 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5920
5921 @enumerate
5922 @item
5923 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5924
5925 @item
5926 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5927 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5928 directories in one command.
5929 @end enumerate
5930
5931 @node Machine Code
5932 @section Source and Machine Code
5933 @cindex source line and its code address
5934
5935 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5936 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5937 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
5938 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
5939 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5940 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5941 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5942 well as hex.
5943
5944 @table @code
5945 @kindex info line
5946 @item info line @var{linespec}
5947 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5948 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5949 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5950 @end table
5951
5952 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5953 the object code for the first line of function
5954 @code{m4_changequote}:
5955
5956 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5957 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5958 @smallexample
5959 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5960 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5961 @end smallexample
5962
5963 @noindent
5964 @cindex code address and its source line
5965 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5966 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5967 @smallexample
5968 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5969 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5970 @end smallexample
5971
5972 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5973 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5974 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5975 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5976 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5977 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5978 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5979 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5980 Variables}).
5981
5982 @table @code
5983 @kindex disassemble
5984 @cindex assembly instructions
5985 @cindex instructions, assembly
5986 @cindex machine instructions
5987 @cindex listing machine instructions
5988 @item disassemble
5989 @itemx disassemble /m
5990 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5991 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5992 the @code{/m} modifier.
5993 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5994 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5995 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5996 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5997 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5998 @end table
5999
6000 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6001 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6002
6003 @smallexample
6004 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
6005 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6006 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6007 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6008 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6009 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6010 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6011 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6012 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6013 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6014 End of assembler dump.
6015 @end smallexample
6016
6017 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
6018
6019 @smallexample
6020 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6021 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6022 5 @{
6023 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
6024 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6025 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6026 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6027 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6028
6029 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6030 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6031 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6032
6033 7 return 0;
6034 8 @}
6035 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6036 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
6037 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
6038
6039 End of assembler dump.
6040 @end smallexample
6041
6042 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6043 mnemonics or other syntax.
6044
6045 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6046 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6047 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6048 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6049 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6050
6051 @table @code
6052 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6053 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6054 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6055 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6056 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6057 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6058
6059 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6060 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6061 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6062 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6063
6064 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6065 @item show disassembly-flavor
6066 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6067 @end table
6068
6069 @table @code
6070 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6071 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6072 @item set disassemble-next-line
6073 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6074 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble next source line
6075 when execution stops. If ON, GDB will display disassembly of the next
6076 source line when execution of the program being debugged stops.
6077 If AUTO (which is the default), or there's no line info to determine
6078 the source line of the next instruction, display disassembly of next
6079 instruction instead.
6080 @end table
6081
6082
6083 @node Data
6084 @chapter Examining Data
6085
6086 @cindex printing data
6087 @cindex examining data
6088 @kindex print
6089 @kindex inspect
6090 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6091 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6092 @c different window or something like that.
6093 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6094 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6095 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6096 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6097 Different Languages}).
6098
6099 @table @code
6100 @item print @var{expr}
6101 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6102 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6103 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6104 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6105 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6106 Formats}.
6107
6108 @item print
6109 @itemx print /@var{f}
6110 @cindex reprint the last value
6111 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6112 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6113 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6114 @end table
6115
6116 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6117 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6118 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6119
6120 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6121 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6122 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6123 Table}.
6124
6125 @menu
6126 * Expressions:: Expressions
6127 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6128 * Variables:: Program variables
6129 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6130 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6131 * Memory:: Examining memory
6132 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6133 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6134 * Value History:: Value history
6135 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6136 * Registers:: Registers
6137 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6138 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6139 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6140 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6141 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6142 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6143 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6144 character set than GDB does
6145 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6146 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6147 @end menu
6148
6149 @node Expressions
6150 @section Expressions
6151
6152 @cindex expressions
6153 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6154 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6155 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6156 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6157 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6158 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6159 @ref{Compilation}.
6160
6161 @cindex arrays in expressions
6162 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6163 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6164 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6165 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6166 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6167 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6168
6169 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6170 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6171 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6172 languages.
6173
6174 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6175 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6176
6177 @cindex casts, in expressions
6178 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6179 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6180 at that address in memory.
6181 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6182
6183 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6184 to programming languages:
6185
6186 @table @code
6187 @item @@
6188 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6189 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6190
6191 @item ::
6192 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6193 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6194
6195 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6196 @cindex type casting memory
6197 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6198 @cindex casts, to view memory
6199 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6200 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6201 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6202 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6203 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6204 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6205 @end table
6206
6207 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6208 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6209 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6210
6211 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6212 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6213 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6214 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6215 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6216 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6217 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6218
6219 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6220 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6221 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6222 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6223 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6224 as well.
6225
6226 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6227 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6228 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6229 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6230 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6231 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6232 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6233 choices.
6234
6235 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6236 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6237 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6238
6239 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6240 @smallexample
6241 @group
6242 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6243 [0] cancel
6244 [1] all
6245 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6246 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6247 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6248 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6249 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6250 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6251 > 2 4 6
6252 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6253 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6254 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6255 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6256 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6257 breakpoints.
6258 (@value{GDBP})
6259 @end group
6260 @end smallexample
6261
6262 @table @code
6263 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6264 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6265 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6266
6267 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6268 is ambiguous.
6269
6270 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6271 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6272 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6273 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6274 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6275 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6276 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6277 in the use of the menu.
6278
6279 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6280 when an ambiguity is detected.
6281
6282 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6283 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6284
6285 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6286 @item show multiple-symbols
6287 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6288 @end table
6289
6290 @node Variables
6291 @section Program Variables
6292
6293 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6294 in your program.
6295
6296 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6297 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6298
6299 @itemize @bullet
6300 @item
6301 global (or file-static)
6302 @end itemize
6303
6304 @noindent or
6305
6306 @itemize @bullet
6307 @item
6308 visible according to the scope rules of the
6309 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6310 @end itemize
6311
6312 @noindent This means that in the function
6313
6314 @smallexample
6315 foo (a)
6316 int a;
6317 @{
6318 bar (a);
6319 @{
6320 int b = test ();
6321 bar (b);
6322 @}
6323 @}
6324 @end smallexample
6325
6326 @noindent
6327 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6328 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6329 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6330 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6331
6332 @cindex variable name conflict
6333 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6334 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6335 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6336 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6337 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6338 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6339 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6340
6341 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6342 @ifnotinfo
6343 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6344 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6345 @end ifnotinfo
6346 @smallexample
6347 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6348 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6349 @end smallexample
6350
6351 @noindent
6352 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6353 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6354 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6355 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6356
6357 @smallexample
6358 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6359 @end smallexample
6360
6361 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6362 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6363 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6364 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6365 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6366 @c conflict?? --mew
6367
6368 @cindex wrong values
6369 @cindex variable values, wrong
6370 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6371 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6372 @quotation
6373 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6374 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6375 scope, and just before exit.
6376 @end quotation
6377 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6378 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6379 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6380 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6381 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6382 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6383 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6384 variable definitions may be gone.
6385
6386 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6387 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6388 when compiling.
6389
6390 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6391 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6392 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6393 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6394 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6395 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6396 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6397
6398 @smallexample
6399 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6400 @end smallexample
6401
6402 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6403 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6404 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6405 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6406 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6407 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6408 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6409 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6410 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6411 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6412 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6413
6414 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6415 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6416 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6417 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6418
6419 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6420 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6421 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6422 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6423 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6424 For program code
6425
6426 @smallexample
6427 char var0[] = "A";
6428 signed char var1[] = "A";
6429 @end smallexample
6430
6431 You get during debugging
6432 @smallexample
6433 (gdb) print var0
6434 $1 = "A"
6435 (gdb) print var1
6436 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6437 @end smallexample
6438
6439 @node Arrays
6440 @section Artificial Arrays
6441
6442 @cindex artificial array
6443 @cindex arrays
6444 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6445 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6446 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6447 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6448 program.
6449
6450 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6451 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6452 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6453 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6454 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6455 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6456 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6457 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6458 example. If a program says
6459
6460 @smallexample
6461 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6462 @end smallexample
6463
6464 @noindent
6465 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6466
6467 @smallexample
6468 p *array@@len
6469 @end smallexample
6470
6471 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6472 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6473 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6474 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6475 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6476
6477 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6478 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6479 The value need not be in memory:
6480 @smallexample
6481 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6482 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6483 @end smallexample
6484
6485 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6486 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6487 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6488 @smallexample
6489 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6490 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6491 @end smallexample
6492
6493 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6494 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6495 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6496 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6497 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6498 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6499 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6500 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6501 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6502 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 set $i = 0
6506 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6507 @key{RET}
6508 @key{RET}
6509 @dots{}
6510 @end smallexample
6511
6512 @node Output Formats
6513 @section Output Formats
6514
6515 @cindex formatted output
6516 @cindex output formats
6517 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6518 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6519 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6520 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6521 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6522
6523 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6524 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6525 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6526 letters supported are:
6527
6528 @table @code
6529 @item x
6530 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6531 hexadecimal.
6532
6533 @item d
6534 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6535
6536 @item u
6537 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6538
6539 @item o
6540 Print as integer in octal.
6541
6542 @item t
6543 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6544 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6545 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6546 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6547
6548 @item a
6549 @cindex unknown address, locating
6550 @cindex locate address
6551 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6552 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6553 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6554
6555 @smallexample
6556 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6557 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6558 @end smallexample
6559
6560 @noindent
6561 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6562 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6563
6564 @item c
6565 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6566 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6567 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6568 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6569
6570 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6571 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6572 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6573 data.
6574
6575 @item f
6576 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6577 using typical floating point syntax.
6578
6579 @item s
6580 @cindex printing strings
6581 @cindex printing byte arrays
6582 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6583 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6584 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6585 natural types.
6586
6587 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6588 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6589 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6590 array.
6591 @end table
6592
6593 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6594
6595 @smallexample
6596 p/x $pc
6597 @end smallexample
6598
6599 @noindent
6600 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6601 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6602
6603 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6604 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6605 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6606
6607 @node Memory
6608 @section Examining Memory
6609
6610 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6611 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6612
6613 @cindex examining memory
6614 @table @code
6615 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6616 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6617 @itemx x @var{addr}
6618 @itemx x
6619 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6620 @end table
6621
6622 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6623 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6624 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6625 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6626 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6627
6628 @table @r
6629 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6630 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6631 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6632 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6633 @c 4.1.2.
6634
6635 @item @var{f}, the display format
6636 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6637 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6638 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6639 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6640 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6641
6642 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6643 The unit size is any of
6644
6645 @table @code
6646 @item b
6647 Bytes.
6648 @item h
6649 Halfwords (two bytes).
6650 @item w
6651 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6652 @item g
6653 Giant words (eight bytes).
6654 @end table
6655
6656 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6657 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6658 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6659
6660 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6661 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6662 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6663 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6664 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6665 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6666 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6667 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6668 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6669 a value from memory).
6670 @end table
6671
6672 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6673 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6674 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6675 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6676 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6677
6678 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6679 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6680 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6681 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6682 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6683
6684 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6685 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6686 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6687 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6688 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6689 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6690 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6691 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6692 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6693
6694 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6695 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6696 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6697 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6698 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6699 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6700 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6701
6702 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6703 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6704 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6705 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6706 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6707 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6708 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6709 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6710 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6711
6712 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6713 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6714 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6715
6716 @cindex remote memory comparison
6717 @cindex verify remote memory image
6718 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6719 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6720 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6721 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6722 situations.
6723
6724 @table @code
6725 @kindex compare-sections
6726 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6727 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6728 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6729 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6730 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6731 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6732 remote request.
6733 @end table
6734
6735 @node Auto Display
6736 @section Automatic Display
6737 @cindex automatic display
6738 @cindex display of expressions
6739
6740 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6741 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6742 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6743 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6744 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6745 The automatic display looks like this:
6746
6747 @smallexample
6748 2: foo = 38
6749 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6750 @end smallexample
6751
6752 @noindent
6753 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6754 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6755 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6756 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6757 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6758 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6759
6760 @table @code
6761 @kindex display
6762 @item display @var{expr}
6763 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6764 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6765
6766 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6767
6768 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6769 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6770 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6771 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6772 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6773
6774 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6775 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6776 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6777 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6778 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6779 @end table
6780
6781 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6782 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6783 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6784
6785 @table @code
6786 @kindex delete display
6787 @kindex undisplay
6788 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6789 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6790 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6791
6792 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6793 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6794
6795 @kindex disable display
6796 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6797 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6798 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6799 enabled again later.
6800
6801 @kindex enable display
6802 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6803 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6804 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6805
6806 @item display
6807 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6808 done when your program stops.
6809
6810 @kindex info display
6811 @item info display
6812 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6813 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6814 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6815 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6816 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6817 @end table
6818
6819 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6820 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6821 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6822 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6823 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6824 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6825 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6826 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6827 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6828 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6829 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6830
6831 @node Print Settings
6832 @section Print Settings
6833
6834 @cindex format options
6835 @cindex print settings
6836 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6837 and symbols are printed.
6838
6839 @noindent
6840 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6841
6842 @table @code
6843 @kindex set print
6844 @item set print address
6845 @itemx set print address on
6846 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6847 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6848 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6849 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6850 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6851 @code{set print address on}:
6852
6853 @smallexample
6854 @group
6855 (@value{GDBP}) f
6856 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6857 at input.c:530
6858 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6859 @end group
6860 @end smallexample
6861
6862 @item set print address off
6863 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6864 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6865
6866 @smallexample
6867 @group
6868 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6869 (@value{GDBP}) f
6870 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6871 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6872 @end group
6873 @end smallexample
6874
6875 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6876 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6877 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6878 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6879
6880 @kindex show print
6881 @item show print address
6882 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6883 @end table
6884
6885 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6886 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6887 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6888 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6889 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6890 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6891 it prints a symbolic address:
6892
6893 @table @code
6894 @item set print symbol-filename on
6895 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6896 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6897 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6898 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6899
6900 @item set print symbol-filename off
6901 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6902 default.
6903
6904 @item show print symbol-filename
6905 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6906 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6907 @end table
6908
6909 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6910 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6911 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6912
6913 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6914 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6915
6916 @table @code
6917 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6918 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6919 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6920 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6921 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6922 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6923
6924 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6925 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6926 symbolic address.
6927 @end table
6928
6929 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6930 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6931 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6932 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6933 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6934 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6935 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6936 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6937
6938 @smallexample
6939 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6940 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6941 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6942 @end smallexample
6943
6944 @quotation
6945 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6946 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6947 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6948 @end quotation
6949
6950 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6951
6952 @table @code
6953 @item set print array
6954 @itemx set print array on
6955 @cindex pretty print arrays
6956 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6957 but uses more space. The default is off.
6958
6959 @item set print array off
6960 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6961
6962 @item show print array
6963 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6964 arrays.
6965
6966 @cindex print array indexes
6967 @item set print array-indexes
6968 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6969 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6970 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6971 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6972
6973 @item set print array-indexes off
6974 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6975
6976 @item show print array-indexes
6977 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6978 arrays.
6979
6980 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6981 @cindex number of array elements to print
6982 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6983 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6984 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6985 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6986 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6987 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6988 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6989
6990 @item show print elements
6991 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6992 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6993
6994 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6995 @kindex set print frame-arguments
6996 @cindex printing frame argument values
6997 @cindex print all frame argument values
6998 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6999 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7000 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7001 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7002 values are:
7003
7004 @table @code
7005 @item all
7006 The values of all arguments are printed.
7007
7008 @item scalars
7009 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7010 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7011 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7012 only scalar arguments are shown:
7013
7014 @smallexample
7015 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7016 at frame-args.c:23
7017 @end smallexample
7018
7019 @item none
7020 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7021 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7022
7023 @smallexample
7024 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7025 at frame-args.c:23
7026 @end smallexample
7027 @end table
7028
7029 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7030 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7031 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7032 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7033 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7034 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7035 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7036 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7037 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7038 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7039
7040 @item show print frame-arguments
7041 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7042
7043 @item set print repeats
7044 @cindex repeated array elements
7045 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7046 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7047 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7048 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7049 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7050 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7051 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7052
7053 @item show print repeats
7054 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7055 elements.
7056
7057 @item set print null-stop
7058 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7059 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7060 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7061 contain only short strings.
7062 The default is off.
7063
7064 @item show print null-stop
7065 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7066 @sc{null} character.
7067
7068 @item set print pretty on
7069 @cindex print structures in indented form
7070 @cindex indentation in structure display
7071 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7072 per line, like this:
7073
7074 @smallexample
7075 @group
7076 $1 = @{
7077 next = 0x0,
7078 flags = @{
7079 sweet = 1,
7080 sour = 1
7081 @},
7082 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7083 @}
7084 @end group
7085 @end smallexample
7086
7087 @item set print pretty off
7088 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7089
7090 @smallexample
7091 @group
7092 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7093 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7094 @end group
7095 @end smallexample
7096
7097 @noindent
7098 This is the default format.
7099
7100 @item show print pretty
7101 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7102
7103 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7104 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7105 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7106 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7107 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7108 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7109 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7110 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7111
7112 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7113 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7114 international character sets, and is the default.
7115
7116 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7117 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7118
7119 @item set print union on
7120 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7121 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7122 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7123
7124 @item set print union off
7125 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7126 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7127 instead.
7128
7129 @item show print union
7130 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7131 structures and other unions.
7132
7133 For example, given the declarations
7134
7135 @smallexample
7136 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7137 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7138 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7139 Bug_forms;
7140
7141 struct thing @{
7142 Species it;
7143 union @{
7144 Tree_forms tree;
7145 Bug_forms bug;
7146 @} form;
7147 @};
7148
7149 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7150 @end smallexample
7151
7152 @noindent
7153 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7154
7155 @smallexample
7156 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7157 @end smallexample
7158
7159 @noindent
7160 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7161
7162 @smallexample
7163 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7164 @end smallexample
7165
7166 @noindent
7167 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7168 and in Pascal.
7169 @end table
7170
7171 @need 1000
7172 @noindent
7173 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7174
7175 @table @code
7176 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7177 @item set print demangle
7178 @itemx set print demangle on
7179 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7180 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7181 linkage. The default is on.
7182
7183 @item show print demangle
7184 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7185
7186 @item set print asm-demangle
7187 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7188 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7189 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7190 The default is off.
7191
7192 @item show print asm-demangle
7193 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7194 or demangled form.
7195
7196 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7197 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7198 @kindex set demangle-style
7199 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7200 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7201 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7202
7203 @table @code
7204 @item auto
7205 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7206
7207 @item gnu
7208 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7209 This is the default.
7210
7211 @item hp
7212 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7213
7214 @item lucid
7215 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7216
7217 @item arm
7218 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7219 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7220 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7221 require further enhancement to permit that.
7222
7223 @end table
7224 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7225
7226 @item show demangle-style
7227 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7228
7229 @item set print object
7230 @itemx set print object on
7231 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7232 @cindex display derived types
7233 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7234 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7235 the virtual function table.
7236
7237 @item set print object off
7238 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7239 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7240
7241 @item show print object
7242 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7243
7244 @item set print static-members
7245 @itemx set print static-members on
7246 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7247 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7248
7249 @item set print static-members off
7250 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7251
7252 @item show print static-members
7253 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7254
7255 @item set print pascal_static-members
7256 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7257 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7258 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7259 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7260
7261 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7262 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7263
7264 @item show print pascal_static-members
7265 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7266
7267 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7268 @item set print vtbl
7269 @itemx set print vtbl on
7270 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7271 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7272 @cindex VTBL display
7273 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7274 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7275 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7276
7277 @item set print vtbl off
7278 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7279
7280 @item show print vtbl
7281 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7282 @end table
7283
7284 @node Value History
7285 @section Value History
7286
7287 @cindex value history
7288 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7289 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7290 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7291 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7292 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7293 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7294 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7295 symbol table.
7296
7297 @cindex @code{$}
7298 @cindex @code{$$}
7299 @cindex history number
7300 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7301 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7302 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7303 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7304 history number.
7305
7306 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7307 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7308 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7309 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7310 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7311 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7312 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7313
7314 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7315 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7316
7317 @smallexample
7318 p *$
7319 @end smallexample
7320
7321 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7322 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7323
7324 @smallexample
7325 p *$.next
7326 @end smallexample
7327
7328 @noindent
7329 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7330 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7331
7332 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7333 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7334
7335 @smallexample
7336 print x
7337 set x=5
7338 @end smallexample
7339
7340 @noindent
7341 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7342 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7343
7344 @table @code
7345 @kindex show values
7346 @item show values
7347 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7348 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7349 values} does not change the history.
7350
7351 @item show values @var{n}
7352 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7353
7354 @item show values +
7355 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7356 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7357 @end table
7358
7359 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7360 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7361
7362 @node Convenience Vars
7363 @section Convenience Variables
7364
7365 @cindex convenience variables
7366 @cindex user-defined variables
7367 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7368 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7369 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7370 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7371 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7372
7373 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7374 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7375 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7376 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7377 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7378
7379 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7380 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7381 For example:
7382
7383 @smallexample
7384 set $foo = *object_ptr
7385 @end smallexample
7386
7387 @noindent
7388 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7389 @code{object_ptr}.
7390
7391 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7392 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7393 value with another assignment at any time.
7394
7395 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7396 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7397 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7398 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7399
7400 @table @code
7401 @kindex show convenience
7402 @cindex show all user variables
7403 @item show convenience
7404 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7405 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7406
7407 @kindex init-if-undefined
7408 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7409 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7410 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7411 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7412 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7413 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7414 override default values used in a command script.
7415
7416 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7417 any side-effects do not occur.
7418 @end table
7419
7420 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7421 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7422 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7423
7424 @smallexample
7425 set $i = 0
7426 print bar[$i++]->contents
7427 @end smallexample
7428
7429 @noindent
7430 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7431
7432 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7433 values likely to be useful.
7434
7435 @table @code
7436 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7437 @item $_
7438 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7439 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7440 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7441 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7442 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7443 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7444 to the type of @code{$__}.
7445
7446 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7447 @item $__
7448 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7449 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7450 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7451
7452 @item $_exitcode
7453 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7454 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7455 the program being debugged terminates.
7456
7457 @item $_siginfo
7458 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
7459 The variable @code{$_siginfo} is bound to extra signal information
7460 inspection (@pxref{extra signal information}).
7461 @end table
7462
7463 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7464 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7465 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7466
7467 @cindex convenience functions
7468 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
7469 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
7470 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
7471 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
7472 @value{GDBN}.
7473
7474 @table @code
7475 @item help function
7476 @kindex help function
7477 @cindex show all convenience functions
7478 Print a list of all convenience functions.
7479 @end table
7480
7481 @node Registers
7482 @section Registers
7483
7484 @cindex registers
7485 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7486 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7487 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7488 your machine.
7489
7490 @table @code
7491 @kindex info registers
7492 @item info registers
7493 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7494 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7495
7496 @kindex info all-registers
7497 @cindex floating point registers
7498 @item info all-registers
7499 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7500 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7501
7502 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7503 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7504 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7505 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7506 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7507 @end table
7508
7509 @cindex stack pointer register
7510 @cindex program counter register
7511 @cindex process status register
7512 @cindex frame pointer register
7513 @cindex standard registers
7514 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7515 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7516 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7517 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7518 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7519 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7520 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7521 you could print the program counter in hex with
7522
7523 @smallexample
7524 p/x $pc
7525 @end smallexample
7526
7527 @noindent
7528 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7529
7530 @smallexample
7531 x/i $pc
7532 @end smallexample
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7536 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7537 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7538 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7539 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7540 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7541 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7542
7543 @smallexample
7544 set $sp += 4
7545 @end smallexample
7546
7547 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7548 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7549 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7550 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7551 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7552 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7553 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7554
7555 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7556 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7557 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7558 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7559 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7560 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7561 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7562
7563 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7564 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7565 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7566 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7567 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7568 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7569 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7570 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7571 prints the data in both formats.
7572
7573 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7574 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7575 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7576 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7577 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7578 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7579 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7580
7581 @smallexample
7582 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7583 $1 = @{
7584 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7585 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7586 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7587 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7588 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7589 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7590 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7591 @}
7592 @end smallexample
7593
7594 @noindent
7595 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7596 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7597 value to a @code{struct} member:
7598
7599 @smallexample
7600 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7601 @end smallexample
7602
7603 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7604 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7605 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7606 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7607 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7608 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7609
7610 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7611 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7612 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7613 frame makes no difference.
7614
7615 @node Floating Point Hardware
7616 @section Floating Point Hardware
7617 @cindex floating point
7618
7619 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7620 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7621
7622 @table @code
7623 @kindex info float
7624 @item info float
7625 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7626 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7627 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7628 the ARM and x86 machines.
7629 @end table
7630
7631 @node Vector Unit
7632 @section Vector Unit
7633 @cindex vector unit
7634
7635 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7636 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7637
7638 @table @code
7639 @kindex info vector
7640 @item info vector
7641 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7642 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7643 @end table
7644
7645 @node OS Information
7646 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7647 @cindex OS information
7648
7649 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7650 you debug your program.
7651
7652 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7653 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7654 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7655 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7656 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7657 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7658 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7659 structure.
7660
7661 @table @code
7662 @item info udot
7663 @kindex info udot
7664 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7665 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7666 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7667 the @code{examine} command.
7668 @end table
7669
7670 @cindex auxiliary vector
7671 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7672 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7673 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7674 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7675 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7676 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7677 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7678 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7679 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7680 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7681 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7682 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7683
7684 @table @code
7685 @kindex info auxv
7686 @item info auxv
7687 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7688 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7689 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7690 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7691 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7692 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7693 an unrecognized tag.
7694 @end table
7695
7696 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
7697 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
7698 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
7699 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
7700
7701 @table @code
7702 @kindex info os processes
7703 @item info os processes
7704 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
7705 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
7706 the command corresponding to the process.
7707 @end table
7708
7709 @node Memory Region Attributes
7710 @section Memory Region Attributes
7711 @cindex memory region attributes
7712
7713 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7714 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7715 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7716 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7717 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7718 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7719 user can override the fetched regions.
7720
7721 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7722 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7723 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7724 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7725 all memory.
7726
7727 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7728 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7729
7730 @table @code
7731 @kindex mem
7732 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7733 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7734 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7735 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7736 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7737 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7738
7739 @item mem auto
7740 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7741 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7742
7743 @kindex delete mem
7744 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7745 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7746 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7747
7748 @kindex disable mem
7749 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7750 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7751 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7752 It may be enabled again later.
7753
7754 @kindex enable mem
7755 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7756 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7757
7758 @kindex info mem
7759 @item info mem
7760 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7761 for each region:
7762
7763 @table @emph
7764 @item Memory Region Number
7765 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7766 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7767 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7768
7769 @item Lo Address
7770 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7771
7772 @item Hi Address
7773 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7774
7775 @item Attributes
7776 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7777 @end table
7778 @end table
7779
7780
7781 @subsection Attributes
7782
7783 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7784 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7785 write accesses to a memory region.
7786
7787 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7788 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7789 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7790
7791 @table @code
7792 @item ro
7793 Memory is read only.
7794 @item wo
7795 Memory is write only.
7796 @item rw
7797 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7798 @end table
7799
7800 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7801 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7802 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7803 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7804 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7805
7806 @table @code
7807 @item 8
7808 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7809 @item 16
7810 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7811 @item 32
7812 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7813 @item 64
7814 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7815 @end table
7816
7817 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7818 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7819 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7820 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7821 @c
7822 @c @table @code
7823 @c @item hwbreak
7824 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7825 @c @item swbreak (default)
7826 @c @end table
7827
7828 @subsubsection Data Cache
7829 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7830 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7831 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7832 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7833 registers.
7834
7835 @table @code
7836 @item cache
7837 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7838 @item nocache
7839 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7840 @end table
7841
7842 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7843 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7844 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7845 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7846 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7847
7848 @table @code
7849 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7850 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7851 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7852 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7853 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7854 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7855 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7856 The default value is @code{on}.
7857 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7858 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7859 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7860 @end table
7861
7862
7863 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7864 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7865 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7866 @c
7867 @c @table @code
7868 @c @item verify
7869 @c @item noverify (default)
7870 @c @end table
7871
7872 @node Dump/Restore Files
7873 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7874 @cindex dump/restore files
7875 @cindex append data to a file
7876 @cindex dump data to a file
7877 @cindex restore data from a file
7878
7879 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7880 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7881 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7882 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7883 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7884 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7885 files.
7886
7887 @table @code
7888
7889 @kindex dump
7890 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7891 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7892 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7893 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7894
7895 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7896 @table @code
7897 @item binary
7898 Raw binary form.
7899 @item ihex
7900 Intel hex format.
7901 @item srec
7902 Motorola S-record format.
7903 @item tekhex
7904 Tektronix Hex format.
7905 @end table
7906
7907 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7908 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7909 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7910 form.
7911
7912 @kindex append
7913 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7914 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7915 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7916 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7917 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7918
7919 @kindex restore
7920 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7921 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7922 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7923 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7924 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7925
7926 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7927 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7928 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7929 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7930 from that location.
7931
7932 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7933 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7934 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7935 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7936
7937 @end table
7938
7939 @node Core File Generation
7940 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7941 @cindex dump core from inferior
7942
7943 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7944 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7945 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7946 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7947 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7948 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7949 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7950
7951 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7952 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7953 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7954
7955 @table @code
7956 @kindex gcore
7957 @kindex generate-core-file
7958 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7959 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7960 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7961 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7962 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7963 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7964
7965 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7966 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7967 @end table
7968
7969 @node Character Sets
7970 @section Character Sets
7971 @cindex character sets
7972 @cindex charset
7973 @cindex translating between character sets
7974 @cindex host character set
7975 @cindex target character set
7976
7977 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7978 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7979 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7980 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7981 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7982 @dfn{target character set}.
7983
7984 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7985 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7986 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7987 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7988 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7989 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7990 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7991 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7992 character and string literals in expressions.
7993
7994 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7995 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7996 target-charset} command, described below.
7997
7998 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7999 support:
8000
8001 @table @code
8002 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
8003 @kindex set target-charset
8004 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
8005 list of supported target character sets, type
8006 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8007
8008 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
8009 @kindex set host-charset
8010 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
8011
8012 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
8013 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
8014 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
8015 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
8016 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
8017
8018 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
8019 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8020 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
8021
8022 @item set charset @var{charset}
8023 @kindex set charset
8024 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
8025 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8026 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
8027 for both host and target.
8028
8029 @item show charset
8030 @kindex show charset
8031 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
8032
8033 @item show host-charset
8034 @kindex show host-charset
8035 Show the name of the current host character set.
8036
8037 @item show target-charset
8038 @kindex show target-charset
8039 Show the name of the current target character set.
8040
8041 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
8042 @kindex set target-wide-charset
8043 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
8044 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
8045 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
8046 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8047
8048 @item show target-wide-charset
8049 @kindex show target-wide-charset
8050 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
8051 @end table
8052
8053 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8054 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8055 @file{charset-test.c}:
8056
8057 @smallexample
8058 #include <stdio.h>
8059
8060 char ascii_hello[]
8061 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8062 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8063 char ibm1047_hello[]
8064 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8065 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8066
8067 main ()
8068 @{
8069 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8070 @}
8071 @end smallexample
8072
8073 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8074 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8075 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8076
8077 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8078
8079 @smallexample
8080 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8081 $ gdb -nw charset-test
8082 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8083 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8084 @dots{}
8085 (@value{GDBP})
8086 @end smallexample
8087
8088 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8089 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8090 strings:
8091
8092 @smallexample
8093 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8094 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8095 (@value{GDBP})
8096 @end smallexample
8097
8098 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8099 initial character set:
8100 @smallexample
8101 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8102 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8103 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8104 (@value{GDBP})
8105 @end smallexample
8106
8107 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8108 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8109 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8110 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8111 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8112
8113 @smallexample
8114 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8115 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8116 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8117 $2 = 72 'H'
8118 (@value{GDBP})
8119 @end smallexample
8120
8121 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8122 literals you use in expressions:
8123
8124 @smallexample
8125 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8126 $3 = 43 '+'
8127 (@value{GDBP})
8128 @end smallexample
8129
8130 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8131 character.
8132
8133 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8134 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8135 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8136
8137 @smallexample
8138 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8139 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8140 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8141 $5 = 200 '\310'
8142 (@value{GDBP})
8143 @end smallexample
8144
8145 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8146 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8147
8148 @smallexample
8149 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8150 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8151 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8152 @end smallexample
8153
8154 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8155 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8156 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8157 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8158 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8159
8160 @smallexample
8161 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8162 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8163 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8164 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8165 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8166 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8167 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8168 $7 = 72 '\110'
8169 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8170 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8171 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8172 $9 = 200 'H'
8173 (@value{GDBP})
8174 @end smallexample
8175
8176 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8177 string literals you use in expressions:
8178
8179 @smallexample
8180 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8181 $10 = 78 '+'
8182 (@value{GDBP})
8183 @end smallexample
8184
8185 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8186 character.
8187
8188 @node Caching Remote Data
8189 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8190 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8191
8192 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
8193 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8194 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8195 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
8196 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
8197 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
8198 volatile registers are in use.
8199
8200 @table @code
8201 @kindex set remotecache
8202 @item set remotecache on
8203 @itemx set remotecache off
8204 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
8205 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
8206
8207 @kindex show remotecache
8208 @item show remotecache
8209 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
8210
8211 @kindex info dcache
8212 @item info dcache
8213 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8214 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
8215 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
8216 state (invalid, dirty, valid). This command is useful for debugging
8217 the data cache operation.
8218 @end table
8219
8220 @node Searching Memory
8221 @section Search Memory
8222 @cindex searching memory
8223
8224 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8225 @code{find} command.
8226
8227 @table @code
8228 @kindex find
8229 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8230 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8231 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8232 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8233 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8234 @end table
8235
8236 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8237 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8238
8239 @table @r
8240 @item @var{s}, search query size
8241 The size of each search query value.
8242
8243 @table @code
8244 @item b
8245 bytes
8246 @item h
8247 halfwords (two bytes)
8248 @item w
8249 words (four bytes)
8250 @item g
8251 giant words (eight bytes)
8252 @end table
8253
8254 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8255 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8256 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8257
8258 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8259 value's type in the current language.
8260 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8261 pattern as a mixture of types.
8262 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8263 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8264 which is typically four bytes.
8265
8266 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8267 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8268 @end table
8269
8270 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8271 (@code{"}).
8272 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8273 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8274
8275 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8276 number of matches found.
8277
8278 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8279 @samp{$_}.
8280 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8281
8282 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8283
8284 @smallexample
8285 void
8286 hello ()
8287 @{
8288 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8289 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8290 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8291 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8292 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8293 @}
8294 @end smallexample
8295
8296 @noindent
8297 you get during debugging:
8298
8299 @smallexample
8300 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8301 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8302 1 pattern found
8303 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8304 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8305 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8306 2 patterns found
8307 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8308 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8309 1 pattern found
8310 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8311 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8312 1 pattern found
8313 (gdb) print $numfound
8314 $1 = 1
8315 (gdb) print $_
8316 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8317 @end smallexample
8318
8319 @node Macros
8320 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8321
8322 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8323 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8324 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8325 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8326 where it was defined.
8327
8328 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8329 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8330 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8331 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8332
8333 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8334 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8335 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8336 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8337 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8338 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8339 see @ref{List}.
8340
8341 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8342 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8343 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8344
8345 @table @code
8346
8347 @kindex macro expand
8348 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8349 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8350 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8351 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8352 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8353 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8354 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8355 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8356 it can be any string of tokens.
8357
8358 @kindex macro exp1
8359 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8360 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8361 @cindex expand macro once
8362 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8363 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8364 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8365 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8366 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8367 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8368 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8369 can be any string of tokens.
8370
8371 @kindex info macro
8372 @cindex macro definition, showing
8373 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8374 @item info macro @var{macro}
8375 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8376 source location where that definition was established.
8377
8378 @kindex macro define
8379 @cindex user-defined macros
8380 @cindex defining macros interactively
8381 @cindex macros, user-defined
8382 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8383 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8384 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8385 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8386 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8387 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8388 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8389 @var{arglist}.
8390
8391 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8392 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8393 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8394 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8395 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8396
8397 @kindex macro undef
8398 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8399 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8400 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8401 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8402 in the program being debugged.
8403
8404 @kindex macro list
8405 @item macro list
8406 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8407 @end table
8408
8409 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8410 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8411 show our source files:
8412
8413 @smallexample
8414 $ cat sample.c
8415 #include <stdio.h>
8416 #include "sample.h"
8417
8418 #define M 42
8419 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8420
8421 main ()
8422 @{
8423 #define N 28
8424 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8425 #undef N
8426 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8427 #define N 1729
8428 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8429 @}
8430 $ cat sample.h
8431 #define Q <
8432 $
8433 @end smallexample
8434
8435 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8436 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8437 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8438 information.
8439
8440 @smallexample
8441 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8442 $
8443 @end smallexample
8444
8445 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8446
8447 @smallexample
8448 $ gdb -nw sample
8449 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8450 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8451 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8452 (@value{GDBP})
8453 @end smallexample
8454
8455 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8456 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8457 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8458
8459 @smallexample
8460 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8461 3
8462 4 #define M 42
8463 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8464 6
8465 7 main ()
8466 8 @{
8467 9 #define N 28
8468 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8469 11 #undef N
8470 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8471 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8472 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8473 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8474 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8475 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8476 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8477 #define Q <
8478 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8479 expands to: (42 + 1)
8480 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8481 expands to: once (M + 1)
8482 (@value{GDBP})
8483 @end smallexample
8484
8485 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8486 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8487 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8488 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8489
8490 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8491 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8492
8493 @smallexample
8494 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8495 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8496 (@value{GDBP}) run
8497 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8498
8499 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8500 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8501 (@value{GDBP})
8502 @end smallexample
8503
8504 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8505
8506 @smallexample
8507 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8508 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8509 #define N 28
8510 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8511 expands to: 28 < 42
8512 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8513 $1 = 1
8514 (@value{GDBP})
8515 @end smallexample
8516
8517 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8518 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8519 thereof) in force at each point:
8520
8521 @smallexample
8522 (@value{GDBP}) next
8523 Hello, world!
8524 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8525 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8526 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8527 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8528 (@value{GDBP}) next
8529 We're so creative.
8530 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8531 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8532 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8533 #define N 1729
8534 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8535 expands to: 1729 < 42
8536 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8537 $2 = 0
8538 (@value{GDBP})
8539 @end smallexample
8540
8541
8542 @node Tracepoints
8543 @chapter Tracepoints
8544 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8545 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8546
8547 @cindex tracepoints
8548 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8549 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8550 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8551 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8552 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8553 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8554 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8555
8556 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8557 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8558 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8559 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8560 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8561 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8562 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8563 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8564 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8565 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8566 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8567
8568 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8569 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8570 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8571 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8572 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8573 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8574 Packets}.
8575
8576 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8577
8578 @menu
8579 * Set Tracepoints::
8580 * Analyze Collected Data::
8581 * Tracepoint Variables::
8582 @end menu
8583
8584 @node Set Tracepoints
8585 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8586
8587 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8588 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
8589 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
8590 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
8591 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
8592 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
8593 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
8594
8595 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8596 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8597 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8598 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8599 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8600 tracepoint was hit.
8601
8602 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Conditional
8603 expressions and ignore counts on tracepoints have no effect, and
8604 tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} commands when they are
8605 hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific either.
8606
8607 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8608 conditions and actions.
8609
8610 @menu
8611 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8612 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8613 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8614 * Tracepoint Actions::
8615 * Listing Tracepoints::
8616 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8617 @end menu
8618
8619 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8620 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8621
8622 @table @code
8623 @cindex set tracepoint
8624 @kindex trace
8625 @item trace @var{location}
8626 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8627 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
8628 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
8629 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
8630 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
8631 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
8632 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
8633 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
8634 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
8635
8636 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8637
8638 @smallexample
8639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8640
8641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8642
8643 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8644
8645 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8646
8647 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8648 @end smallexample
8649
8650 @noindent
8651 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8652
8653 @vindex $tpnum
8654 @cindex last tracepoint number
8655 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8656 @cindex tracepoint number
8657 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8658 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8659
8660 @kindex delete tracepoint
8661 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8662 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8663 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8664 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
8665 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
8666
8667 Examples:
8668
8669 @smallexample
8670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8671
8672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8673 @end smallexample
8674
8675 @noindent
8676 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8677 @end table
8678
8679 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8680 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8681
8682 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
8683
8684 @table @code
8685 @kindex disable tracepoint
8686 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8687 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8688 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8689 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8690 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8691
8692 @kindex enable tracepoint
8693 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8694 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8695 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8696 run.
8697 @end table
8698
8699 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8700 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8701
8702 @table @code
8703 @kindex passcount
8704 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8705 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8706 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8707 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8708 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8709 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8710 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8711 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8712 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8713 user.
8714
8715 Examples:
8716
8717 @smallexample
8718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8719 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8720
8721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8722 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8729 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8730 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8731 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8732 @end smallexample
8733 @end table
8734
8735 @node Tracepoint Actions
8736 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8737
8738 @table @code
8739 @kindex actions
8740 @cindex tracepoint actions
8741 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8742 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8743 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8744 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8745 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8746 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8747 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8748 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8749 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8750 @code{while-stepping}.
8751
8752 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8753 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8754 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8755
8756 @smallexample
8757 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8758
8759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8760
8761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8762 @end smallexample
8763
8764 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8765 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8766 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8767 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8768 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8769 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8770 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8771 @code{end} command.
8772
8773 @smallexample
8774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8776 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8777 > collect bar,baz
8778 > collect $regs
8779 > while-stepping 12
8780 > collect $fp, $sp
8781 > end
8782 end
8783 @end smallexample
8784
8785 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8786 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8787 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8788 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8789 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8790 special arguments are supported:
8791
8792 @table @code
8793 @item $regs
8794 collect all registers
8795
8796 @item $args
8797 collect all function arguments
8798
8799 @item $locals
8800 collect all local variables.
8801 @end table
8802
8803 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8804 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8805 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8806
8807 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8808 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8809
8810 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8811 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8812 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8813 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8814 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8815 its own @code{end} command):
8816
8817 @smallexample
8818 > while-stepping 12
8819 > collect $regs, myglobal
8820 > end
8821 >
8822 @end smallexample
8823
8824 @noindent
8825 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8826 @code{stepping}.
8827 @end table
8828
8829 @node Listing Tracepoints
8830 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8831
8832 @table @code
8833 @kindex info tracepoints
8834 @kindex info tp
8835 @cindex information about tracepoints
8836 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8837 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
8838 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
8839 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
8840 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
8841 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
8842
8843 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
8844 tracing:
8845
8846 @itemize @bullet
8847 @item
8848 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8849 @item
8850 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8851 @item
8852 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command. The actions
8853 are prefixed with an @samp{A} so as to distinguish them from commands.
8854 @end itemize
8855
8856 @smallexample
8857 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8858 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
8859 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
8860 pass count 1200
8861 step count 20
8862 A while-stepping 20
8863 A collect globfoo, $regs
8864 A end
8865 A collect globfoo2
8866 A end
8867 (@value{GDBP})
8868 @end smallexample
8869
8870 @noindent
8871 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8872 @end table
8873
8874 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8875 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8876
8877 @table @code
8878 @kindex tstart
8879 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8880 @cindex collected data discarded
8881 @item tstart
8882 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8883 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8884 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8885 experiment.
8886
8887 @kindex tstop
8888 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8889 @item tstop
8890 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8891 stops collecting data.
8892
8893 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8894 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8895 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8896
8897 @kindex tstatus
8898 @cindex status of trace data collection
8899 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8900 @item tstatus
8901 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8902 collection.
8903 @end table
8904
8905 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8906
8907 @smallexample
8908 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8910 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8911 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8912 > while-stepping 11
8913 > collect $regs
8914 > end
8915 > end
8916 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8917 [time passes @dots{}]
8918 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8919 @end smallexample
8920
8921
8922 @node Analyze Collected Data
8923 @section Using the Collected Data
8924
8925 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8926 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8927 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8928 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8929 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8930 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8931 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8932 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8933 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8934 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8935 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8936 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8937 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8938 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8939 the buffer will fail.
8940
8941 @menu
8942 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8943 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8944 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8945 @end menu
8946
8947 @node tfind
8948 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8949
8950 @kindex tfind
8951 @cindex select trace snapshot
8952 @cindex find trace snapshot
8953 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8954 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8955 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8956 snapshot is selected.
8957
8958 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8959
8960 @table @code
8961 @item tfind start
8962 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8963 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8964
8965 @item tfind none
8966 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8967
8968 @item tfind end
8969 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8970
8971 @item tfind
8972 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8973
8974 @item tfind -
8975 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8976 retracing earlier steps.
8977
8978 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8979 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8980 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8981 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8982 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8983
8984 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8985 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8986 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8987 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8988 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8989
8990 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8991 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8992 addresses.
8993
8994 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8995 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8996 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8997
8998 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8999 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
9000 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
9001 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
9002 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
9003 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
9004 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
9005 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
9006 @end table
9007
9008 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
9009 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
9010 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
9011 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
9012 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
9013 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
9014 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
9015 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
9016 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
9017 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
9018 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
9019 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
9020 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
9021 tracepoint as the current one.
9022
9023 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
9024 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
9025 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
9026 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
9027 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
9028
9029 @smallexample
9030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9031 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9032 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
9033 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
9034 > tfind
9035 > end
9036
9037 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
9038 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
9039 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
9040 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
9041 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
9042 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
9043 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
9044 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
9045 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
9046 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
9047 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
9048 @end smallexample
9049
9050 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
9051 the buffer:
9052
9053 @smallexample
9054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9055 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9056 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
9057 > tfind line
9058 > end
9059
9060 Frame 0, X = 1
9061 Frame 7, X = 2
9062 Frame 13, X = 255
9063 @end smallexample
9064
9065 @node tdump
9066 @subsection @code{tdump}
9067 @kindex tdump
9068 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
9069 @cindex tracepoint data, display
9070
9071 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
9072 the current trace snapshot.
9073
9074 @smallexample
9075 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
9076 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9077 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
9078 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
9079 > end
9080
9081 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9082
9083 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
9084 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
9085 at gdb_test.c:444
9086 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
9087
9088 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
9089 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
9090 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
9091 d1 0x18 24
9092 d2 0x80 128
9093 d3 0x33 51
9094 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
9095 d5 0x22 34
9096 d6 0xe0 224
9097 d7 0x380035 3670069
9098 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
9099 a1 0x3000668 50333288
9100 a2 0x100 256
9101 a3 0x322000 3284992
9102 a4 0x3000698 50333336
9103 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
9104 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
9105 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
9106 ps 0x0 0
9107 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
9108 fpcontrol 0x0 0
9109 fpstatus 0x0 0
9110 fpiaddr 0x0 0
9111 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
9112 p1 = (void *) 0x11
9113 p2 = (void *) 0x22
9114 p3 = (void *) 0x33
9115 p4 = (void *) 0x44
9116 p5 = (void *) 0x55
9117 p6 = (void *) 0x66
9118 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
9119
9120 (@value{GDBP})
9121 @end smallexample
9122
9123 @node save-tracepoints
9124 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
9125 @kindex save-tracepoints
9126 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
9127
9128 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
9129 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
9130 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
9131 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
9132 Files}).
9133
9134 @node Tracepoint Variables
9135 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
9136 @cindex tracepoint variables
9137 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
9138
9139 @table @code
9140 @vindex $trace_frame
9141 @item (int) $trace_frame
9142 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
9143 snapshot is selected.
9144
9145 @vindex $tracepoint
9146 @item (int) $tracepoint
9147 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
9148
9149 @vindex $trace_line
9150 @item (int) $trace_line
9151 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
9152
9153 @vindex $trace_file
9154 @item (char []) $trace_file
9155 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
9156
9157 @vindex $trace_func
9158 @item (char []) $trace_func
9159 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
9160 @end table
9161
9162 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
9163 use @code{output} instead.
9164
9165 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
9166 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
9167 data.
9168
9169 @smallexample
9170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9171
9172 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
9173 > output $trace_file
9174 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
9175 > tfind
9176 > end
9177 @end smallexample
9178
9179 @node Overlays
9180 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
9181 @cindex overlays
9182
9183 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
9184 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
9185 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
9186 use overlays.
9187
9188 @menu
9189 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
9190 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
9191 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
9192 mapped by asking the inferior.
9193 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
9194 @end menu
9195
9196 @node How Overlays Work
9197 @section How Overlays Work
9198 @cindex mapped overlays
9199 @cindex unmapped overlays
9200 @cindex load address, overlay's
9201 @cindex mapped address
9202 @cindex overlay area
9203
9204 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
9205 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9206 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9207 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9208 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9209
9210 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9211 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9212 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9213 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9214 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9215 largest overlay as well.
9216
9217 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9218 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9219 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9220 there.
9221
9222 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9223 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9224 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9225
9226 @smallexample
9227 @group
9228 Data Instruction Larger
9229 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9230 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9231 | | | | | |
9232 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9233 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9234 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9235 | and heap | | | | | |
9236 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9237 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9238 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
9239 | | | | | |
9240 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
9241 address | | | | | |
9242 | overlay | <-' | | |
9243 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
9244 | | <---. | | load address
9245 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
9246 | | | |
9247 +-----------+ | |
9248 +-----------+
9249 | |
9250 +-----------+
9251
9252 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
9253 @end group
9254 @end smallexample
9255
9256 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9257 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9258 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9259 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9260 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9261 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9262 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9263 program and the overlay area.
9264
9265 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9266 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9267 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9268 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9269 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9270 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9271 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9272
9273 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9274 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9275 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9276
9277 @itemize @bullet
9278
9279 @item
9280 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9281 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9282 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9283 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9284
9285 @item
9286 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9287 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9288 your program's performance.
9289
9290 @item
9291 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9292 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9293 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9294 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9295 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9296 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9297 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9298
9299 @item
9300 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9301 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9302 instruction and data spaces.
9303
9304 @end itemize
9305
9306 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9307 improved in many ways:
9308
9309 @itemize @bullet
9310
9311 @item
9312 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9313 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9314 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9315 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9316 area in the usual way.
9317
9318 @item
9319 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9320 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9321
9322 @item
9323 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9324 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9325 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9326 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9327 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9328 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9329 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9330
9331 @end itemize
9332
9333
9334 @node Overlay Commands
9335 @section Overlay Commands
9336
9337 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9338 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9339 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9340 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9341 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9342 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9343
9344 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9345 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9346
9347 @table @code
9348 @item overlay off
9349 @kindex overlay
9350 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9351 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9352 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9353 overlay support is disabled.
9354
9355 @item overlay manual
9356 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9357 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9358 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9359 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9360 commands described below.
9361
9362 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9363 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9364 @cindex map an overlay
9365 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9366 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9367 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9368 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9369 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9370 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9371
9372 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9373 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9374 @cindex unmap an overlay
9375 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9376 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9377 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9378 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9379
9380 @item overlay auto
9381 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9382 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9383 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9384 Overlay Debugging}.
9385
9386 @item overlay load-target
9387 @itemx overlay load
9388 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9389 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9390 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9391 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9392 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9393 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9394
9395 @item overlay list-overlays
9396 @itemx overlay list
9397 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9398 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9399 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9400
9401 @end table
9402
9403 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9404 of the function the address falls in:
9405
9406 @smallexample
9407 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9408 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9409 @end smallexample
9410 @noindent
9411 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9412 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9413 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9414 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9415
9416 @smallexample
9417 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9418 No sections are mapped.
9419 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9420 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9421 @end smallexample
9422 @noindent
9423 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9424 name normally:
9425
9426 @smallexample
9427 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9428 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9429 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9430 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9431 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9432 @end smallexample
9433
9434 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9435 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9436 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9437 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9438 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9439
9440 @itemize @bullet
9441 @item
9442 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9443 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9444 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9445 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9446 @item
9447 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9448 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9449 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9450 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9451 breakpoints properly.
9452 @end itemize
9453
9454
9455 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9456 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9457 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9458
9459 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9460 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9461 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9462 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9463 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9464 current state of the overlays.
9465
9466 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9467 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9468
9469 @table @asis
9470
9471 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9472 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9473
9474 @smallexample
9475 struct
9476 @{
9477 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9478 unsigned long vma;
9479
9480 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9481 unsigned long size;
9482
9483 /* The overlay's load address. */
9484 unsigned long lma;
9485
9486 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9487 zero otherwise. */
9488 unsigned long mapped;
9489 @}
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 @item @code{_novlys}:
9493 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9494 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9495
9496 @end table
9497
9498 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9499 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9500 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9501 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9502 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9503 currently mapped.
9504
9505 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9506 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9507 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9508 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9509 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9510 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9511 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9512 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9513 are not being executed.
9514
9515 @node Overlay Sample Program
9516 @section Overlay Sample Program
9517 @cindex overlay example program
9518
9519 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9520 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9521 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9522 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9523 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9524 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9525 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9526
9527 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9528 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9529 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9530 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9531
9532 @table @file
9533 @item overlays.c
9534 The main program file.
9535 @item ovlymgr.c
9536 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9537 @item foo.c
9538 @itemx bar.c
9539 @itemx baz.c
9540 @itemx grbx.c
9541 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9542 @item d10v.ld
9543 @itemx m32r.ld
9544 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9545 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9546 @end table
9547
9548 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9549 cross-compiler like this:
9550
9551 @smallexample
9552 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9553 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9554 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9555 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9556 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9557 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9558 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9559 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9560 @end smallexample
9561
9562 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9563 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9564 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9565
9566
9567 @node Languages
9568 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9569 @cindex languages
9570
9571 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9572 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9573 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9574 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9575 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9576 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9577
9578 @cindex working language
9579 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9580 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9581 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9582 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9583 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9584 language}.
9585
9586 @menu
9587 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9588 * Show:: Displaying the language
9589 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9590 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9591 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9592 @end menu
9593
9594 @node Setting
9595 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9596
9597 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9598 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9599 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9600 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9601 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9602 are printed, etc.
9603
9604 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9605 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9606 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9607 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9608 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9609 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9610 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9611 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9612 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9613 Displaying the Language}.
9614
9615 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9616 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9617 another language. In that case, make the
9618 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9619 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9620 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9621
9622 @menu
9623 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9624 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9625 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9626 @end menu
9627
9628 @node Filenames
9629 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9630
9631 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9632 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9633
9634 @table @file
9635 @item .ada
9636 @itemx .ads
9637 @itemx .adb
9638 @itemx .a
9639 Ada source file.
9640
9641 @item .c
9642 C source file
9643
9644 @item .C
9645 @itemx .cc
9646 @itemx .cp
9647 @itemx .cpp
9648 @itemx .cxx
9649 @itemx .c++
9650 C@t{++} source file
9651
9652 @item .m
9653 Objective-C source file
9654
9655 @item .f
9656 @itemx .F
9657 Fortran source file
9658
9659 @item .mod
9660 Modula-2 source file
9661
9662 @item .s
9663 @itemx .S
9664 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9665 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9666 @end table
9667
9668 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9669 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9670
9671 @node Manually
9672 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9673
9674 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9675 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9676 your program.
9677
9678 @kindex set language
9679 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9680 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9681 a language, such as
9682 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9683 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9684
9685 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9686 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9687 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9688 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9689 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9690 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9691 command such as:
9692
9693 @smallexample
9694 print a = b + c
9695 @end smallexample
9696
9697 @noindent
9698 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9699 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9700 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9701 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9702
9703 @node Automatically
9704 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9705
9706 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9707 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9708 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9709 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9710 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9711 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9712 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9713 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9714 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9715
9716 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9717 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9718 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9719 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9720 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9721
9722 @node Show
9723 @section Displaying the Language
9724
9725 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9726 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9727
9728 @table @code
9729 @item show language
9730 @kindex show language
9731 Display the current working language. This is the
9732 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9733 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9734
9735 @item info frame
9736 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9737 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9738 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9739 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9740 information listed here.
9741
9742 @item info source
9743 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9744 Display the source language of this source file.
9745 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9746 information listed here.
9747 @end table
9748
9749 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9750 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9751 with a language explicitly:
9752
9753 @table @code
9754 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9755 @kindex set extension-language
9756 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9757 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9758
9759 @item info extensions
9760 @kindex info extensions
9761 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9762 @end table
9763
9764 @node Checks
9765 @section Type and Range Checking
9766
9767 @quotation
9768 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9769 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9770 section documents the intended facilities.
9771 @end quotation
9772 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9773
9774 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9775 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9776 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9777 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9778 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9779 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9780 errors when your program is running.
9781
9782 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9783 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9784 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9785 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9786 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9787 automatically based on your program's source language.
9788 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9789 settings of supported languages.
9790
9791 @menu
9792 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9793 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9794 @end menu
9795
9796 @cindex type checking
9797 @cindex checks, type
9798 @node Type Checking
9799 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9800
9801 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9802 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9803 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9804 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9805
9806 @smallexample
9807 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9808 @exdent but
9809 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9810 @end smallexample
9811
9812 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9813 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9814
9815 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9816 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9817 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9818 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9819 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9820 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9821 also issues a warning.
9822
9823 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9824 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9825 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9826 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9827 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9828 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9829
9830 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9831 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9832 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9833 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9834 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9835 details on specific languages.
9836
9837 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9838
9839 @kindex set check type
9840 @kindex show check type
9841 @table @code
9842 @item set check type auto
9843 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9844 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9845 each language.
9846
9847 @item set check type on
9848 @itemx set check type off
9849 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9850 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9851 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9852 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9853 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9854
9855 @item set check type warn
9856 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9857 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9858 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9859 numbers and structures.
9860
9861 @item show type
9862 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9863 is setting it automatically.
9864 @end table
9865
9866 @cindex range checking
9867 @cindex checks, range
9868 @node Range Checking
9869 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9870
9871 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9872 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9873 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9874 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9875 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9876
9877 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9878 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9879 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9880 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9881
9882 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9883 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9884 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9885 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9886 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9887 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9888
9889 @smallexample
9890 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9891 @end smallexample
9892
9893 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9894 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9895 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9896
9897 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9898
9899 @kindex set check range
9900 @kindex show check range
9901 @table @code
9902 @item set check range auto
9903 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9904 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9905 each language.
9906
9907 @item set check range on
9908 @itemx set check range off
9909 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9910 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9911 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9912 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9913
9914 @item set check range warn
9915 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9916 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9917 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9918 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9919 systems).
9920
9921 @item show range
9922 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9923 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9924 @end table
9925
9926 @node Supported Languages
9927 @section Supported Languages
9928
9929 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9930 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9931 @c This is false ...
9932 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9933 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9934 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9935 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9936 language.
9937
9938 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9939 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9940 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9941 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9942 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9943 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9944 language reference or tutorial.
9945
9946 @menu
9947 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9948 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9949 * Fortran:: Fortran
9950 * Pascal:: Pascal
9951 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9952 * Ada:: Ada
9953 @end menu
9954
9955 @node C
9956 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9957
9958 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9959 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9960
9961 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9962 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9963 together.
9964
9965 @cindex C@t{++}
9966 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9967 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9968 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9969 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9970 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9971 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9972 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9973
9974 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9975 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9976 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9977 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9978 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9979 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9980
9981 @menu
9982 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9983 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9984 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9985 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9986 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9987 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9988 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9989 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9990 @end menu
9991
9992 @node C Operators
9993 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9994
9995 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9996
9997 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9998 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9999 often defined on groups of types.
10000
10001 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
10002
10003 @itemize @bullet
10004
10005 @item
10006 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
10007 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
10008
10009 @item
10010 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
10011 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
10012
10013 @item
10014 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
10015
10016 @item
10017 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
10018
10019 @end itemize
10020
10021 @noindent
10022 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
10023 in order of increasing precedence:
10024
10025 @table @code
10026 @item ,
10027 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
10028 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
10029 expression being the last expression evaluated.
10030
10031 @item =
10032 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
10033 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
10034
10035 @item @var{op}=
10036 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
10037 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
10038 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
10039 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
10040 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
10041
10042 @item ?:
10043 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
10044 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
10045 integral type.
10046
10047 @item ||
10048 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10049
10050 @item &&
10051 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10052
10053 @item |
10054 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10055
10056 @item ^
10057 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10058
10059 @item &
10060 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10061
10062 @item ==@r{, }!=
10063 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
10064 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
10065
10066 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
10067 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
10068 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
10069 and non-zero for true.
10070
10071 @item <<@r{, }>>
10072 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
10073
10074 @item @@
10075 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10076
10077 @item +@r{, }-
10078 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
10079 pointer types.
10080
10081 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
10082 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
10083 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
10084 integral types.
10085
10086 @item ++@r{, }--
10087 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
10088 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
10089 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
10090 operation takes place.
10091
10092 @item *
10093 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
10094 @code{++}.
10095
10096 @item &
10097 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
10098
10099 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
10100 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
10101 to examine the address
10102 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
10103 stored.
10104
10105 @item -
10106 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
10107 precedence as @code{++}.
10108
10109 @item !
10110 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10111 @code{++}.
10112
10113 @item ~
10114 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10115 @code{++}.
10116
10117
10118 @item .@r{, }->
10119 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
10120 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
10121 pointer based on the stored type information.
10122 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
10123
10124 @item .*@r{, }->*
10125 Dereferences of pointers to members.
10126
10127 @item []
10128 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
10129 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10130
10131 @item ()
10132 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10133
10134 @item ::
10135 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
10136 and @code{class} types.
10137
10138 @item ::
10139 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
10140 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
10141 above.
10142 @end table
10143
10144 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
10145 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
10146 predefined meaning.
10147
10148 @node C Constants
10149 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
10150
10151 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
10152
10153 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
10154 following ways:
10155
10156 @itemize @bullet
10157 @item
10158 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
10159 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
10160 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
10161 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
10162 @code{long} value.
10163
10164 @item
10165 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
10166 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
10167 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
10168 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
10169 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
10170 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
10171 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
10172 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
10173 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
10174 constant.
10175
10176 @item
10177 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
10178 integral equivalents.
10179
10180 @item
10181 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
10182 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
10183 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
10184 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
10185 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
10186 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
10187 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
10188 @samp{\n} for newline.
10189
10190 @item
10191 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
10192 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
10193 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
10194 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
10195 characters.
10196
10197 @item
10198 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
10199 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
10200
10201 @item
10202 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
10203 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
10204 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
10205 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10206 @end itemize
10207
10208 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10209 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10210
10211 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10212 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10213
10214 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10215 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10216 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10217 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10218 @quotation
10219 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10220 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10221 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10222 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10223 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10224 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10225 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10226 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10227 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10228 C@t{++} code.
10229 @end quotation
10230
10231 @enumerate
10232
10233 @cindex member functions
10234 @item
10235 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10236
10237 @smallexample
10238 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
10239 @end smallexample
10240
10241 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
10242 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
10243 @item
10244 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
10245 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
10246 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
10247 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
10248
10249 @cindex call overloaded functions
10250 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
10251 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
10252 @item
10253 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
10254 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10255 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10256 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10257 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10258 default arguments.
10259
10260 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10261 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10262 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10263 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10264 number of function arguments.
10265
10266 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10267 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10268 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10269
10270 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10271 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10272 @smallexample
10273 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10274 @end smallexample
10275
10276 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10277 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10278
10279 @cindex reference declarations
10280 @item
10281 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10282 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10283 dereferenced.
10284
10285 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10286 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10287 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10288 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10289 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10290
10291 @item
10292 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10293 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10294 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10295 necessary, for example in an expression like
10296 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10297 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10298 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10299 @end enumerate
10300
10301 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10302 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10303 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10304 invoking user-defined operators.
10305
10306 @node C Defaults
10307 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10308
10309 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10310
10311 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10312 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10313 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10314 selects the working language.
10315
10316 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10317 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10318 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10319 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10320 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10321 for further details.
10322
10323 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10324 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10325 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10326
10327 @node C Checks
10328 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10329
10330 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10331
10332 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10333 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10334 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10335
10336 @itemize @bullet
10337 @item
10338 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10339 enumerated tag.
10340
10341 @item
10342 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10343 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10344
10345 @ignore
10346 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10347 @c FIXME--beers?
10348 @item
10349 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10350 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10351 compilers.)
10352 @end ignore
10353 @end itemize
10354
10355 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10356 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10357 that is not itself an array.
10358
10359 @node Debugging C
10360 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10361
10362 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10363 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10364 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10365 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10366
10367 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10368 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10369 ,Expressions}.
10370
10371 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10372 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10373
10374 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10375
10376 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10377 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10378
10379 @table @code
10380 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10381 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10382 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10383 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10384 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10385 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10386
10387 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10388 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10389 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10390 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10391 classes.
10392 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10393
10394 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10395 @item catch throw
10396 @itemx catch catch
10397 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10398 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10399
10400 @cindex inheritance
10401 @item ptype @var{typename}
10402 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10403 @var{typename}.
10404 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10405
10406 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10407 @item set print demangle
10408 @itemx show print demangle
10409 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10410 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10411 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10412 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10413 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10414
10415 @item set print object
10416 @itemx show print object
10417 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10418 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10419
10420 @item set print vtbl
10421 @itemx show print vtbl
10422 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10423 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10424 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10425 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10426
10427 @kindex set overload-resolution
10428 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10429 @item set overload-resolution on
10430 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10431 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10432 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10433 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10434 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10435 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10436
10437 @item set overload-resolution off
10438 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10439 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10440 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10441 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10442 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10443 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10444 argument types.
10445
10446 @kindex show overload-resolution
10447 @item show overload-resolution
10448 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10449
10450 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10451 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10452 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10453 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10454 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10455 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10456 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10457 @end table
10458
10459 @node Decimal Floating Point
10460 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10461 @cindex decimal floating point format
10462
10463 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10464 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10465 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10466 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10467
10468 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10469 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10470 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10471 target.
10472
10473 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10474 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10475 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10476
10477 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10478 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10479 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10480
10481 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10482 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10483 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10484
10485 @node Objective-C
10486 @subsection Objective-C
10487
10488 @cindex Objective-C
10489 This section provides information about some commands and command
10490 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10491 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10492 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10493
10494 @menu
10495 * Method Names in Commands::
10496 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10497 @end menu
10498
10499 @node Method Names in Commands
10500 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10501
10502 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10503 names as line specifications:
10504
10505 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10506 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10507 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10508 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10509 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10510 @itemize
10511 @item @code{clear}
10512 @item @code{break}
10513 @item @code{info line}
10514 @item @code{jump}
10515 @item @code{list}
10516 @end itemize
10517
10518 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10519
10520 @smallexample
10521 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10522 @end smallexample
10523
10524 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10525 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10526 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10527 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10528 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10529 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10530 debugged, enter:
10531
10532 @smallexample
10533 break -[Fruit create]
10534 @end smallexample
10535
10536 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10537 enter:
10538
10539 @smallexample
10540 list +[NSText initialize]
10541 @end smallexample
10542
10543 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10544 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10545 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10546 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10547
10548 @smallexample
10549 break create
10550 @end smallexample
10551
10552 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10553 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10554 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10555 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10556 none apply.
10557
10558 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10559 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10560
10561 @smallexample
10562 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10563 @end smallexample
10564
10565 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10566 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10567 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10568 @kindex print-object
10569 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10570
10571 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10572
10573 @smallexample
10574 print -[@var{object} hash]
10575 @end smallexample
10576
10577 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10578 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10579 @noindent
10580 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10581 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10582 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10583 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10584 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10585 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10586
10587 @node Fortran
10588 @subsection Fortran
10589 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10590
10591 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10592 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10593
10594 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10595 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10596 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10597 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10598 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10599 underscore.
10600
10601 @menu
10602 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10603 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10604 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10605 @end menu
10606
10607 @node Fortran Operators
10608 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10609
10610 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10611
10612 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10613 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10614 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10615
10616 @table @code
10617 @item **
10618 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10619 of the second one.
10620
10621 @item :
10622 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10623 represent a section of array.
10624
10625 @item %
10626 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10627 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10628 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10629 union type.
10630 @end table
10631
10632 @node Fortran Defaults
10633 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10634
10635 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10636
10637 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10638 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10639 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10640 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10641
10642 @node Special Fortran Commands
10643 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10644
10645 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10646
10647 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10648 such as displaying common blocks.
10649
10650 @table @code
10651 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10652 @kindex info common
10653 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10654 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10655 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10656 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10657 printed.
10658 @end table
10659
10660 @node Pascal
10661 @subsection Pascal
10662
10663 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10664 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10665 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10666 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10667 syntax.
10668
10669 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10670 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10671 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10672
10673 @node Modula-2
10674 @subsection Modula-2
10675
10676 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10677
10678 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10679 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10680 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10681 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10682 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10683 table.
10684
10685 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10686 @menu
10687 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10688 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10689 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10690 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10691 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10692 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10693 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10694 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10695 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10696 @end menu
10697
10698 @node M2 Operators
10699 @subsubsection Operators
10700 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10701
10702 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10703 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10704 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10705 following definitions hold:
10706
10707 @itemize @bullet
10708
10709 @item
10710 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10711 their subranges.
10712
10713 @item
10714 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10715
10716 @item
10717 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10718
10719 @item
10720 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10721 @var{type}}.
10722
10723 @item
10724 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10725
10726 @item
10727 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10728
10729 @item
10730 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10731 @end itemize
10732
10733 @noindent
10734 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10735 increasing precedence:
10736
10737 @table @code
10738 @item ,
10739 Function argument or array index separator.
10740
10741 @item :=
10742 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10743 @var{value}.
10744
10745 @item <@r{, }>
10746 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10747 types.
10748
10749 @item <=@r{, }>=
10750 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10751 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10752 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10753
10754 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10755 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10756 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10757 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10758 comment character.
10759
10760 @item IN
10761 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10762 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10763
10764 @item OR
10765 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10766
10767 @item AND@r{, }&
10768 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10769
10770 @item @@
10771 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10772
10773 @item +@r{, }-
10774 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10775 and difference on set types.
10776
10777 @item *
10778 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10779 on set types.
10780
10781 @item /
10782 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10783 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10784
10785 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10786 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10787 precedence as @code{*}.
10788
10789 @item -
10790 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10791
10792 @item ^
10793 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10794
10795 @item NOT
10796 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10797 @code{^}.
10798
10799 @item .
10800 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10801 precedence as @code{^}.
10802
10803 @item []
10804 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10805
10806 @item ()
10807 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10808 as @code{^}.
10809
10810 @item ::@r{, }.
10811 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10812 @end table
10813
10814 @quotation
10815 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10816 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10817 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10818 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10819 @end quotation
10820
10821
10822 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10823 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10824 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10825
10826 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10827 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10828
10829 @table @var
10830
10831 @item a
10832 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10833
10834 @item c
10835 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10836
10837 @item i
10838 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10839
10840 @item m
10841 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10842 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10843 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10844
10845 @item n
10846 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10847
10848 @item r
10849 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10850
10851 @item t
10852 represents a type.
10853
10854 @item v
10855 represents a variable.
10856
10857 @item x
10858 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10859 explanation of the function for details.
10860 @end table
10861
10862 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10863
10864 @table @code
10865 @item ABS(@var{n})
10866 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10867
10868 @item CAP(@var{c})
10869 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10870 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10871
10872 @item CHR(@var{i})
10873 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10874
10875 @item DEC(@var{v})
10876 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10877
10878 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10879 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10880 new value.
10881
10882 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10883 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10884 set.
10885
10886 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10887 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10888
10889 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10890 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10891
10892 @item INC(@var{v})
10893 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10894
10895 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10896 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10897 new value.
10898
10899 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10900 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10901 there. Returns the new set.
10902
10903 @item MAX(@var{t})
10904 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10905
10906 @item MIN(@var{t})
10907 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10908
10909 @item ODD(@var{i})
10910 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10911
10912 @item ORD(@var{x})
10913 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10914 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10915 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10916 integral, character and enumerated types.
10917
10918 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10919 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10920
10921 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10922 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10923
10924 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10925 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10926
10927 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10928 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10929 @end table
10930
10931 @quotation
10932 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10933 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10934 an error.
10935 @end quotation
10936
10937 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10938 @node M2 Constants
10939 @subsubsection Constants
10940
10941 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10942 ways:
10943
10944 @itemize @bullet
10945
10946 @item
10947 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10948 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10949 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10950 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10951
10952 @item
10953 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10954 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10955 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10956 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10957 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10958 digits.
10959
10960 @item
10961 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10962 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10963 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10964 followed by a @samp{C}.
10965
10966 @item
10967 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10968 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10969 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10970 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10971 sequences.
10972
10973 @item
10974 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10975
10976 @item
10977 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10978 @code{FALSE}.
10979
10980 @item
10981 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10982
10983 @item
10984 Set constants are not yet supported.
10985 @end itemize
10986
10987 @node M2 Types
10988 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10989 @cindex Modula-2 types
10990
10991 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10992 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10993 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10994 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10995 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10996 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10997
10998 The first example contains the following section of code:
10999
11000 @smallexample
11001 VAR
11002 s: SET OF CHAR ;
11003 r: [20..40] ;
11004 @end smallexample
11005
11006 @noindent
11007 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
11008 @code{r} and @code{s}.
11009
11010 @smallexample
11011 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11012 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
11013 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11014 SET OF CHAR
11015 (@value{GDBP}) print r
11016 21
11017 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
11018 [20..40]
11019 @end smallexample
11020
11021 @noindent
11022 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
11023
11024 @smallexample
11025 VAR
11026 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
11027 @end smallexample
11028
11029 @noindent
11030 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
11031
11032 @smallexample
11033 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11034 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
11035 @end smallexample
11036
11037 @noindent
11038 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
11039 expressions using the debugger.
11040
11041 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
11042 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
11043
11044 @smallexample
11045 VAR
11046 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
11047 @end smallexample
11048
11049 @smallexample
11050 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11051 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
11052 @end smallexample
11053
11054 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
11055 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
11056 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
11057 above.
11058
11059 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
11060
11061 @smallexample
11062 TYPE
11063 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
11064 t = [blue..yellow] ;
11065 VAR
11066 s: t ;
11067 BEGIN
11068 s := blue ;
11069 @end smallexample
11070
11071 @noindent
11072 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
11073 and value of a variable.
11074
11075 @smallexample
11076 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11077 $1 = blue
11078 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
11079 type = [blue..yellow]
11080 @end smallexample
11081
11082 @noindent
11083 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
11084 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
11085 their @code{C} counterparts.
11086
11087 @smallexample
11088 VAR
11089 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11090 BEGIN
11091 s[1] := 1 ;
11092 @end smallexample
11093
11094 @smallexample
11095 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11096 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
11097 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11098 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11099 @end smallexample
11100
11101 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
11102 pointer types as shown in this example:
11103
11104 @smallexample
11105 VAR
11106 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11107 BEGIN
11108 NEW(s) ;
11109 s^[1] := 1 ;
11110 @end smallexample
11111
11112 @noindent
11113 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
11114
11115 @smallexample
11116 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11117 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11118 @end smallexample
11119
11120 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
11121 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
11122 types:
11123
11124 @smallexample
11125 TYPE
11126 foo = RECORD
11127 f1: CARDINAL ;
11128 f2: CHAR ;
11129 f3: myarray ;
11130 END ;
11131
11132 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
11133 myrange = [-2..2] ;
11134 VAR
11135 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
11136 @end smallexample
11137
11138 @noindent
11139 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
11140 below.
11141
11142 @smallexample
11143 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11144 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
11145 f1 : CARDINAL;
11146 f2 : CHAR;
11147 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
11148 END
11149 @end smallexample
11150
11151 @node M2 Defaults
11152 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
11153 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
11154
11155 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
11156 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
11157 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11158 selected the working language.
11159
11160 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
11161 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
11162 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
11163 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
11164
11165 @node Deviations
11166 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
11167 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
11168
11169 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
11170 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
11171
11172 @itemize @bullet
11173 @item
11174 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
11175 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
11176 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
11177 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
11178 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
11179 returned a pointer.)
11180
11181 @item
11182 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
11183 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
11184 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
11185 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
11186
11187 @item
11188 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
11189 argument.
11190
11191 @item
11192 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
11193 @end itemize
11194
11195 @node M2 Checks
11196 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
11197 @cindex Modula-2 checks
11198
11199 @quotation
11200 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
11201 range checking.
11202 @end quotation
11203 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
11204
11205 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11206
11207 @itemize @bullet
11208 @item
11209 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11210 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11211
11212 @item
11213 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11214 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11215 @end itemize
11216
11217 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11218 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11219
11220 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11221 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11222
11223 @node M2 Scope
11224 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11225 @cindex scope
11226 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11227 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11228 @ifinfo
11229 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11230 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11231 @end ifinfo
11232 @ifnotinfo
11233 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11234 @end ifnotinfo
11235
11236 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11237 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11238 similar syntax:
11239
11240 @smallexample
11241
11242 @var{module} . @var{id}
11243 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
11244 @end smallexample
11245
11246 @noindent
11247 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
11248 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
11249 identifier within your program, except another module.
11250
11251 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
11252 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
11253 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
11254 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11255
11256 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11257 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11258 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11259 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11260 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11261 @var{module}.
11262
11263 @node GDB/M2
11264 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11265
11266 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11267 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11268 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11269 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11270 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11271 analogue in Modula-2.
11272
11273 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11274 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11275 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11276 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11277 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11278 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11279
11280 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11281 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11282 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11283
11284 @node Ada
11285 @subsection Ada
11286 @cindex Ada
11287
11288 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11289 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11290 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11291 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11292 to be difficult.
11293
11294
11295 @cindex expressions in Ada
11296 @menu
11297 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11298 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11299 in @value{GDBN}.
11300 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11301 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11302 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11303 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
11304 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11305 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11306 @end menu
11307
11308 @node Ada Mode Intro
11309 @subsubsection Introduction
11310 @cindex Ada mode, general
11311
11312 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11313 syntax, with some extensions.
11314 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11315
11316 @itemize @bullet
11317 @item
11318 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11319 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11320 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11321 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11322
11323 @item
11324 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11325 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11326
11327 @item
11328 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11329 @end itemize
11330
11331 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11332 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11333 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11334 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11335 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11336
11337 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11338 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11339 was translated from an Ada source file.
11340
11341 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11342 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11343 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11344 middle (to allow based literals).
11345
11346 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11347 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11348 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11349 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11350 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11351 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11352
11353 @node Omissions from Ada
11354 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11355 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11356
11357 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11358
11359 @itemize @bullet
11360 @item
11361 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11362
11363 @itemize @minus
11364 @item
11365 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11366 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11367
11368 @item
11369 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11370
11371 @item
11372 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11373
11374 @item
11375 @t{'Tag}.
11376
11377 @item
11378 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11379 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11380
11381 @item
11382 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11383 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11384
11385 @item
11386 @t{'Address}.
11387 @end itemize
11388
11389 @item
11390 The names in
11391 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11392 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11393 not currently available.
11394
11395 @item
11396 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11397 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11398 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11399 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11400 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11401 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11402 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11403 indeterminate values.
11404
11405 @item
11406 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11407 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11408 are not implemented.
11409
11410 @item
11411 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11412 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11413 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11414 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11415 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11416
11417 @smallexample
11418 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11419 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11420 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11421 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11422 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11423 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11424 @end smallexample
11425
11426 Changing a
11427 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11428 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11429 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11430 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11431 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11432 declared to have a type such as:
11433
11434 @smallexample
11435 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11436 Id : Integer;
11437 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11438 end record;
11439 @end smallexample
11440
11441 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11442 assignments:
11443
11444 @smallexample
11445 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
11446 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11447 @end smallexample
11448
11449 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11450 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11451 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11452 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11453 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11454 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11455 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11456 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11457
11458 @item
11459 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11460
11461 @item
11462 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11463 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11464 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11465 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11466 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11467 the proper resolution.
11468
11469 @item
11470 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11471
11472 @item
11473 Entry calls are not implemented.
11474
11475 @item
11476 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11477 formats are not supported.
11478
11479 @item
11480 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11481
11482 @item
11483 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
11484 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
11485 context.
11486 Should your program
11487 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
11488 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
11489 @end itemize
11490
11491 @node Additions to Ada
11492 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11493 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11494
11495 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11496 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11497
11498 @itemize @bullet
11499 @item
11500 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11501 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11502 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11503 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11504 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11505 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11506 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11507 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11508
11509 @item
11510 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11511 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11512 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11513
11514 @item
11515 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11516 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11517
11518 @item
11519 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11520 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11521 @end itemize
11522
11523 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11524 additions specific to Ada:
11525
11526 @itemize @bullet
11527 @item
11528 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11529 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11530
11531 @smallexample
11532 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
11533 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
11534 @end smallexample
11535
11536 @item
11537 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11538 the value of its right-hand operand.
11539 This allows, for example,
11540 complex conditional breaks:
11541
11542 @smallexample
11543 (@value{GDBP}) break f
11544 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11545 @end smallexample
11546
11547 @item
11548 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11549 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11550 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11551 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11552 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11553 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11554 in strings. For example,
11555 @smallexample
11556 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11557 @end smallexample
11558 @noindent
11559 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11560 after each period.
11561
11562 @item
11563 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11564 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11565 to write
11566
11567 @smallexample
11568 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
11569 @end smallexample
11570
11571 @item
11572 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11573 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11574 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11575 of 3 might print as
11576
11577 @smallexample
11578 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11579 @end smallexample
11580
11581 @noindent
11582 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11583 clause.
11584
11585 @item
11586 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11587 multi-character subsequence of
11588 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11589 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11590 in place of @t{a'length}.
11591
11592 @item
11593 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11594 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11595 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11596 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11597 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11598 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11599 For example,
11600 @smallexample
11601 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11602 @end smallexample
11603
11604 @item
11605 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11606 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11607 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11608 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11609 object.
11610
11611 @end itemize
11612
11613 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11614 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11615
11616 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11617 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11618 before reaching the main procedure.
11619 As defined in the Ada Reference
11620 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11621 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11622 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11623 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11624
11625 @node Ada Tasks
11626 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
11627 @cindex Ada, tasking
11628
11629 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
11630 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
11631
11632 @table @code
11633 @kindex info tasks
11634 @item info tasks
11635 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
11636
11637
11638 @smallexample
11639 @iftex
11640 @leftskip=0.5cm
11641 @end iftex
11642 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11643 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11644 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11645 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
11646 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
11647 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
11648
11649 @end smallexample
11650
11651 @noindent
11652 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
11653 task currently being inspected.
11654
11655 @table @asis
11656 @item ID
11657 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
11658
11659 @item TID
11660 The Ada task ID.
11661
11662 @item P-ID
11663 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
11664
11665 @item Pri
11666 The base priority of the task.
11667
11668 @item State
11669 Current state of the task.
11670
11671 @table @code
11672 @item Unactivated
11673 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
11674 executing.
11675
11676 @item Runnable
11677 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
11678 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
11679
11680 @item Terminated
11681 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
11682 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
11683 terminated themselves.
11684
11685 @item Child Activation Wait
11686 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
11687
11688 @item Accept Statement
11689 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
11690
11691 @item Waiting on entry call
11692 The task is waiting on an entry call.
11693
11694 @item Async Select Wait
11695 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
11696 select statement.
11697
11698 @item Delay Sleep
11699 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
11700 alternative open.
11701
11702 @item Child Termination Wait
11703 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
11704 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
11705 waiting on a terminate Phase.
11706
11707 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
11708 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
11709 finish terminating.
11710
11711 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
11712 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
11713 @end table
11714
11715 @item Name
11716 Name of the task in the program.
11717
11718 @end table
11719
11720 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
11721 @item info task @var{taskno}
11722 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
11723 the following example:
11724 @smallexample
11725 @iftex
11726 @leftskip=0.5cm
11727 @end iftex
11728 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11729 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11730 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11731 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
11732 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
11733 Ada Task: 0x807c468
11734 Name: task_1
11735 Thread: 0x807f378
11736 Parent: 1 (main_task)
11737 Base Priority: 15
11738 State: Runnable
11739 @end smallexample
11740
11741 @item task
11742 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
11743 @cindex current Ada task ID
11744 This command prints the ID of the current task.
11745
11746 @smallexample
11747 @iftex
11748 @leftskip=0.5cm
11749 @end iftex
11750 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11751 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11752 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11753 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
11754 (@value{GDBP}) task
11755 [Current task is 2]
11756 @end smallexample
11757
11758 @item task @var{taskno}
11759 @cindex Ada task switching
11760 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
11761 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
11762 from the current task to the given task.
11763
11764 @smallexample
11765 @iftex
11766 @leftskip=0.5cm
11767 @end iftex
11768 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11769 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11770 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11771 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
11772 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
11773 [Switching to task 1]
11774 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11775 (@value{GDBP}) bt
11776 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11777 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
11778 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
11779 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
11780 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
11781 @end smallexample
11782
11783 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
11784 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
11785 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
11786 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
11787 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
11788 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
11789 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
11790 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
11791 in @ref{Specify Location}.
11792
11793 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
11794 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
11795 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
11796 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
11797 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
11798
11799 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
11800 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
11801 program.
11802
11803 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
11804 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
11805 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
11806
11807 For example,
11808
11809 @smallexample
11810 @iftex
11811 @leftskip=0.5cm
11812 @end iftex
11813 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11814 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11815 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11816 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
11817 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
11818 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
11819 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
11820 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
11821 (@value{GDBP}) cont
11822 Continuing.
11823 task # 1 running
11824 task # 2 running
11825
11826 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
11827 15 flush;
11828 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11829 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11830 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11831 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
11832 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
11833 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
11834 @end smallexample
11835 @end table
11836
11837 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
11838 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11839 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
11840
11841 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
11842 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
11843 the platform being used.
11844 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
11845 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
11846 as usual.
11847
11848 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
11849 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
11850 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
11851 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
11852 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
11853 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
11854
11855 @node Ada Glitches
11856 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11857 @cindex Ada, problems
11858
11859 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11860 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11861 @value{GDBN},
11862 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11863 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11864
11865 @itemize @bullet
11866 @item
11867 Currently, the debugger
11868 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11869 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11870 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11871 to get it printed properly.
11872
11873 @item
11874 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11875 storage are invisible to the debugger.
11876
11877 @item
11878 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11879 argument lists are treated as positional).
11880
11881 @item
11882 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11883
11884 @item
11885 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11886 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11887 the host machine.
11888
11889 @item
11890 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11891 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11892 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11893 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11894 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11895 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11896 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11897 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11898 you can usually resolve the confusion
11899 by qualifying the problematic names with package
11900 @code{Standard} explicitly.
11901 @end itemize
11902
11903 @node Unsupported Languages
11904 @section Unsupported Languages
11905
11906 @cindex unsupported languages
11907 @cindex minimal language
11908 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11909 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11910 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11911 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11912 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11913 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11914
11915 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11916 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11917 language.
11918
11919 @node Symbols
11920 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11921
11922 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11923 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11924 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11925 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11926 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11927 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11928 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11929
11930 @cindex symbol names
11931 @cindex names of symbols
11932 @cindex quoting names
11933 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11934 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11935 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11936 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11937 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11938 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11939 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11940 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11941
11942 @smallexample
11943 p 'foo.c'::x
11944 @end smallexample
11945
11946 @noindent
11947 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11948
11949 @table @code
11950 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11951 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11952 @kindex set case-sensitive
11953 @item set case-sensitive on
11954 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11955 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11956 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11957 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11958 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11959 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11960 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11961 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11962 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11963 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11964 case-insensitive matches.
11965
11966 @kindex show case-sensitive
11967 @item show case-sensitive
11968 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11969 lookups.
11970
11971 @kindex info address
11972 @cindex address of a symbol
11973 @item info address @var{symbol}
11974 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11975 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11976 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11977 is always stored.
11978
11979 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11980 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11981 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11982
11983 @kindex info symbol
11984 @cindex symbol from address
11985 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11986 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11987 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11988 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11989 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11990
11991 @smallexample
11992 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11993 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11994 @end smallexample
11995
11996 @noindent
11997 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11998 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11999
12000 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
12001 library containing the symbol is also printed:
12002
12003 @smallexample
12004 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
12005 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
12006 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
12007 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
12008 @end smallexample
12009
12010 @kindex whatis
12011 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
12012 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
12013 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
12014 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
12015 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
12016 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
12017 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
12018 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
12019 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
12020 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
12021 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12022
12023 @kindex ptype
12024 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
12025 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
12026 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
12027 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12028
12029 For example, for this variable declaration:
12030
12031 @smallexample
12032 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
12033 @end smallexample
12034
12035 @noindent
12036 the two commands give this output:
12037
12038 @smallexample
12039 @group
12040 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
12041 type = struct complex
12042 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
12043 type = struct complex @{
12044 double real;
12045 double imag;
12046 @}
12047 @end group
12048 @end smallexample
12049
12050 @noindent
12051 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
12052 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
12053
12054 @cindex incomplete type
12055 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
12056 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
12057 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
12058 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
12059 given these declarations:
12060
12061 @smallexample
12062 struct foo;
12063 struct foo *fooptr;
12064 @end smallexample
12065
12066 @noindent
12067 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
12068
12069 @smallexample
12070 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
12071 $1 = <incomplete type>
12072 @end smallexample
12073
12074 @noindent
12075 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
12076 completely specified.
12077
12078 @kindex info types
12079 @item info types @var{regexp}
12080 @itemx info types
12081 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
12082 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
12083 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
12084 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
12085 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
12086 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
12087 name is @code{value}.
12088
12089 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
12090 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
12091 lists all source files where a type is defined.
12092
12093 @kindex info scope
12094 @cindex local variables
12095 @item info scope @var{location}
12096 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
12097 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
12098 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
12099 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
12100 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
12101
12102 @smallexample
12103 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
12104 Scope for command_line_handler:
12105 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
12106 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
12107 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
12108 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
12109 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
12110 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
12111 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
12112 @end smallexample
12113
12114 @noindent
12115 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
12116 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
12117 collect}.
12118
12119 @kindex info source
12120 @item info source
12121 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
12122 the function containing the current point of execution:
12123 @itemize @bullet
12124 @item
12125 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
12126 @item
12127 the directory it was compiled in,
12128 @item
12129 its length, in lines,
12130 @item
12131 which programming language it is written in,
12132 @item
12133 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
12134 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
12135 @item
12136 whether the debugging information includes information about
12137 preprocessor macros.
12138 @end itemize
12139
12140
12141 @kindex info sources
12142 @item info sources
12143 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
12144 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
12145 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
12146
12147 @kindex info functions
12148 @item info functions
12149 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
12150
12151 @item info functions @var{regexp}
12152 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
12153 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
12154 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
12155 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
12156 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
12157 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
12158 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
12159
12160 @kindex info variables
12161 @item info variables
12162 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
12163 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
12164
12165 @item info variables @var{regexp}
12166 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
12167 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
12168 @var{regexp}.
12169
12170 @kindex info classes
12171 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
12172 @item info classes
12173 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
12174 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
12175 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12176 expression.
12177
12178 @kindex info selectors
12179 @item info selectors
12180 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
12181 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
12182 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12183 expression.
12184
12185 @ignore
12186 This was never implemented.
12187 @kindex info methods
12188 @item info methods
12189 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
12190 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
12191 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
12192 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
12193 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
12194 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
12195 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
12196 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
12197 @end ignore
12198
12199 @cindex reloading symbols
12200 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
12201 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
12202 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
12203 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
12204 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
12205
12206 @table @code
12207 @kindex set symbol-reloading
12208 @item set symbol-reloading on
12209 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
12210 object file with a particular name is seen again.
12211
12212 @item set symbol-reloading off
12213 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
12214 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
12215 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
12216 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
12217 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
12218 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
12219 name.
12220
12221 @kindex show symbol-reloading
12222 @item show symbol-reloading
12223 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
12224 @end table
12225
12226 @cindex opaque data types
12227 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
12228 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
12229 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
12230 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
12231 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
12232 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
12233 another source file. The default is on.
12234
12235 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
12236 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
12237
12238 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
12239 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
12240 is printed as follows:
12241 @smallexample
12242 @{<no data fields>@}
12243 @end smallexample
12244
12245 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
12246 @item show opaque-type-resolution
12247 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
12248
12249 @kindex set print symbol-loading
12250 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
12251 @item set print symbol-loading
12252 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
12253 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
12254 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
12255 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12256 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
12257 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
12258 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
12259 annoying than useful.
12260
12261 @kindex show print symbol-loading
12262 @item show print symbol-loading
12263 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12264
12265 @kindex maint print symbols
12266 @cindex symbol dump
12267 @kindex maint print psymbols
12268 @cindex partial symbol dump
12269 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
12270 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
12271 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
12272 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
12273 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
12274 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
12275 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
12276 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
12277 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
12278 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
12279 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
12280 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
12281 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
12282 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
12283 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
12284 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
12285 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
12286
12287 @kindex maint info symtabs
12288 @kindex maint info psymtabs
12289 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
12290 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12291 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12292 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12293 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12294 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12295
12296 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
12297 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
12298 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
12299 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
12300 structure in more detail. For example:
12301
12302 @smallexample
12303 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
12304 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12305 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12306 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12307 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
12308 readin no
12309 fullname (null)
12310 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
12311 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
12312 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
12313 dependencies (none)
12314 @}
12315 @}
12316 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12317 (@value{GDBP})
12318 @end smallexample
12319 @noindent
12320 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
12321 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
12322 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
12323 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
12324 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
12325
12326 @smallexample
12327 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
12328 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
12329 line 1574.
12330 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12331 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12332 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12333 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12334 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
12335 dirname (null)
12336 fullname (null)
12337 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
12338 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
12339 debugformat DWARF 2
12340 @}
12341 @}
12342 (@value{GDBP})
12343 @end smallexample
12344 @end table
12345
12346
12347 @node Altering
12348 @chapter Altering Execution
12349
12350 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
12351 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
12352 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
12353 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
12354 program.
12355
12356 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
12357 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
12358 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
12359
12360 @menu
12361 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
12362 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
12363 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
12364 * Returning:: Returning from a function
12365 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
12366 * Patching:: Patching your program
12367 @end menu
12368
12369 @node Assignment
12370 @section Assignment to Variables
12371
12372 @cindex assignment
12373 @cindex setting variables
12374 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
12375 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
12376
12377 @smallexample
12378 print x=4
12379 @end smallexample
12380
12381 @noindent
12382 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
12383 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
12384 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
12385 information on operators in supported languages.
12386
12387 @kindex set variable
12388 @cindex variables, setting
12389 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
12390 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
12391 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
12392 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
12393 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
12394
12395 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
12396 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
12397 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
12398 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
12399 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
12400 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
12401 command @code{set width}:
12402
12403 @smallexample
12404 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
12405 type = double
12406 (@value{GDBP}) p width
12407 $4 = 13
12408 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
12409 Invalid syntax in expression.
12410 @end smallexample
12411
12412 @noindent
12413 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
12414 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
12415
12416 @smallexample
12417 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
12418 @end smallexample
12419
12420 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
12421 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
12422 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
12423 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
12424 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
12425 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
12426
12427 @smallexample
12428 @group
12429 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
12430 type = double
12431 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12432 $1 = 1
12433 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
12434 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12435 $2 = 1
12436 (@value{GDBP}) r
12437 The program being debugged has been started already.
12438 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
12439 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
12440 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
12441 Invalid bfd target.
12442 (@value{GDBP}) show g
12443 The current BFD target is "=4".
12444 @end group
12445 @end smallexample
12446
12447 @noindent
12448 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
12449 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
12450 @code{g}, use
12451
12452 @smallexample
12453 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
12454 @end smallexample
12455
12456 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
12457 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
12458 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
12459 same length or shorter.
12460 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
12461 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
12462
12463 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
12464 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
12465 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
12466 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
12467 and representation in memory), and
12468
12469 @smallexample
12470 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
12471 @end smallexample
12472
12473 @noindent
12474 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
12475
12476 @node Jumping
12477 @section Continuing at a Different Address
12478
12479 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
12480 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
12481 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
12482
12483 @table @code
12484 @kindex jump
12485 @item jump @var{linespec}
12486 @itemx jump @var{location}
12487 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
12488 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
12489 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
12490 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
12491 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
12492 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12493
12494 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
12495 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
12496 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
12497 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
12498 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
12499 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
12500 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
12501 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12502 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12503 @end table
12504
12505 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12506 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12507 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12508 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12509 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12510 example,
12511
12512 @smallexample
12513 set $pc = 0x485
12514 @end smallexample
12515
12516 @noindent
12517 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12518 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12519 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12520
12521 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12522 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12523 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12524 detail.
12525
12526 @c @group
12527 @node Signaling
12528 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12529 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12530
12531 @table @code
12532 @kindex signal
12533 @item signal @var{signal}
12534 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12535 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12536 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12537 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12538
12539 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12540 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12541 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12542 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12543 signal.
12544
12545 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12546 after executing the command.
12547 @end table
12548 @c @end group
12549
12550 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12551 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12552 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12553 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12554 passes the signal directly to your program.
12555
12556
12557 @node Returning
12558 @section Returning from a Function
12559
12560 @table @code
12561 @cindex returning from a function
12562 @kindex return
12563 @item return
12564 @itemx return @var{expression}
12565 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12566 command. If you give an
12567 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12568 value.
12569 @end table
12570
12571 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12572 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12573 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12574 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12575
12576 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12577 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12578 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12579 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12580 of functions.
12581
12582 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12583 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12584 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12585 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12586 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12587
12588 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
12589 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
12590 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
12591 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
12592 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
12593 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
12594 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
12595 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
12596 assignment into the right register(s).
12597
12598 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
12599 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
12600 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
12601 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
12602 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
12603 into a @code{long long int}:
12604
12605 @smallexample
12606 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
12607 29 return 31;
12608 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12609 Make func return now? (y or n) y
12610 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
12611 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
12612 (@value{GDBP})
12613 @end smallexample
12614
12615 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
12616 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
12617 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
12618 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
12619 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
12620 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
12621 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
12622 an appropriate cast explicitly:
12623
12624 @smallexample
12625 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
12626 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12627 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
12628 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
12629 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
12630 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
12631 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
12632 (@value{GDBP})
12633 @end smallexample
12634
12635 @node Calling
12636 @section Calling Program Functions
12637
12638 @table @code
12639 @cindex calling functions
12640 @cindex inferior functions, calling
12641 @item print @var{expr}
12642 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12643 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12644 debugged.
12645
12646 @kindex call
12647 @item call @var{expr}
12648 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12649 returned values.
12650
12651 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12652 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12653 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12654 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12655 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12656 value history.
12657 @end table
12658
12659 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12660 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12661 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12662 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12663
12664 @table @code
12665 @item set unwindonsignal
12666 @kindex set unwindonsignal
12667 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
12668 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12669 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12670 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12671 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12672 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12673 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12674 received.
12675
12676 @item show unwindonsignal
12677 @kindex show unwindonsignal
12678 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12679 @value{GDBN}.
12680 @end table
12681
12682 @cindex weak alias functions
12683 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12684 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12685 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12686 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12687 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12688 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12689 function instead.
12690
12691 @node Patching
12692 @section Patching Programs
12693
12694 @cindex patching binaries
12695 @cindex writing into executables
12696 @cindex writing into corefiles
12697
12698 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12699 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12700 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12701 patching your program's binary.
12702
12703 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12704 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12705 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12706 repairs.
12707
12708 @table @code
12709 @kindex set write
12710 @item set write on
12711 @itemx set write off
12712 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12713 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
12714 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12715
12716 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12717 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12718 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12719
12720 @item show write
12721 @kindex show write
12722 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12723 as well as reading.
12724 @end table
12725
12726 @node GDB Files
12727 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12728
12729 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12730 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12731 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12732 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12733
12734 @menu
12735 * Files:: Commands to specify files
12736 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12737 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12738 @end menu
12739
12740 @node Files
12741 @section Commands to Specify Files
12742
12743 @cindex symbol table
12744 @cindex core dump file
12745
12746 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12747 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12748 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12749 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12750
12751 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12752 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12753 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12754 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12755 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12756 new files are useful.
12757
12758 @table @code
12759 @cindex executable file
12760 @kindex file
12761 @item file @var{filename}
12762 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12763 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12764 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12765 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12766 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12767 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12768 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12769 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12770
12771 @cindex unlinked object files
12772 @cindex patching object files
12773 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12774 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12775 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12776 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12777 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12778 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12779 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12780 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12781
12782 @item file
12783 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12784 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12785
12786 @kindex exec-file
12787 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12788 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12789 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12790 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12791 discard information on the executable file.
12792
12793 @kindex symbol-file
12794 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12795 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12796 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12797 table and program to run from the same file.
12798
12799 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12800 program's symbol table.
12801
12802 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12803 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12804 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12805 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12806 @value{GDBN}.
12807
12808 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12809 executing it once.
12810
12811 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12812 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12813 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12814 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12815 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12816 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12817 optimized code.
12818
12819 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12820 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12821 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12822 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12823 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12824
12825 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12826 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12827 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12828 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12829 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12830 Warnings and Messages}.)
12831
12832 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12833 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12834 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12835 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12836 in stabs format.
12837
12838 @kindex readnow
12839 @cindex reading symbols immediately
12840 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
12841 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12842 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12843 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12844 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12845 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12846 entire symbol table available.
12847
12848 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12849 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12850 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12851 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12852 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12853 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12854 @c files.
12855
12856 @kindex core-file
12857 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12858 @itemx core
12859 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12860 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12861 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12862 executable file itself for other parts.
12863
12864 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12865 to be used.
12866
12867 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12868 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12869 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12870 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
12871 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
12872
12873 @kindex add-symbol-file
12874 @cindex dynamic linking
12875 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12876 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12877 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12878 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12879 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12880 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12881 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12882 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12883 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12884 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12885 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12886 @var{address} as an expression.
12887
12888 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12889 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12890 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12891 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12892 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12893
12894 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12895 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12896 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12897 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12898 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12899 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12900 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12901 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12902 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12903
12904 @itemize @bullet
12905 @item
12906 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12907 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12908 @item
12909 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12910 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12911 @item
12912 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12913 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12914 @end itemize
12915
12916 @noindent
12917 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12918 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12919 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12920 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12921 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12922 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12923 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12924 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12925 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12926 way.
12927
12928 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12929
12930 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12931 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12932 @cindex load symbols from memory
12933 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12934 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12935 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12936 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12937 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12938 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12939 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12940 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12941 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12942
12943 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12944 @kindex assf
12945 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12946 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
12947 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12948 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12949 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12950 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12951 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12952 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12953 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12954 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12955
12956 @kindex section
12957 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12958 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12959 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12960 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12961 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12962 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12963 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12964 their addresses.
12965
12966 @kindex info files
12967 @kindex info target
12968 @item info files
12969 @itemx info target
12970 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12971 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12972 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12973 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12974 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12975 current ones.
12976
12977 @kindex maint info sections
12978 @item maint info sections
12979 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12980 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12981 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12982 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12983 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12984 may be arbitrarily combined):
12985
12986 @table @code
12987 @item ALLOBJ
12988 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12989 @item @var{sections}
12990 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12991 @item @var{section-flags}
12992 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12993 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12994 @table @code
12995 @item ALLOC
12996 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12997 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12998 @item LOAD
12999 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
13000 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
13001 @item RELOC
13002 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
13003 @item READONLY
13004 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
13005 @item CODE
13006 Section contains executable code only.
13007 @item DATA
13008 Section contains data only (no executable code).
13009 @item ROM
13010 Section will reside in ROM.
13011 @item CONSTRUCTOR
13012 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
13013 @item HAS_CONTENTS
13014 Section is not empty.
13015 @item NEVER_LOAD
13016 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
13017 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
13018 A notification to the linker that the section contains
13019 COFF shared library information.
13020 @item IS_COMMON
13021 Section contains common symbols.
13022 @end table
13023 @end table
13024 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
13025 @cindex read-only sections
13026 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
13027 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
13028 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
13029 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
13030 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
13031 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
13032 enhancement to debugging performance.
13033
13034 The default is off.
13035
13036 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
13037 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
13038 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
13039 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
13040
13041 @item show trust-readonly-sections
13042 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
13043 @end table
13044
13045 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
13046 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
13047 name and remembers it that way.
13048
13049 @cindex shared libraries
13050 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
13051 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
13052 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
13053
13054 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
13055 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
13056
13057 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
13058 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
13059 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
13060 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
13061 debugging a core file).
13062
13063 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
13064 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
13065
13066 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
13067 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
13068 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
13069
13070 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
13071 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
13072 particularly large or there are many of them.
13073
13074 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
13075 commands:
13076
13077 @table @code
13078 @kindex set auto-solib-add
13079 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
13080 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
13081 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
13082 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
13083 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
13084 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
13085 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
13086
13087 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
13088 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
13089 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
13090 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
13091 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
13092 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
13093 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
13094 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
13095 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
13096
13097 @kindex show auto-solib-add
13098 @item show auto-solib-add
13099 Display the current autoloading mode.
13100 @end table
13101
13102 @cindex load shared library
13103 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
13104 command:
13105
13106 @table @code
13107 @kindex info sharedlibrary
13108 @kindex info share
13109 @item info share
13110 @itemx info sharedlibrary
13111 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
13112
13113 @kindex sharedlibrary
13114 @kindex share
13115 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
13116 @itemx share @var{regex}
13117 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
13118 Unix regular expression.
13119 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
13120 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
13121 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
13122 loaded.
13123
13124 @item nosharedlibrary
13125 @kindex nosharedlibrary
13126 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
13127 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
13128 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
13129 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
13130 discarded.
13131 @end table
13132
13133 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
13134 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
13135 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
13136
13137 @table @code
13138 @item set stop-on-solib-events
13139 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
13140 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
13141 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
13142 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
13143 shared library.
13144
13145 @item show stop-on-solib-events
13146 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
13147 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
13148 library events happen.
13149 @end table
13150
13151 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
13152 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
13153 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
13154 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
13155 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
13156 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
13157 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
13158 not.
13159
13160 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
13161 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
13162 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
13163 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
13164 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
13165
13166 @table @code
13167 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
13168 @cindex system root, alternate
13169 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
13170 @kindex set sysroot
13171 @item set sysroot @var{path}
13172 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
13173 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
13174 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
13175 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
13176 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
13177 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
13178 under @var{path}.
13179
13180 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
13181 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
13182 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
13183 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
13184 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
13185 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
13186 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
13187 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
13188 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
13189
13190 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
13191 sysroot}.
13192
13193 @cindex default system root
13194 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
13195 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
13196 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
13197 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
13198 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
13199 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
13200 location.
13201
13202 @kindex show sysroot
13203 @item show sysroot
13204 Display the current shared library prefix.
13205
13206 @kindex set solib-search-path
13207 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
13208 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
13209 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
13210 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
13211 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
13212 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
13213 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
13214 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
13215 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
13216 of shared library symbols.
13217
13218 @kindex show solib-search-path
13219 @item show solib-search-path
13220 Display the current shared library search path.
13221 @end table
13222
13223
13224 @node Separate Debug Files
13225 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
13226 @cindex separate debugging information files
13227 @cindex debugging information in separate files
13228 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
13229 @cindex debugging information directory, global
13230 @cindex global debugging information directory
13231 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
13232 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
13233
13234 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
13235 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
13236 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
13237 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
13238 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
13239 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
13240 install only when they need to debug a problem.
13241
13242 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
13243 file:
13244
13245 @itemize @bullet
13246 @item
13247 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
13248 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
13249 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
13250 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
13251 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
13252 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
13253 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
13254 came from the same build.
13255
13256 @item
13257 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
13258 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
13259 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
13260 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
13261 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
13262 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
13263 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
13264 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
13265 below.
13266 @end itemize
13267
13268 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
13269 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
13270
13271 @itemize @bullet
13272 @item
13273 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
13274 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
13275 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
13276 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
13277 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
13278
13279 @item
13280 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
13281 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
13282 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
13283 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
13284 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
13285 hex characters, not 10.)
13286 @end itemize
13287
13288 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
13289 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
13290 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
13291 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
13292 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
13293 debug information files, in the indicated order:
13294
13295 @itemize @minus
13296 @item
13297 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
13298 @item
13299 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
13300 @item
13301 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
13302 @item
13303 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
13304 @end itemize
13305
13306 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
13307 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
13308
13309 @table @code
13310
13311 @kindex set debug-file-directory
13312 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
13313 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13314 information files to @var{directory}.
13315
13316 @kindex show debug-file-directory
13317 @item show debug-file-directory
13318 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13319 information files.
13320
13321 @end table
13322
13323 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
13324 @cindex debug link sections
13325 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
13326 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
13327
13328 @itemize
13329 @item
13330 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
13331 a zero byte,
13332 @item
13333 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
13334 boundary within the section, and
13335 @item
13336 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
13337 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
13338 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
13339 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
13340 @end itemize
13341
13342 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
13343 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
13344 described above.
13345
13346 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
13347 @cindex build ID sections
13348 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
13349 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
13350 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
13351 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
13352 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
13353 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
13354 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
13355 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
13356 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
13357
13358 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
13359 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
13360 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
13361 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
13362 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
13363 in an ordinary executable.
13364
13365 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
13366 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
13367 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
13368 following commands:
13369
13370 @smallexample
13371 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
13372 @kbd{strip -g foo}
13373 @end smallexample
13374
13375 @noindent
13376 These commands remove the debugging
13377 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
13378 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
13379 two files:
13380
13381 @itemize @bullet
13382 @item
13383 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
13384 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
13385
13386 @smallexample
13387 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
13388 @end smallexample
13389
13390 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
13391 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
13392 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
13393 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
13394
13395 @item
13396 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
13397 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
13398 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
13399 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
13400 @end itemize
13401
13402 @noindent
13403
13404 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
13405 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
13406 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
13407 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
13408
13409 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
13410 @smallexample
13411 unsigned long
13412 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
13413 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
13414 @{
13415 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
13416 @{
13417 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
13418 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
13419 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
13420 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
13421 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
13422 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
13423 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
13424 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
13425 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
13426 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
13427 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
13428 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
13429 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
13430 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
13431 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
13432 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
13433 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
13434 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
13435 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
13436 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
13437 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
13438 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
13439 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
13440 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
13441 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
13442 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
13443 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
13444 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
13445 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
13446 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
13447 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
13448 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
13449 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
13450 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
13451 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
13452 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
13453 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
13454 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
13455 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
13456 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
13457 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
13458 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
13459 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
13460 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
13461 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
13462 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
13463 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
13464 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
13465 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
13466 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
13467 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
13468 0x2d02ef8d
13469 @};
13470 unsigned char *end;
13471
13472 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13473 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
13474 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
13475 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13476 @}
13477 @end smallexample
13478
13479 @noindent
13480 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
13481
13482
13483 @node Symbol Errors
13484 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
13485
13486 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
13487 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
13488 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
13489 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
13490 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
13491 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
13492 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
13493 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
13494 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
13495 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13496 Messages}).
13497
13498 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
13499
13500 @table @code
13501 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
13502
13503 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
13504 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
13505 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
13506 in its outer scope blocks.
13507
13508 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
13509 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
13510 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
13511 function.
13512
13513 @item block at @var{address} out of order
13514
13515 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
13516 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
13517 do so.
13518
13519 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
13520 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
13521 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
13522 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13523 Messages}.)
13524
13525 @item bad block start address patched
13526
13527 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
13528 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
13529 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
13530
13531 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
13532 starting on the previous source line.
13533
13534 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
13535
13536 @cindex foo
13537 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
13538 larger than the size of the string table.
13539
13540 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
13541 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
13542 with this name.
13543
13544 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
13545
13546 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
13547 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
13548 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
13549
13550 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
13551 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
13552 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
13553 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
13554 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
13555 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
13556
13557 @item stub type has NULL name
13558
13559 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
13560
13561 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
13562 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
13563 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
13564 it.
13565
13566 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13567
13568 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13569
13570 @end table
13571
13572 @node Targets
13573 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13574
13575 @cindex debugging target
13576 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13577
13578 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13579 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13580 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13581 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13582 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13583 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13584 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13585 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13586
13587 @cindex target architecture
13588 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13589 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13590 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13591 command.
13592
13593 @table @code
13594 @kindex set architecture
13595 @kindex show architecture
13596 @item set architecture @var{arch}
13597 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13598 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13599 supported architectures.
13600
13601 @item show architecture
13602 Show the current target architecture.
13603
13604 @item set processor
13605 @itemx processor
13606 @kindex set processor
13607 @kindex show processor
13608 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13609 and @code{show architecture}.
13610 @end table
13611
13612 @menu
13613 * Active Targets:: Active targets
13614 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13615 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13616 @end menu
13617
13618 @node Active Targets
13619 @section Active Targets
13620
13621 @cindex stacking targets
13622 @cindex active targets
13623 @cindex multiple targets
13624
13625 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13626 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13627 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13628 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13629 a core file.
13630
13631 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13632 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13633 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13634 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13635 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13636 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13637 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13638 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13639 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13640
13641 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13642 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13643 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13644 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13645 process target is active.
13646
13647 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13648 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13649 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13650 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13651 Process}).
13652
13653 @node Target Commands
13654 @section Commands for Managing Targets
13655
13656 @table @code
13657 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13658 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13659 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13660 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13661 protocol of the target machine.
13662
13663 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13664 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13665 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13666
13667 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13668 after executing the command.
13669
13670 @kindex help target
13671 @item help target
13672 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13673 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13674 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13675
13676 @item help target @var{name}
13677 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13678 select it.
13679
13680 @kindex set gnutarget
13681 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
13682 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13683 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13684 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13685 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13686 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13687
13688 @quotation
13689 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13690 you must know the actual BFD name.
13691 @end quotation
13692
13693 @noindent
13694 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13695
13696 @kindex show gnutarget
13697 @item show gnutarget
13698 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13699 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13700 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13701 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13702 @end table
13703
13704 @cindex common targets
13705 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13706 configuration):
13707
13708 @table @code
13709 @kindex target
13710 @item target exec @var{program}
13711 @cindex executable file target
13712 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13713 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13714
13715 @item target core @var{filename}
13716 @cindex core dump file target
13717 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13718 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13719
13720 @item target remote @var{medium}
13721 @cindex remote target
13722 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13723 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13724 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13725
13726 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13727 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13728
13729 @smallexample
13730 target remote /dev/ttya
13731 @end smallexample
13732
13733 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13734 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13735 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13736 clobbered by the download.
13737
13738 @item target sim
13739 @cindex built-in simulator target
13740 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13741 In general,
13742 @smallexample
13743 target sim
13744 load
13745 run
13746 @end smallexample
13747 @noindent
13748 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13749 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13750 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13751 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13752 Processors}.
13753
13754 @end table
13755
13756 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13757
13758 @table @code
13759
13760 @item target nrom @var{dev}
13761 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13762 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13763
13764 @end table
13765
13766 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13767 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13768
13769 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13770 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
13771 various aspects of this process.
13772
13773 @table @code
13774
13775 @item set hash
13776 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13777 @cindex hash mark while downloading
13778 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13779 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13780 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13781 monitor.
13782
13783 @item show hash
13784 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13785 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13786
13787 @item set debug monitor
13788 @kindex set debug monitor
13789 @cindex display remote monitor communications
13790 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13791 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13792
13793 @item show debug monitor
13794 @kindex show debug monitor
13795 Show the current status of displaying communications between
13796 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13797 @end table
13798
13799 @table @code
13800
13801 @kindex load @var{filename}
13802 @item load @var{filename}
13803 @anchor{load}
13804 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13805 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13806 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13807 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13808 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13809 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13810
13811 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13812 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13813 target is @dots{}}''
13814
13815 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13816 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13817 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13818 specifies a fixed address.
13819 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13820
13821 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13822 load programs into flash memory.
13823
13824 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13825 @end table
13826
13827 @node Byte Order
13828 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
13829
13830 @cindex choosing target byte order
13831 @cindex target byte order
13832
13833 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13834 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13835 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13836 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13837 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13838 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13839
13840 @table @code
13841 @kindex set endian
13842 @item set endian big
13843 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
13844
13845 @item set endian little
13846 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
13847
13848 @item set endian auto
13849 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
13850 executable.
13851
13852 @item show endian
13853 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
13854
13855 @end table
13856
13857 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
13858 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
13859 target system.
13860
13861
13862 @node Remote Debugging
13863 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
13864 @cindex remote debugging
13865
13866 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
13867 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
13868 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
13869 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
13870 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
13871
13872 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
13873 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
13874 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
13875 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
13876 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
13877 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
13878
13879 Other remote targets may be available in your
13880 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
13881
13882 @menu
13883 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
13884 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
13885 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
13886 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
13887 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13888 @end menu
13889
13890 @node Connecting
13891 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
13892
13893 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13894 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13895 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13896 program as the first argument.
13897
13898 @cindex @code{target remote}
13899 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13900 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13901 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13902 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13903 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13904 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13905
13906 @table @code
13907
13908 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
13909 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13910 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13911 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13912
13913 @smallexample
13914 target remote /dev/ttyb
13915 @end smallexample
13916
13917 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13918 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13919 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13920 @code{target} command.
13921
13922 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13923 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13924 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13925 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13926 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13927 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13928 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13929 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13930 target.
13931
13932 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13933 @code{manyfarms}:
13934
13935 @smallexample
13936 target remote manyfarms:2828
13937 @end smallexample
13938
13939 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13940 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13941 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13942 port 1234 on your local machine:
13943
13944 @smallexample
13945 target remote :1234
13946 @end smallexample
13947 @noindent
13948
13949 Note that the colon is still required here.
13950
13951 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13952 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13953 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13954 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13955
13956 @smallexample
13957 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13958 @end smallexample
13959
13960 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13961 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13962 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13963 cause havoc with your debugging session.
13964
13965 @item target remote | @var{command}
13966 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13967 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13968 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13969 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13970 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13971 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13972 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13973 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13974
13975 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13976 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13977 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13978
13979 @end table
13980
13981 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13982 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13983 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13984 need to use @kbd{run}.
13985
13986 @cindex interrupting remote programs
13987 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
13988 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13989 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13990 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13991 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13992 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13993
13994 @smallexample
13995 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13996 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13997 @end smallexample
13998
13999 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
14000 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
14001 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
14002 goes back to waiting.
14003
14004 @table @code
14005 @kindex detach (remote)
14006 @item detach
14007 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
14008 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
14009 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
14010 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
14011 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
14012
14013 @kindex disconnect
14014 @item disconnect
14015 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
14016 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
14017 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
14018 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
14019 another target.
14020
14021 @cindex send command to remote monitor
14022 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
14023 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
14024 @kindex monitor
14025 @item monitor @var{cmd}
14026 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
14027 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
14028 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
14029 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
14030 and implement.
14031 @end table
14032
14033 @node File Transfer
14034 @section Sending files to a remote system
14035 @cindex remote target, file transfer
14036 @cindex file transfer
14037 @cindex sending files to remote systems
14038
14039 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
14040 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
14041 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
14042 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
14043 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
14044 the only way to upload or download files.
14045
14046 Not all remote targets support these commands.
14047
14048 @table @code
14049 @kindex remote put
14050 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
14051 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
14052 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
14053
14054 @kindex remote get
14055 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
14056 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
14057 on the host system.
14058
14059 @kindex remote delete
14060 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
14061 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
14062
14063 @end table
14064
14065 @node Server
14066 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
14067
14068 @kindex gdbserver
14069 @cindex remote connection without stubs
14070 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
14071 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
14072 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
14073
14074 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
14075 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
14076 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
14077 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
14078 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
14079 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
14080 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
14081 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
14082 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
14083 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
14084 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
14085 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
14086 choice for debugging.
14087
14088 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
14089 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
14090 protocol.
14091
14092 @quotation
14093 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
14094 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
14095 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
14096 target system with the same privileges as the user running
14097 @code{gdbserver}.
14098 @end quotation
14099
14100 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
14101 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
14102
14103 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
14104 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
14105 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
14106 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
14107 system does all the symbol handling.
14108
14109 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
14110 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
14111 syntax is:
14112
14113 @smallexample
14114 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
14115 @end smallexample
14116
14117 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
14118 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
14119 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
14120 @file{/dev/com1}:
14121
14122 @smallexample
14123 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
14124 @end smallexample
14125
14126 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
14127 with it.
14128
14129 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
14130
14131 @smallexample
14132 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
14133 @end smallexample
14134
14135 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
14136 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
14137 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
14138 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
14139 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
14140 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
14141 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
14142 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
14143 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
14144 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
14145 @code{target remote} command.
14146
14147 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
14148
14149 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
14150 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
14151
14152 @smallexample
14153 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
14154 @end smallexample
14155
14156 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
14157 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
14158
14159 @pindex pidof
14160 @cindex attach to a program by name
14161 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
14162 @code{pidof} utility:
14163
14164 @smallexample
14165 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
14166 @end smallexample
14167
14168 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
14169 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
14170 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
14171
14172 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
14173 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
14174 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
14175
14176 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
14177 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
14178 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
14179 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
14180
14181 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
14182 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
14183 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
14184 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
14185 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
14186 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
14187 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
14188 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
14189 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
14190
14191 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
14192 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
14193 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
14194 the program you want to debug.
14195
14196 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
14197 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
14198 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
14199
14200 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
14201
14202 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
14203 status information about the debugging process. The
14204 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
14205 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
14206 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
14207
14208 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
14209 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
14210 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
14211 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
14212
14213 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
14214 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
14215 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
14216 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
14217
14218 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
14219 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
14220 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
14221 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
14222
14223 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
14224 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
14225 environment:
14226
14227 @smallexample
14228 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
14229 @end smallexample
14230
14231 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
14232
14233 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
14234
14235 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
14236 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
14237 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
14238 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
14239
14240 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
14241 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
14242 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
14243 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
14244 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
14245 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
14246 programs.
14247
14248 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14249 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
14250 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
14251 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
14252 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
14253 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
14254 already on the target.
14255
14256 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
14257 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
14258 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
14259
14260 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
14261 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
14262 Here are the available commands.
14263
14264 @table @code
14265 @item monitor help
14266 List the available monitor commands.
14267
14268 @item monitor set debug 0
14269 @itemx monitor set debug 1
14270 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
14271
14272 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
14273 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
14274 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
14275 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
14276
14277 @item monitor exit
14278 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
14279 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
14280 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
14281 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
14282 of a multi-process mode debug session.
14283
14284 @end table
14285
14286 @node Remote Configuration
14287 @section Remote Configuration
14288
14289 @kindex set remote
14290 @kindex show remote
14291 This section documents the configuration options available when
14292 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
14293 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
14294 system-call-allowed}.
14295
14296 @table @code
14297 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
14298 @cindex address size for remote targets
14299 @cindex bits in remote address
14300 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
14301 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
14302 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
14303 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
14304
14305 @item show remoteaddresssize
14306 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
14307
14308 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
14309 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
14310 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
14311 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
14312 remote targets.
14313
14314 @item show remotebaud
14315 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
14316
14317 @item set remotebreak
14318 @cindex interrupt remote programs
14319 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
14320 @anchor{set remotebreak}
14321 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
14322 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
14323 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
14324 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
14325 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
14326
14327 @item show remotebreak
14328 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
14329 interrupt the remote program.
14330
14331 @item set remoteflow on
14332 @itemx set remoteflow off
14333 @kindex set remoteflow
14334 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
14335 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
14336
14337 @item show remoteflow
14338 @kindex show remoteflow
14339 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
14340
14341 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
14342 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
14343 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
14344 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
14345 @code{ascii}.
14346
14347 @item show remotelogbase
14348 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
14349 protocol.
14350
14351 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
14352 @cindex record serial communications on file
14353 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
14354 default is not to record at all.
14355
14356 @item show remotelogfile.
14357 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
14358 serial communications.
14359
14360 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
14361 @cindex timeout for serial communications
14362 @cindex remote timeout
14363 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
14364 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
14365
14366 @item show remotetimeout
14367 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
14368 responses.
14369
14370 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14371 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
14372 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
14373 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
14374 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
14375 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
14376 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
14377 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
14378
14379 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
14380 @itemx show remote exec-file
14381 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
14382 @cindex executable file, for remote target
14383 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
14384 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
14385 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
14386 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
14387
14388 @kindex set tcp
14389 @kindex show tcp
14390 @item set tcp auto-retry on
14391 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
14392 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
14393 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
14394 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
14395 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
14396 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
14397 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
14398 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
14399
14400 @item set tcp auto-retry off
14401 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
14402
14403 @item show tcp auto-retry
14404 Show the current auto-retry setting.
14405
14406 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
14407 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
14408 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
14409 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
14410 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
14411 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
14412 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
14413 value.
14414
14415 @item show tcp connect-timeout
14416 Show the current connection timeout setting.
14417 @end table
14418
14419 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
14420 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
14421 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
14422 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
14423 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
14424 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
14425 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
14426 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
14427 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
14428
14429 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
14430 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
14431 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
14432 @value{GDBN} developers.
14433
14434 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
14435 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
14436 are:
14437
14438 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
14439 @item Command Name
14440 @tab Remote Packet
14441 @tab Related Features
14442
14443 @item @code{fetch-register}
14444 @tab @code{p}
14445 @tab @code{info registers}
14446
14447 @item @code{set-register}
14448 @tab @code{P}
14449 @tab @code{set}
14450
14451 @item @code{binary-download}
14452 @tab @code{X}
14453 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
14454
14455 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
14456 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
14457 @tab @code{info auxv}
14458
14459 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
14460 @tab @code{qSymbol}
14461 @tab Detecting multiple threads
14462
14463 @item @code{attach}
14464 @tab @code{vAttach}
14465 @tab @code{attach}
14466
14467 @item @code{verbose-resume}
14468 @tab @code{vCont}
14469 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
14470
14471 @item @code{run}
14472 @tab @code{vRun}
14473 @tab @code{run}
14474
14475 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
14476 @tab @code{Z0}
14477 @tab @code{break}
14478
14479 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
14480 @tab @code{Z1}
14481 @tab @code{hbreak}
14482
14483 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
14484 @tab @code{Z2}
14485 @tab @code{watch}
14486
14487 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
14488 @tab @code{Z3}
14489 @tab @code{rwatch}
14490
14491 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
14492 @tab @code{Z4}
14493 @tab @code{awatch}
14494
14495 @item @code{target-features}
14496 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
14497 @tab @code{set architecture}
14498
14499 @item @code{library-info}
14500 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
14501 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
14502
14503 @item @code{memory-map}
14504 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
14505 @tab @code{info mem}
14506
14507 @item @code{read-spu-object}
14508 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
14509 @tab @code{info spu}
14510
14511 @item @code{write-spu-object}
14512 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
14513 @tab @code{info spu}
14514
14515 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
14516 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
14517 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
14518
14519 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
14520 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
14521 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
14522
14523 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
14524 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
14525 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
14526
14527 @item @code{search-memory}
14528 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
14529 @tab @code{find}
14530
14531 @item @code{supported-packets}
14532 @tab @code{qSupported}
14533 @tab Remote communications parameters
14534
14535 @item @code{pass-signals}
14536 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
14537 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
14538
14539 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
14540 @tab @code{vFile:close}
14541 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14542
14543 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
14544 @tab @code{vFile:open}
14545 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14546
14547 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
14548 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
14549 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14550
14551 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
14552 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
14553 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14554
14555 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
14556 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
14557 @tab @code{remote delete}
14558
14559 @item @code{noack-packet}
14560 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
14561 @tab Packet acknowledgment
14562
14563 @item @code{osdata}
14564 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
14565 @tab @code{info os}
14566
14567 @item @code{query-attached}
14568 @tab @code{qAttached}
14569 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
14570 @end multitable
14571
14572 @node Remote Stub
14573 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
14574
14575 @cindex debugging stub, example
14576 @cindex remote stub, example
14577 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
14578 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
14579 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
14580 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
14581 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
14582 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
14583 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
14584 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
14585
14586 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
14587 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
14588 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
14589 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
14590 program, you need:
14591
14592 @enumerate
14593 @item
14594 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
14595 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
14596 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
14597
14598 @item
14599 A C subroutine library to support your program's
14600 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
14601
14602 @item
14603 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
14604 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
14605 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
14606 documentation.
14607 @end enumerate
14608
14609 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
14610 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
14611 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14612
14613 @table @emph
14614 @item On the host,
14615 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14616 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14617 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14618
14619 @item On the target,
14620 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14621 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14622 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14623
14624 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14625 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14626 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14627 @end table
14628
14629 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14630 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14631 @sc{sparc} boards.
14632
14633 @cindex remote serial stub list
14634 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14635
14636 @table @code
14637
14638 @item i386-stub.c
14639 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14640 @cindex Intel
14641 @cindex i386
14642 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14643
14644 @item m68k-stub.c
14645 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14646 @cindex Motorola 680x0
14647 @cindex m680x0
14648 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14649
14650 @item sh-stub.c
14651 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14652 @cindex Renesas
14653 @cindex SH
14654 For Renesas SH architectures.
14655
14656 @item sparc-stub.c
14657 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14658 @cindex Sparc
14659 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14660
14661 @item sparcl-stub.c
14662 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14663 @cindex Fujitsu
14664 @cindex SparcLite
14665 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14666
14667 @end table
14668
14669 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14670 recently added stubs.
14671
14672 @menu
14673 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14674 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14675 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14676 @end menu
14677
14678 @node Stub Contents
14679 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14680
14681 @cindex remote serial stub
14682 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14683 subroutines:
14684
14685 @table @code
14686 @item set_debug_traps
14687 @findex set_debug_traps
14688 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14689 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14690 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14691 beginning of your program.
14692
14693 @item handle_exception
14694 @findex handle_exception
14695 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14696 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14697 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14698 run when a trap is triggered.
14699
14700 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14701 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14702 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14703 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14704 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14705 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14706 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14707 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14708 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14709 machine.
14710
14711 @item breakpoint
14712 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14713 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14714 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14715 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14716 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14717 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14718 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14719 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14720 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14721 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14722 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
14723
14724 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14725 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14726 start of your debugging session.
14727 @end table
14728
14729 @node Bootstrapping
14730 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14731
14732 @cindex remote stub, support routines
14733 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14734 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14735 debugging target machine.
14736
14737 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14738 serial port.
14739
14740 @table @code
14741 @item int getDebugChar()
14742 @findex getDebugChar
14743 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14744 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14745 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14746
14747 @item void putDebugChar(int)
14748 @findex putDebugChar
14749 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14750 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14751 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14752 @end table
14753
14754 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
14755 @cindex interrupting remote targets
14756 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14757 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14758 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14759 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14760 remote system to stop.
14761
14762 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14763 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14764 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14765 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14766
14767 Other routines you need to supply are:
14768
14769 @table @code
14770 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
14771 @findex exceptionHandler
14772 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
14773 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
14774 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
14775 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
14776 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
14777 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
14778 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
14779 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
14780 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
14781 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
14782 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
14783 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
14784 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
14785
14786 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
14787 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
14788 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
14789 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
14790 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
14791
14792 @item void flush_i_cache()
14793 @findex flush_i_cache
14794 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
14795 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
14796 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
14797
14798 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
14799 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
14800 @end table
14801
14802 @noindent
14803 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
14804
14805 @table @code
14806 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
14807 @findex memset
14808 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
14809 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
14810 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
14811 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
14812 @end table
14813
14814 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
14815 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
14816 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
14817 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
14818
14819
14820 @node Debug Session
14821 @subsection Putting it All Together
14822
14823 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
14824 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14825 steps.
14826
14827 @enumerate
14828 @item
14829 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14830 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14831 @display
14832 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14833 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14834 @end display
14835
14836 @item
14837 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14838
14839 @smallexample
14840 set_debug_traps();
14841 breakpoint();
14842 @end smallexample
14843
14844 @item
14845 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
14846 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
14847
14848 @smallexample
14849 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
14850 @end smallexample
14851
14852 @noindent
14853 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
14854 function in your program, that function is called when
14855 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
14856 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
14857 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
14858
14859 @item
14860 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
14861 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
14862
14863 @item
14864 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
14865 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
14866
14867 @item
14868 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
14869 @c document that. FIXME.
14870 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
14871 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
14872
14873 @item
14874 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
14875 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14876
14877 @end enumerate
14878
14879 @node Configurations
14880 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
14881
14882 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
14883 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
14884 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
14885
14886 There are three major categories of configurations: native
14887 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
14888 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
14889 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
14890 are quite different from each other.
14891
14892 @menu
14893 * Native::
14894 * Embedded OS::
14895 * Embedded Processors::
14896 * Architectures::
14897 @end menu
14898
14899 @node Native
14900 @section Native
14901
14902 This section describes details specific to particular native
14903 configurations.
14904
14905 @menu
14906 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
14907 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
14908 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
14909 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
14910 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
14911 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
14912 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
14913 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
14914 @end menu
14915
14916 @node HP-UX
14917 @subsection HP-UX
14918
14919 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
14920 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
14921 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
14922
14923
14924 @node BSD libkvm Interface
14925 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
14926
14927 @cindex libkvm
14928 @cindex kernel memory image
14929 @cindex kernel crash dump
14930
14931 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
14932 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
14933 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
14934 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
14935 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
14936 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
14937 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
14938 @code{kvm} target:
14939
14940 @smallexample
14941 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14942 @end smallexample
14943
14944 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14945 argument:
14946
14947 @smallexample
14948 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14949 @end smallexample
14950
14951 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14952 available:
14953
14954 @table @code
14955 @kindex kvm
14956 @item kvm pcb
14957 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14958
14959 @item kvm proc
14960 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14961 modern FreeBSD systems.
14962 @end table
14963
14964 @node SVR4 Process Information
14965 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
14966 @cindex /proc
14967 @cindex examine process image
14968 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14969
14970 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14971 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14972 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14973 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14974 proc} is available to report information about the process running
14975 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14976 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14977 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14978 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14979
14980 @table @code
14981 @kindex info proc
14982 @cindex process ID
14983 @item info proc
14984 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14985 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14986 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14987 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14988 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14989 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14990 executable file's absolute file name.
14991
14992 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14993 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14994 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14995 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14996 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14997 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14998
14999 @item info proc mappings
15000 @cindex memory address space mappings
15001 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
15002 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
15003 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
15004 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
15005 memory access rights to that range.
15006
15007 @item info proc stat
15008 @itemx info proc status
15009 @cindex process detailed status information
15010 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
15011 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
15012 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
15013 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
15014 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
15015 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
15016 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
15017
15018 @item info proc all
15019 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
15020 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
15021
15022 @ignore
15023 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
15024 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
15025 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
15026 @kindex info proc times
15027 @item info proc times
15028 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
15029 its children.
15030
15031 @kindex info proc id
15032 @item info proc id
15033 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
15034 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
15035 @end ignore
15036
15037 @item set procfs-trace
15038 @kindex set procfs-trace
15039 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
15040 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
15041
15042 @item show procfs-trace
15043 @kindex show procfs-trace
15044 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
15045
15046 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
15047 @kindex set procfs-file
15048 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
15049 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
15050 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
15051 standard output.
15052
15053 @item show procfs-file
15054 @kindex show procfs-file
15055 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
15056
15057 @item proc-trace-entry
15058 @itemx proc-trace-exit
15059 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
15060 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
15061 @kindex proc-trace-entry
15062 @kindex proc-trace-exit
15063 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
15064 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
15065 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
15066 from the @code{syscall} interface.
15067
15068 @item info pidlist
15069 @kindex info pidlist
15070 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
15071 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
15072 processes and all the threads within each process.
15073
15074 @item info meminfo
15075 @kindex info meminfo
15076 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
15077 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
15078 @end table
15079
15080 @node DJGPP Native
15081 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
15082 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
15083 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
15084 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
15085
15086 @cindex DPMI
15087 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
15088 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
15089 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
15090 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
15091
15092 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
15093 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
15094 subsection describes those commands.
15095
15096 @table @code
15097 @kindex info dos
15098 @item info dos
15099 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
15100 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15101
15102 @kindex sysinfo
15103 @cindex MS-DOS system info
15104 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
15105 @item info dos sysinfo
15106 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
15107 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
15108 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
15109
15110 @cindex GDT
15111 @cindex LDT
15112 @cindex IDT
15113 @cindex segment descriptor tables
15114 @cindex descriptor tables display
15115 @item info dos gdt
15116 @itemx info dos ldt
15117 @itemx info dos idt
15118 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
15119 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
15120 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
15121 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
15122 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
15123 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
15124 rights.
15125
15126 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
15127 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
15128 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
15129 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
15130 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
15131
15132 @cindex garbled pointers
15133 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
15134 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
15135 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
15136 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
15137 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
15138 debugged program's data segment:
15139
15140 @smallexample
15141 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
15142 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
15143 @end smallexample
15144
15145 @noindent
15146 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
15147 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
15148
15149 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
15150 @item info dos pde
15151 @itemx info dos pte
15152 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
15153 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
15154 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
15155 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
15156 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
15157 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
15158 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
15159 that is currently in use.
15160
15161 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
15162 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
15163 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
15164 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
15165 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
15166 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
15167 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
15168
15169 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
15170 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
15171 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
15172 controller.
15173
15174 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
15175
15176 @cindex physical address from linear address
15177 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
15178 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
15179 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
15180 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
15181 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
15182 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
15183 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
15184
15185 @smallexample
15186 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
15187 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
15188 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
15189 @end smallexample
15190
15191 @noindent
15192 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
15193 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
15194 attributes of that page.
15195
15196 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
15197 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
15198 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
15199 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
15200 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
15201 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
15202
15203 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
15204 transfer buffer:
15205
15206 @smallexample
15207 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
15208 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
15209 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
15210 @end smallexample
15211
15212 @noindent
15213 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
15214 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
15215 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
15216 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
15217 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
15218
15219 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
15220 @end table
15221
15222 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
15223 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
15224 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
15225 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
15226
15227 @table @code
15228 @kindex set com1base
15229 @kindex set com1irq
15230 @kindex set com2base
15231 @kindex set com2irq
15232 @kindex set com3base
15233 @kindex set com3irq
15234 @kindex set com4base
15235 @kindex set com4irq
15236 @item set com1base @var{addr}
15237 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
15238 port.
15239
15240 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
15241 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
15242 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
15243
15244 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
15245 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
15246 other 3 COM ports.
15247
15248 @kindex show com1base
15249 @kindex show com1irq
15250 @kindex show com2base
15251 @kindex show com2irq
15252 @kindex show com3base
15253 @kindex show com3irq
15254 @kindex show com4base
15255 @kindex show com4irq
15256 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
15257 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
15258 lines used by the COM ports.
15259
15260 @item info serial
15261 @kindex info serial
15262 @cindex DOS serial port status
15263 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
15264 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
15265 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
15266 counts of various errors encountered so far.
15267 @end table
15268
15269
15270 @node Cygwin Native
15271 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
15272 @cindex MS Windows debugging
15273 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
15274 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
15275
15276 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
15277 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
15278 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
15279 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
15280 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
15281
15282 @table @code
15283 @kindex info w32
15284 @item info w32
15285 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
15286 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15287
15288 @item info w32 selector
15289 This command displays information returned by
15290 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
15291 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
15292 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
15293 Without argument, this command displays information
15294 about the six segment registers.
15295
15296 @kindex info dll
15297 @item info dll
15298 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
15299
15300 @kindex dll-symbols
15301 @item dll-symbols
15302 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
15303 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
15304
15305 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
15306 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
15307 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
15308 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
15309 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
15310 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
15311 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
15312 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
15313 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
15314 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
15315 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
15316
15317 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
15318 @item show cygwin-exceptions
15319 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
15320 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
15321
15322 @kindex set new-console
15323 @item set new-console @var{mode}
15324 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
15325 be started in a new console on next start.
15326 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
15327 be started in the same console as the debugger.
15328
15329 @kindex show new-console
15330 @item show new-console
15331 Displays whether a new console is used
15332 when the debuggee is started.
15333
15334 @kindex set new-group
15335 @item set new-group @var{mode}
15336 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
15337 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
15338 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
15339 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
15340
15341 @kindex show new-group
15342 @item show new-group
15343 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
15344
15345 @kindex set debugevents
15346 @item set debugevents
15347 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
15348 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
15349 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
15350 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
15351 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
15352
15353 @kindex set debugexec
15354 @item set debugexec
15355 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
15356 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
15357
15358 @kindex set debugexceptions
15359 @item set debugexceptions
15360 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
15361 debuggee seen by the debugger.
15362
15363 @kindex set debugmemory
15364 @item set debugmemory
15365 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
15366 and writes by the debugger.
15367
15368 @kindex set shell
15369 @item set shell
15370 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
15371 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
15372
15373 @kindex show shell
15374 @item show shell
15375 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
15376
15377 @end table
15378
15379 @menu
15380 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
15381 @end menu
15382
15383 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
15384 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
15385 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
15386 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
15387
15388 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
15389 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
15390 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
15391 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
15392 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
15393 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
15394 ``minimal symbols''.
15395
15396 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
15397 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
15398 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
15399 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
15400 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
15401 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
15402 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
15403 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
15404 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
15405 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
15406
15407 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
15408
15409 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
15410 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
15411 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
15412 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
15413 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
15414 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
15415 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
15416 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
15417 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
15418
15419 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
15420 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
15421 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
15422 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
15423 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
15424 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
15425
15426 @smallexample
15427 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
15428 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
15429
15430 Non-debugging symbols:
15431 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
15432 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
15433 @end smallexample
15434
15435 @smallexample
15436 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
15437 All functions matching regular expression "!":
15438
15439 Non-debugging symbols:
15440 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
15441 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
15442 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
15443 [etc...]
15444 @end smallexample
15445
15446 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
15447
15448 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
15449 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
15450 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
15451 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
15452 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
15453 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
15454 a function within a DLL without a running program.
15455
15456 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
15457 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
15458 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
15459 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
15460 problem:
15461
15462 @smallexample
15463 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
15464 $1 = 268572168
15465 @end smallexample
15466
15467 @smallexample
15468 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
15469 0x10021610: "\230y\""
15470 @end smallexample
15471
15472 And two possible solutions:
15473
15474 @smallexample
15475 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
15476 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15477 @end smallexample
15478
15479 @smallexample
15480 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
15481 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
15482 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
15483 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
15484 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
15485 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15486 @end smallexample
15487
15488 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
15489 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
15490 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
15491 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
15492 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
15493
15494 @smallexample
15495 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
15496 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
15497 @end smallexample
15498
15499 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
15500 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
15501 safe.
15502
15503 @node Hurd Native
15504 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
15505 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
15506
15507 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
15508 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
15509
15510 @table @code
15511 @item set signals
15512 @itemx set sigs
15513 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
15514 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15515 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
15516 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
15517 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
15518 @code{signals}.
15519
15520 @item show signals
15521 @itemx show sigs
15522 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
15523 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15524 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
15525
15526 @item set signal-thread
15527 @itemx set sigthread
15528 @kindex set signal-thread
15529 @kindex set sigthread
15530 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
15531 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
15532 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
15533 signal-thread}.
15534
15535 @item show signal-thread
15536 @itemx show sigthread
15537 @kindex show signal-thread
15538 @kindex show sigthread
15539 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
15540 delivered a signal.
15541
15542 @item set stopped
15543 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15544 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
15545 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
15546 continued by delivering a signal to it.
15547
15548 @item show stopped
15549 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15550 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
15551 stopped.
15552
15553 @item set exceptions
15554 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15555 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
15556 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
15557 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
15558 trapping on.
15559
15560 @item show exceptions
15561 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15562 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
15563
15564 @item set task pause
15565 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
15566 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15567 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15568 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
15569 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
15570 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
15571 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
15572 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
15573 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
15574
15575 @item show task pause
15576 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
15577 Show the current state of task suspension.
15578
15579 @item set task detach-suspend-count
15580 @cindex task suspend count
15581 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15582 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
15583 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
15584
15585 @item show task detach-suspend-count
15586 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
15587
15588 @item set task exception-port
15589 @itemx set task excp
15590 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15591 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
15592 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
15593 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
15594
15595 @item set noninvasive
15596 @cindex noninvasive task options
15597 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
15598 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
15599 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
15600 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
15601
15602 @item info send-rights
15603 @itemx info receive-rights
15604 @itemx info port-rights
15605 @itemx info port-sets
15606 @itemx info dead-names
15607 @itemx info ports
15608 @itemx info psets
15609 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15610 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15611 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15612 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15613 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15614 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15615 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15616 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15617 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15618
15619 @item set thread pause
15620 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15621 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15622 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15623 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15624 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15625 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15626 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15627 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15628 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15629 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15630 only the current thread.
15631
15632 @item show thread pause
15633 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15634 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15635
15636 @item set thread run
15637 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15638
15639 @item show thread run
15640 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15641
15642 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
15643 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15644 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15645 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15646 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15647 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15648 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15649
15650 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
15651 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15652 detaching.
15653
15654 @item set thread exception-port
15655 @itemx set thread excp
15656 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15657 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15658 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15659
15660 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15661 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15662 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15663 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15664
15665 @item set thread default
15666 @itemx show thread default
15667 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15668 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15669 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15670 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15671 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15672 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15673 the non-default commands.
15674 @end table
15675
15676
15677 @node Neutrino
15678 @subsection QNX Neutrino
15679 @cindex QNX Neutrino
15680
15681 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15682 Neutrino target:
15683
15684 @table @code
15685 @item set debug nto-debug
15686 @kindex set debug nto-debug
15687 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15688 Neutrino support.
15689
15690 @item show debug nto-debug
15691 @kindex show debug nto-debug
15692 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15693 @end table
15694
15695 @node Darwin
15696 @subsection Darwin
15697 @cindex Darwin
15698
15699 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
15700
15701 @table @code
15702 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
15703 @kindex set debug darwin
15704 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
15705 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
15706
15707 @item show debug darwin
15708 @kindex show debug darwin
15709 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
15710
15711 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
15712 @kindex set debug mach-o
15713 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
15714 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
15715 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
15716 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
15717 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
15718 usage.
15719
15720 @item show debug mach-o
15721 @kindex show debug mach-o
15722 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
15723
15724 @item set mach-exceptions on
15725 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
15726 @kindex set mach-exceptions
15727 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
15728 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
15729 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
15730 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
15731
15732 @item show mach-exceptions
15733 @kindex show mach-exceptions
15734 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
15735 @end table
15736
15737
15738 @node Embedded OS
15739 @section Embedded Operating Systems
15740
15741 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15742 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15743 architectures.
15744
15745 @menu
15746 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15747 @end menu
15748
15749 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15750 various real-time operating systems.
15751
15752 @node VxWorks
15753 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15754
15755 @cindex VxWorks
15756
15757 @table @code
15758
15759 @kindex target vxworks
15760 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15761 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15762 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15763
15764 @end table
15765
15766 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15767 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15768
15769 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15770 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
15771 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15772 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
15773 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
15774 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
15775 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
15776
15777 @table @code
15778 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
15779 @kindex vxworks-timeout
15780 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
15781 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15782 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
15783 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
15784 of a thin network line.
15785 @end table
15786
15787 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
15788 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
15789 procedures.
15790
15791 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
15792 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
15793 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
15794 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
15795 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
15796 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
15797 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
15798 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
15799 manual.
15800 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
15801
15802 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
15803 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15804 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
15805 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
15806
15807 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15808
15809 @smallexample
15810 (vxgdb)
15811 @end smallexample
15812
15813 @menu
15814 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
15815 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
15816 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
15817 @end menu
15818
15819 @node VxWorks Connection
15820 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
15821
15822 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
15823 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
15824
15825 @smallexample
15826 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
15827 @end smallexample
15828
15829 @need 750
15830 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15831
15832 @smallexample
15833 Attaching remote machine across net...
15834 Connected to tt.
15835 @end smallexample
15836
15837 @need 1000
15838 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
15839 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
15840 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
15841 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
15842 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
15843
15844 @smallexample
15845 prog.o: No such file or directory.
15846 @end smallexample
15847
15848 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
15849 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
15850 command again.
15851
15852 @node VxWorks Download
15853 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
15854
15855 @cindex download to VxWorks
15856 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
15857 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
15858 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
15859 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
15860 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
15861 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
15862 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
15863 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
15864 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
15865 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
15866 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
15867 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
15868 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
15869 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
15870 program, type this on VxWorks:
15871
15872 @smallexample
15873 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
15874 @end smallexample
15875
15876 @noindent
15877 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15878
15879 @smallexample
15880 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
15881 (vxgdb) load prog.o
15882 @end smallexample
15883
15884 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
15885
15886 @smallexample
15887 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
15888 @end smallexample
15889
15890 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
15891 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
15892 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
15893 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
15894 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
15895 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
15896 table.)
15897
15898 @node VxWorks Attach
15899 @subsubsection Running Tasks
15900
15901 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
15902 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
15903 follows:
15904
15905 @smallexample
15906 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
15907 @end smallexample
15908
15909 @noindent
15910 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
15911 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
15912 the time of attachment.
15913
15914 @node Embedded Processors
15915 @section Embedded Processors
15916
15917 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
15918 configurations.
15919
15920 @cindex send command to simulator
15921 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
15922 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
15923
15924 @table @code
15925 @item sim @var{command}
15926 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
15927 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
15928 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
15929 acceptable commands.
15930 @end table
15931
15932
15933 @menu
15934 * ARM:: ARM RDI
15935 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
15936 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
15937 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
15938 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
15939 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
15940 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
15941 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
15942 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
15943 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
15944 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
15945 * CRIS:: CRIS
15946 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
15947 @end menu
15948
15949 @node ARM
15950 @subsection ARM
15951 @cindex ARM RDI
15952
15953 @table @code
15954 @kindex target rdi
15955 @item target rdi @var{dev}
15956 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
15957 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
15958 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
15959
15960 @kindex target rdp
15961 @item target rdp @var{dev}
15962 ARM Demon monitor.
15963
15964 @end table
15965
15966 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
15967
15968 @table @code
15969 @item set arm disassembler
15970 @kindex set arm
15971 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
15972 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
15973
15974 @item show arm disassembler
15975 @kindex show arm
15976 Show the current disassembly style.
15977
15978 @item set arm apcs32
15979 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
15980 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
15981
15982 @item show arm apcs32
15983 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15984
15985 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15986 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15987 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15988
15989 @table @code
15990 @item auto
15991 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15992 @item softfpa
15993 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15994 processors.
15995 @item fpa
15996 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15997 @item softvfp
15998 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15999 @item vfp
16000 VFP co-processor.
16001 @end table
16002
16003 @item show arm fpu
16004 Show the current type of the FPU.
16005
16006 @item set arm abi
16007 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
16008
16009 @item show arm abi
16010 Show the currently used ABI.
16011
16012 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16013 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
16014 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
16015 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
16016 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
16017 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
16018 register).
16019
16020 @item show arm fallback-mode
16021 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
16022
16023 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16024 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
16025 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
16026 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
16027 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
16028
16029 @item show arm force-mode
16030 Show the current forced instruction mode.
16031
16032 @item set debug arm
16033 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
16034 target support subsystem.
16035
16036 @item show debug arm
16037 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
16038 @end table
16039
16040 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
16041 using the RDI interface:
16042
16043 @table @code
16044 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16045 @kindex rdilogfile
16046 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
16047 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
16048 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
16049 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
16050 @file{rdi.log}.
16051
16052 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
16053 @kindex rdilogenable
16054 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
16055 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
16056 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
16057 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
16058 are logged to a file.
16059
16060 @item set rdiromatzero
16061 @kindex set rdiromatzero
16062 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
16063 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
16064 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
16065 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
16066 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
16067
16068 @item show rdiromatzero
16069 @kindex show rdiromatzero
16070 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
16071
16072 @item set rdiheartbeat
16073 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
16074 @cindex RDI heartbeat
16075 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
16076 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
16077 well as the Angel monitor.
16078
16079 @item show rdiheartbeat
16080 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
16081 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
16082 @end table
16083
16084
16085 @node M32R/D
16086 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
16087
16088 @table @code
16089 @kindex target m32r
16090 @item target m32r @var{dev}
16091 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
16092
16093 @kindex target m32rsdi
16094 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
16095 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
16096 @end table
16097
16098 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
16099
16100 @table @code
16101 @item set download-path @var{path}
16102 @kindex set download-path
16103 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
16104 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16105
16106 @item show download-path
16107 @kindex show download-path
16108 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16109
16110 @item set board-address @var{addr}
16111 @kindex set board-address
16112 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
16113 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
16114
16115 @item show board-address
16116 @kindex show board-address
16117 Show the current IP address of the target board.
16118
16119 @item set server-address @var{addr}
16120 @kindex set server-address
16121 @cindex download server address (M32R)
16122 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
16123 host machine.
16124
16125 @item show server-address
16126 @kindex show server-address
16127 Display the IP address of the download server.
16128
16129 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16130 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
16131 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
16132 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
16133 executable file is uploaded.
16134
16135 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16136 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
16137 Test the @code{upload} command.
16138 @end table
16139
16140 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
16141
16142 @table @code
16143 @item sdireset
16144 @kindex sdireset
16145 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
16146 This command resets the SDI connection.
16147
16148 @item sdistatus
16149 @kindex sdistatus
16150 This command shows the SDI connection status.
16151
16152 @item debug_chaos
16153 @kindex debug_chaos
16154 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
16155 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
16156
16157 @item use_debug_dma
16158 @kindex use_debug_dma
16159 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
16160
16161 @item use_mon_code
16162 @kindex use_mon_code
16163 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
16164
16165 @item use_ib_break
16166 @kindex use_ib_break
16167 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
16168
16169 @item use_dbt_break
16170 @kindex use_dbt_break
16171 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
16172 @end table
16173
16174 @node M68K
16175 @subsection M68k
16176
16177 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
16178 target command for the following ROM monitor.
16179
16180 @table @code
16181
16182 @kindex target dbug
16183 @item target dbug @var{dev}
16184 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
16185
16186 @end table
16187
16188 @node MIPS Embedded
16189 @subsection MIPS Embedded
16190
16191 @cindex MIPS boards
16192 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
16193 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
16194 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
16195
16196 @need 1000
16197 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
16198
16199 @table @code
16200 @item target mips @var{port}
16201 @kindex target mips @var{port}
16202 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
16203 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
16204 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
16205 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
16206 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
16207 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
16208
16209 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
16210 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
16211 debugger:
16212
16213 @smallexample
16214 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
16215 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
16216 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
16217 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
16218 (@value{GDBP}) run
16219 @end smallexample
16220
16221 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
16222 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
16223 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
16224 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
16225 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
16226
16227 @item target pmon @var{port}
16228 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
16229 PMON ROM monitor.
16230
16231 @item target ddb @var{port}
16232 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
16233 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
16234
16235 @item target lsi @var{port}
16236 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
16237 LSI variant of PMON.
16238
16239 @kindex target r3900
16240 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
16241 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
16242
16243 @kindex target array
16244 @item target array @var{dev}
16245 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
16246
16247 @end table
16248
16249
16250 @noindent
16251 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
16252
16253 @table @code
16254 @item set mipsfpu double
16255 @itemx set mipsfpu single
16256 @itemx set mipsfpu none
16257 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
16258 @itemx show mipsfpu
16259 @kindex set mipsfpu
16260 @kindex show mipsfpu
16261 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
16262 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
16263 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
16264 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
16265 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
16266 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
16267 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
16268 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
16269 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
16270 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
16271 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
16272 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
16273 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
16274
16275 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
16276 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
16277 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
16278
16279 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
16280 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
16281
16282 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
16283 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
16284 @itemx show timeout
16285 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
16286 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
16287 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
16288 @kindex set timeout
16289 @kindex show timeout
16290 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
16291 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
16292 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
16293 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
16294 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
16295 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
16296 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
16297 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
16298 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
16299 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
16300
16301 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
16302 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
16303 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
16304 to run before stopping.
16305
16306 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
16307 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16308 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
16309 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
16310 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
16311 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
16312
16313 @item show syn-garbage-limit
16314 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16315 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
16316 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
16317
16318 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
16319 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16320 @cindex remote monitor prompt
16321 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
16322 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
16323 @table @asis
16324 @item pmon target
16325 @samp{PMON}
16326 @item ddb target
16327 @samp{NEC010}
16328 @item lsi target
16329 @samp{PMON>}
16330 @end table
16331
16332 @item show monitor-prompt
16333 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16334 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
16335 remote monitor.
16336
16337 @item set monitor-warnings
16338 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16339 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
16340 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
16341 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
16342 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
16343
16344 @item show monitor-warnings
16345 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16346 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
16347
16348 @item pmon @var{command}
16349 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
16350 @cindex send PMON command
16351 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
16352 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
16353 @end table
16354
16355 @node OpenRISC 1000
16356 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
16357 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
16358
16359 @cindex or1k boards
16360 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
16361 about platform and commands.
16362
16363 @table @code
16364
16365 @kindex target jtag
16366 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
16367
16368 Connects to remote JTAG server.
16369 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
16370 connected via parallel port to the board.
16371
16372 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
16373
16374 @kindex or1ksim
16375 @item or1ksim @var{command}
16376 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
16377 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
16378
16379 @kindex info or1k spr
16380 @item info or1k spr
16381 Displays spr groups.
16382
16383 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
16384 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
16385 Displays register names in selected group.
16386
16387 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
16388 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
16389 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
16390 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
16391 Shows information about specified spr register.
16392
16393 @kindex spr
16394 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
16395 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
16396 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
16397 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
16398 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
16399 @end table
16400
16401 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
16402 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
16403 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
16404 triggers can be set using:
16405 @table @code
16406 @item $LEA/$LDATA
16407 Load effective address/data
16408 @item $SEA/$SDATA
16409 Store effective address/data
16410 @item $AEA/$ADATA
16411 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
16412 @item $FETCH
16413 Fetch data
16414 @end table
16415
16416 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
16417 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
16418
16419 @code{htrace} commands:
16420 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
16421 @table @code
16422 @kindex hwatch
16423 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
16424 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
16425 or Data. For example:
16426
16427 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16428
16429 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16430
16431 @kindex htrace
16432 @item htrace info
16433 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
16434
16435 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
16436 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
16437
16438 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
16439 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
16440
16441 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
16442 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
16443
16444 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
16445 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
16446 triggered.
16447
16448 @item htrace enable
16449 @itemx htrace disable
16450 Enables/disables the HW trace.
16451
16452 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
16453 Clears currently recorded trace data.
16454
16455 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
16456 will be written there.
16457
16458 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
16459 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
16460
16461 @item htrace mode continuous
16462 Set continuous trace mode.
16463
16464 @item htrace mode suspend
16465 Set suspend trace mode.
16466
16467 @end table
16468
16469 @node PowerPC Embedded
16470 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
16471
16472 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
16473
16474 @table @code
16475 @kindex set powerpc
16476 @item set powerpc soft-float
16477 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
16478 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
16479 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
16480 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16481
16482 @item set powerpc vector-abi
16483 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
16484 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
16485 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
16486 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
16487 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
16488 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
16489 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16490
16491 @kindex target dink32
16492 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
16493 DINK32 ROM monitor.
16494
16495 @kindex target ppcbug
16496 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
16497 @kindex target ppcbug1
16498 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
16499 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
16500
16501 @kindex target sds
16502 @item target sds @var{dev}
16503 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
16504 @end table
16505
16506 @cindex SDS protocol
16507 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
16508 by @value{GDBN}:
16509
16510 @table @code
16511 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
16512 @kindex set sdstimeout
16513 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
16514 default is 2 seconds.
16515
16516 @item show sdstimeout
16517 @kindex show sdstimeout
16518 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
16519
16520 @item sds @var{command}
16521 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
16522 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
16523 @end table
16524
16525
16526 @node PA
16527 @subsection HP PA Embedded
16528
16529 @table @code
16530
16531 @kindex target op50n
16532 @item target op50n @var{dev}
16533 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
16534
16535 @kindex target w89k
16536 @item target w89k @var{dev}
16537 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
16538
16539 @end table
16540
16541 @node Sparclet
16542 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
16543
16544 @cindex Sparclet
16545
16546 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
16547 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
16548 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16549 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
16550 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
16551
16552 @table @code
16553 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
16554 @kindex remotetimeout
16555 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
16556 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16557 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
16558 @end table
16559
16560 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
16561 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
16562 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
16563 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
16564 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
16565
16566 @smallexample
16567 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
16568 @end smallexample
16569
16570 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
16571
16572 @smallexample
16573 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
16574 @end smallexample
16575
16576 @cindex running, on Sparclet
16577 Once you have set
16578 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16579 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
16580 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
16581
16582 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16583
16584 @smallexample
16585 (gdbslet)
16586 @end smallexample
16587
16588 @menu
16589 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
16590 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
16591 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
16592 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
16593 @end menu
16594
16595 @node Sparclet File
16596 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
16597
16598 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
16599
16600 @smallexample
16601 (gdbslet) file prog
16602 @end smallexample
16603
16604 @need 1000
16605 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
16606 @value{GDBN} locates
16607 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
16608 path.
16609 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
16610 files will be searched as well.
16611 @value{GDBN} locates
16612 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
16613 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
16614 If it fails
16615 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
16616
16617 @smallexample
16618 prog: No such file or directory.
16619 @end smallexample
16620
16621 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
16622 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
16623 @code{target} command again.
16624
16625 @node Sparclet Connection
16626 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
16627
16628 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
16629 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
16630
16631 @smallexample
16632 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
16633 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
16634 main () at ../prog.c:3
16635 @end smallexample
16636
16637 @need 750
16638 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16639
16640 @smallexample
16641 Connected to ttya.
16642 @end smallexample
16643
16644 @node Sparclet Download
16645 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
16646
16647 @cindex download to Sparclet
16648 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
16649 you can use the @value{GDBN}
16650 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
16651 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
16652 command.
16653 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
16654 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16655 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16656 of each of the file's sections.
16657 For instance, if the program
16658 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16659 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16660
16661 @smallexample
16662 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16663 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16664 @end smallexample
16665
16666 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16667 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16668 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16669
16670 @node Sparclet Execution
16671 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
16672
16673 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16674 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16675 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16676 manual for the list of commands.
16677
16678 @smallexample
16679 (gdbslet) b main
16680 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16681 (gdbslet) run
16682 Starting program: prog
16683 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
16684 3 char *symarg = 0;
16685 (gdbslet) step
16686 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
16687 (gdbslet)
16688 @end smallexample
16689
16690 @node Sparclite
16691 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16692
16693 @table @code
16694
16695 @kindex target sparclite
16696 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
16697 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16698 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16699 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16700 remote protocol.
16701
16702 @end table
16703
16704 @node Z8000
16705 @subsection Zilog Z8000
16706
16707 @cindex Z8000
16708 @cindex simulator, Z8000
16709 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16710
16711 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16712 a Z8000 simulator.
16713
16714 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16715 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16716 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16717 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16718
16719 @table @code
16720 @item target sim @var{args}
16721 @kindex sim
16722 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16723 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16724 options, specify them via @var{args}.
16725 @end table
16726
16727 @noindent
16728 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16729 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16730 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16731 to run your program, and so on.
16732
16733 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16734 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16735 additional items of information as specially named registers:
16736
16737 @table @code
16738
16739 @item cycles
16740 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16741
16742 @item insts
16743 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16744
16745 @item time
16746 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16747
16748 @end table
16749
16750 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16751 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16752 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16753 simulated clock ticks.
16754
16755 @node AVR
16756 @subsection Atmel AVR
16757 @cindex AVR
16758
16759 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16760 following AVR-specific commands:
16761
16762 @table @code
16763 @item info io_registers
16764 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16765 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16766 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16767 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16768 @end table
16769
16770 @node CRIS
16771 @subsection CRIS
16772 @cindex CRIS
16773
16774 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
16775 following CRIS-specific commands:
16776
16777 @table @code
16778 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
16779 @cindex CRIS version
16780 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
16781 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
16782 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
16783
16784 @item show cris-version
16785 Show the current CRIS version.
16786
16787 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
16788 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
16789 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
16790 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
16791 @code{R59}.
16792
16793 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
16794 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
16795
16796 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
16797 @cindex CRIS mode
16798 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
16799 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
16800 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
16801
16802 @item show cris-mode
16803 Show the current CRIS mode.
16804 @end table
16805
16806 @node Super-H
16807 @subsection Renesas Super-H
16808 @cindex Super-H
16809
16810 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
16811 commands:
16812
16813 @table @code
16814 @item regs
16815 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
16816 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
16817
16818 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
16819 @kindex set sh calling-convention
16820 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
16821 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
16822 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
16823 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
16824 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
16825 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
16826 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
16827 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
16828 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
16829 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
16830
16831 @item show sh calling-convention
16832 @kindex show sh calling-convention
16833 Show the current calling convention setting.
16834
16835 @end table
16836
16837
16838 @node Architectures
16839 @section Architectures
16840
16841 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
16842 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
16843
16844 @menu
16845 * i386::
16846 * A29K::
16847 * Alpha::
16848 * MIPS::
16849 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
16850 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16851 * PowerPC::
16852 @end menu
16853
16854 @node i386
16855 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
16856
16857 @table @code
16858 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
16859 @kindex set struct-convention
16860 @cindex struct return convention
16861 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
16862 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
16863 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
16864 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
16865 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
16866 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
16867 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
16868 be returned in a register.
16869
16870 @item show struct-convention
16871 @kindex show struct-convention
16872 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
16873 from functions.
16874 @end table
16875
16876 @node A29K
16877 @subsection A29K
16878
16879 @table @code
16880
16881 @kindex set rstack_high_address
16882 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
16883 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
16884 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
16885 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
16886 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
16887 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
16888 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
16889 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
16890 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
16891 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
16892 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
16893 hexadecimal.
16894
16895 @kindex show rstack_high_address
16896 @item show rstack_high_address
16897 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
16898 processors.
16899
16900 @end table
16901
16902 @node Alpha
16903 @subsection Alpha
16904
16905 See the following section.
16906
16907 @node MIPS
16908 @subsection MIPS
16909
16910 @cindex stack on Alpha
16911 @cindex stack on MIPS
16912 @cindex Alpha stack
16913 @cindex MIPS stack
16914 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
16915 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
16916 find the beginning of a function.
16917
16918 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
16919 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
16920 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
16921 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
16922 commands:
16923
16924 @table @code
16925 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
16926 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
16927 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
16928 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
16929 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
16930 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
16931 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
16932 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
16933
16934 @item show heuristic-fence-post
16935 Display the current limit.
16936 @end table
16937
16938 @noindent
16939 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
16940 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
16941
16942 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
16943 programs:
16944
16945 @table @code
16946 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
16947 @kindex set mips abi
16948 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
16949 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
16950 values of @var{arg} are:
16951
16952 @table @samp
16953 @item auto
16954 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
16955 default).
16956 @item o32
16957 @item o64
16958 @item n32
16959 @item n64
16960 @item eabi32
16961 @item eabi64
16962 @item auto
16963 @end table
16964
16965 @item show mips abi
16966 @kindex show mips abi
16967 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
16968
16969 @item set mipsfpu
16970 @itemx show mipsfpu
16971 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
16972
16973 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
16974 @kindex set mips mask-address
16975 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
16976 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
16977 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
16978 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
16979 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
16980
16981 @item show mips mask-address
16982 @kindex show mips mask-address
16983 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16984 not.
16985
16986 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16987 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16988 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16989 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16990 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16991 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16992
16993 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16994 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16995 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16996
16997 @item set debug mips
16998 @kindex set debug mips
16999 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
17000 target code in @value{GDBN}.
17001
17002 @item show debug mips
17003 @kindex show debug mips
17004 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
17005 @end table
17006
17007
17008 @node HPPA
17009 @subsection HPPA
17010 @cindex HPPA support
17011
17012 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
17013 following special commands:
17014
17015 @table @code
17016 @item set debug hppa
17017 @kindex set debug hppa
17018 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
17019 messages are to be displayed.
17020
17021 @item show debug hppa
17022 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
17023
17024 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
17025 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
17026 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
17027 given @var{address}.
17028
17029 @end table
17030
17031
17032 @node SPU
17033 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17034 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
17035 @cindex SPU
17036
17037 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
17038 it provides the following special commands:
17039
17040 @table @code
17041 @item info spu event
17042 @kindex info spu
17043 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
17044 and pending event status.
17045
17046 @item info spu signal
17047 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
17048 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
17049 notification channels.
17050
17051 @item info spu mailbox
17052 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
17053 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
17054 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
17055
17056 @item info spu dma
17057 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17058 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17059 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17060
17061 @item info spu proxydma
17062 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17063 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17064 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17065
17066 @end table
17067
17068 @node PowerPC
17069 @subsection PowerPC
17070 @cindex PowerPC architecture
17071
17072 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
17073 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
17074 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
17075 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
17076 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
17077
17078 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
17079 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
17080 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
17081
17082 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
17083 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
17084
17085
17086 @node Controlling GDB
17087 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
17088
17089 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
17090 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
17091 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
17092 described here.
17093
17094 @menu
17095 * Prompt:: Prompt
17096 * Editing:: Command editing
17097 * Command History:: Command history
17098 * Screen Size:: Screen size
17099 * Numbers:: Numbers
17100 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
17101 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
17102 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
17103 @end menu
17104
17105 @node Prompt
17106 @section Prompt
17107
17108 @cindex prompt
17109
17110 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
17111 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
17112 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
17113 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
17114 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
17115 which one you are talking to.
17116
17117 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
17118 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
17119 or a prompt that does not.
17120
17121 @table @code
17122 @kindex set prompt
17123 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
17124 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
17125
17126 @kindex show prompt
17127 @item show prompt
17128 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
17129 @end table
17130
17131 @node Editing
17132 @section Command Editing
17133 @cindex readline
17134 @cindex command line editing
17135
17136 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
17137 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
17138 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
17139 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
17140 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
17141 debugging sessions.
17142
17143 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
17144 command @code{set}.
17145
17146 @table @code
17147 @kindex set editing
17148 @cindex editing
17149 @item set editing
17150 @itemx set editing on
17151 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
17152
17153 @item set editing off
17154 Disable command line editing.
17155
17156 @kindex show editing
17157 @item show editing
17158 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
17159 @end table
17160
17161 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
17162 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
17163 encouraged to read that chapter.
17164
17165 @node Command History
17166 @section Command History
17167 @cindex command history
17168
17169 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
17170 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
17171 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
17172 history facility.
17173
17174 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
17175 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
17176 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
17177
17178 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
17179 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
17180 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
17181 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
17182 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
17183 pressed on a line by itself.
17184
17185 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
17186 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
17187 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
17188 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
17189
17190 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
17191 history.
17192
17193 @table @code
17194 @cindex history substitution
17195 @cindex history file
17196 @kindex set history filename
17197 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
17198 @item set history filename @var{fname}
17199 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
17200 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
17201 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
17202 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
17203 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
17204 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
17205 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
17206 is not set.
17207
17208 @cindex save command history
17209 @kindex set history save
17210 @item set history save
17211 @itemx set history save on
17212 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
17213 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
17214
17215 @item set history save off
17216 Stop recording command history in a file.
17217
17218 @cindex history size
17219 @kindex set history size
17220 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
17221 @item set history size @var{size}
17222 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
17223 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
17224 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
17225 @end table
17226
17227 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
17228 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
17229
17230 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
17231 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
17232 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
17233 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
17234 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
17235 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
17236 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
17237 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
17238
17239 The commands to control history expansion are:
17240
17241 @table @code
17242 @item set history expansion on
17243 @itemx set history expansion
17244 @kindex set history expansion
17245 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
17246
17247 @item set history expansion off
17248 Disable history expansion.
17249
17250 @c @group
17251 @kindex show history
17252 @item show history
17253 @itemx show history filename
17254 @itemx show history save
17255 @itemx show history size
17256 @itemx show history expansion
17257 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
17258 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
17259 @c @end group
17260 @end table
17261
17262 @table @code
17263 @kindex show commands
17264 @cindex show last commands
17265 @cindex display command history
17266 @item show commands
17267 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
17268
17269 @item show commands @var{n}
17270 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
17271
17272 @item show commands +
17273 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
17274 @end table
17275
17276 @node Screen Size
17277 @section Screen Size
17278 @cindex size of screen
17279 @cindex pauses in output
17280
17281 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
17282 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
17283 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
17284 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
17285 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
17286 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
17287 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
17288 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
17289
17290 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
17291 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
17292 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
17293 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
17294 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
17295 width} commands:
17296
17297 @table @code
17298 @kindex set height
17299 @kindex set width
17300 @kindex show width
17301 @kindex show height
17302 @item set height @var{lpp}
17303 @itemx show height
17304 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
17305 @itemx show width
17306 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
17307 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
17308 commands display the current settings.
17309
17310 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
17311 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
17312 file or to an editor buffer.
17313
17314 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
17315 from wrapping its output.
17316
17317 @item set pagination on
17318 @itemx set pagination off
17319 @kindex set pagination
17320 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
17321 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
17322
17323 @item show pagination
17324 @kindex show pagination
17325 Show the current pagination mode.
17326 @end table
17327
17328 @node Numbers
17329 @section Numbers
17330 @cindex number representation
17331 @cindex entering numbers
17332
17333 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
17334 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
17335 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
17336 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
17337 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
17338 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
17339 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
17340 both input and output with the commands described below.
17341
17342 @table @code
17343 @kindex set input-radix
17344 @item set input-radix @var{base}
17345 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
17346 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17347 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
17348 example, any of
17349
17350 @smallexample
17351 set input-radix 012
17352 set input-radix 10.
17353 set input-radix 0xa
17354 @end smallexample
17355
17356 @noindent
17357 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
17358 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
17359 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
17360 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
17361 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
17362 change the radix.
17363
17364 @kindex set output-radix
17365 @item set output-radix @var{base}
17366 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
17367 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17368 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
17369
17370 @kindex show input-radix
17371 @item show input-radix
17372 Display the current default base for numeric input.
17373
17374 @kindex show output-radix
17375 @item show output-radix
17376 Display the current default base for numeric display.
17377
17378 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
17379 @itemx show radix
17380 @kindex set radix
17381 @kindex show radix
17382 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
17383 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
17384 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
17385 default value of 10.
17386
17387 @end table
17388
17389 @node ABI
17390 @section Configuring the Current ABI
17391
17392 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
17393 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
17394 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
17395 current ABI.
17396
17397 @cindex OS ABI
17398 @kindex set osabi
17399 @kindex show osabi
17400
17401 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
17402 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
17403 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
17404 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
17405 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
17406 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
17407 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
17408 platform provides.
17409
17410 @table @code
17411 @item show osabi
17412 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
17413
17414 @item set osabi
17415 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
17416
17417 @item set osabi @var{abi}
17418 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
17419 @end table
17420
17421 @cindex float promotion
17422
17423 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
17424 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
17425 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
17426 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
17427 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
17428 @code{double} and then passed.
17429
17430 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
17431 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
17432 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
17433
17434 @table @code
17435 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
17436 @item set coerce-float-to-double
17437 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
17438 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
17439 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
17440
17441 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
17442 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
17443 functions.
17444
17445 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
17446 @item show coerce-float-to-double
17447 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
17448 @end table
17449
17450 @kindex set cp-abi
17451 @kindex show cp-abi
17452 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
17453 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
17454 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
17455 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
17456 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
17457 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
17458 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
17459 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
17460 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
17461 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
17462 ``auto''.
17463
17464 @table @code
17465 @item show cp-abi
17466 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
17467
17468 @item set cp-abi
17469 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
17470
17471 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
17472 @itemx set cp-abi auto
17473 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
17474 @end table
17475
17476 @node Messages/Warnings
17477 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
17478
17479 @cindex verbose operation
17480 @cindex optional warnings
17481 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
17482 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
17483 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
17484 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
17485
17486 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
17487 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
17488 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17489
17490 @table @code
17491 @kindex set verbose
17492 @item set verbose on
17493 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17494
17495 @item set verbose off
17496 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17497
17498 @kindex show verbose
17499 @item show verbose
17500 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
17501 @end table
17502
17503 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
17504 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
17505 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
17506 Symbol Files}).
17507
17508 @table @code
17509
17510 @kindex set complaints
17511 @item set complaints @var{limit}
17512 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
17513 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
17514 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
17515 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
17516
17517 @kindex show complaints
17518 @item show complaints
17519 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
17520
17521 @end table
17522
17523 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
17524 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
17525 you try to run a program which is already running:
17526
17527 @smallexample
17528 (@value{GDBP}) run
17529 The program being debugged has been started already.
17530 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
17531 @end smallexample
17532
17533 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
17534 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
17535
17536 @table @code
17537
17538 @kindex set confirm
17539 @cindex flinching
17540 @cindex confirmation
17541 @cindex stupid questions
17542 @item set confirm off
17543 Disables confirmation requests.
17544
17545 @item set confirm on
17546 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
17547
17548 @kindex show confirm
17549 @item show confirm
17550 Displays state of confirmation requests.
17551
17552 @end table
17553
17554 @cindex command tracing
17555 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
17556 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
17557 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
17558 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
17559
17560 @table @code
17561 @kindex set trace-commands
17562 @cindex command scripts, debugging
17563 @item set trace-commands on
17564 Enable command tracing.
17565 @item set trace-commands off
17566 Disable command tracing.
17567 @item show trace-commands
17568 Display the current state of command tracing.
17569 @end table
17570
17571 @node Debugging Output
17572 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
17573 @cindex optional debugging messages
17574
17575 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
17576 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
17577 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
17578 section documents those commands.
17579
17580 @table @code
17581 @kindex set exec-done-display
17582 @item set exec-done-display
17583 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
17584 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
17585 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
17586 @kindex show exec-done-display
17587 @item show exec-done-display
17588 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
17589 notification.
17590 @kindex set debug
17591 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
17592 @cindex architecture debugging info
17593 @item set debug arch
17594 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
17595 @kindex show debug
17596 @item show debug arch
17597 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
17598 @item set debug aix-thread
17599 @cindex AIX threads
17600 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
17601 module.
17602 @item show debug aix-thread
17603 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
17604 @item set debug dwarf2-die
17605 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
17606 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
17607 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
17608 A value of zero turns off the display.
17609 @item show debug dwarf2-die
17610 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
17611 @item set debug displaced
17612 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
17613 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
17614 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
17615 @item show debug displaced
17616 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
17617 related to displaced stepping.
17618 @item set debug event
17619 @cindex event debugging info
17620 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
17621 default is off.
17622 @item show debug event
17623 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
17624 info.
17625 @item set debug expression
17626 @cindex expression debugging info
17627 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
17628 expression parsing. The default is off.
17629 @item show debug expression
17630 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
17631 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
17632 @item set debug frame
17633 @cindex frame debugging info
17634 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
17635 default is off.
17636 @item show debug frame
17637 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
17638 info.
17639 @item set debug infrun
17640 @cindex inferior debugging info
17641 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
17642 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
17643 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
17644 @item show debug infrun
17645 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
17646 @item set debug lin-lwp
17647 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
17648 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17649 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
17650 @item show debug lin-lwp
17651 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
17652 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
17653 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
17654 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17655 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
17656 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
17657 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
17658 @item set debug observer
17659 @cindex observer debugging info
17660 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
17661 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17662 @item show debug observer
17663 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17664 @item set debug overload
17665 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17666 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17667 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17668 is off.
17669 @item show debug overload
17670 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17671 debugging info.
17672 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17673 @cindex serial connections, debugging
17674 @cindex debug remote protocol
17675 @cindex remote protocol debugging
17676 @cindex display remote packets
17677 @item set debug remote
17678 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17679 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17680 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17681 @item show debug remote
17682 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17683 @item set debug serial
17684 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17685 default is off.
17686 @item show debug serial
17687 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17688 info.
17689 @item set debug solib-frv
17690 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17691 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17692 @item show debug solib-frv
17693 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17694 messages.
17695 @item set debug target
17696 @cindex target debugging info
17697 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17698 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17699 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17700 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17701 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17702 @item show debug target
17703 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17704 info.
17705 @item set debug timestamp
17706 @cindex timestampping debugging info
17707 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17708 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17709 message.
17710 @item show debug timestamp
17711 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17712 debugging info.
17713 @item set debugvarobj
17714 @cindex variable object debugging info
17715 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17716 info. The default is off.
17717 @item show debugvarobj
17718 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17719 debugging info.
17720 @item set debug xml
17721 @cindex XML parser debugging
17722 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17723 @item show debug xml
17724 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17725 @end table
17726
17727 @node Extending GDB
17728 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17729 @cindex extending GDB
17730
17731 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17732 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17733 Python scripting language.
17734
17735 @menu
17736 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17737 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17738 @end menu
17739
17740 @node Sequences
17741 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
17742
17743 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17744 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17745 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17746 files.
17747
17748 @menu
17749 * Define:: How to define your own commands
17750 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17751 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17752 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
17753 @end menu
17754
17755 @node Define
17756 @subsection User-defined Commands
17757
17758 @cindex user-defined command
17759 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17760 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17761 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17762 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17763 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17764 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17765
17766 @smallexample
17767 define adder
17768 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17769 end
17770 @end smallexample
17771
17772 @noindent
17773 To execute the command use:
17774
17775 @smallexample
17776 adder 1 2 3
17777 @end smallexample
17778
17779 @noindent
17780 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
17781 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
17782 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
17783 functions calls.
17784
17785 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
17786 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
17787 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
17788 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
17789
17790 @smallexample
17791 define adder
17792 if $argc == 2
17793 print $arg0 + $arg1
17794 end
17795 if $argc == 3
17796 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17797 end
17798 end
17799 @end smallexample
17800
17801 @table @code
17802
17803 @kindex define
17804 @item define @var{commandname}
17805 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
17806 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
17807 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
17808 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
17809 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
17810 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
17811
17812 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
17813 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
17814 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17815
17816 @kindex document
17817 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
17818 @item document @var{commandname}
17819 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
17820 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
17821 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
17822 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
17823 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
17824 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
17825
17826 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
17827 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
17828 does not change the documentation.
17829
17830 @kindex dont-repeat
17831 @cindex don't repeat command
17832 @item dont-repeat
17833 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
17834 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
17835 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
17836
17837 @kindex help user-defined
17838 @item help user-defined
17839 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
17840 (if any) for each.
17841
17842 @kindex show user
17843 @item show user
17844 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
17845 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
17846 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
17847 definitions for all user-defined commands.
17848
17849 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
17850 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
17851 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
17852 @item show max-user-call-depth
17853 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
17854 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
17855 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
17856 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
17857 @end table
17858
17859 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
17860 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
17861
17862 When user-defined commands are executed, the
17863 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
17864 stops execution of the user-defined command.
17865
17866 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
17867 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
17868 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
17869 messages when used in a user-defined command.
17870
17871 @node Hooks
17872 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
17873 @cindex command hooks
17874 @cindex hooks, for commands
17875 @cindex hooks, pre-command
17876
17877 @kindex hook
17878 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
17879 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
17880 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
17881 before that command.
17882
17883 @cindex hooks, post-command
17884 @kindex hookpost
17885 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
17886 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
17887 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
17888 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
17889 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
17890
17891 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
17892 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
17893
17894 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
17895 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
17896
17897 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
17898 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
17899 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
17900 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
17901 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
17902
17903 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
17904 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
17905 you could define:
17906
17907 @smallexample
17908 define hook-stop
17909 handle SIGALRM nopass
17910 end
17911
17912 define hook-run
17913 handle SIGALRM pass
17914 end
17915
17916 define hook-continue
17917 handle SIGALRM pass
17918 end
17919 @end smallexample
17920
17921 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
17922 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
17923 you could define:
17924
17925 @smallexample
17926 define hook-echo
17927 echo <<<---
17928 end
17929
17930 define hookpost-echo
17931 echo --->>>\n
17932 end
17933
17934 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
17935 <<<---Hello World--->>>
17936 (@value{GDBP})
17937
17938 @end smallexample
17939
17940 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
17941 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
17942 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
17943 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
17944 @c or not?
17945 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
17946 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
17947 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
17948
17949 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
17950 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
17951 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
17952
17953 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
17954 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
17955
17956 @node Command Files
17957 @subsection Command Files
17958
17959 @cindex command files
17960 @cindex scripting commands
17961 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
17962 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
17963 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
17964 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
17965 terminal.
17966
17967 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
17968 command:
17969
17970 @table @code
17971 @kindex source
17972 @cindex execute commands from a file
17973 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
17974 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
17975 @end table
17976
17977 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
17978 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
17979 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
17980 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
17981 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
17982
17983 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
17984 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
17985
17986 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
17987 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
17988 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
17989
17990 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
17991 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
17992 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
17993 when called from command files.
17994
17995 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
17996 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
17997 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
17998 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
17999 the next command.
18000
18001 @smallexample
18002 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
18003 @end smallexample
18004
18005 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
18006 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
18007 would be directed to @file{log}.
18008
18009 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
18010 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
18011 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
18012 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
18013 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
18014 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
18015 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
18016 conditionally, etc.
18017
18018 @table @code
18019 @kindex if
18020 @kindex else
18021 @item if
18022 @itemx else
18023 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
18024 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
18025 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
18026 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
18027 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
18028 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
18029 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
18030
18031 @kindex while
18032 @item while
18033 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
18034 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
18035 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
18036 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
18037 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
18038 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
18039
18040 @kindex loop_break
18041 @item loop_break
18042 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
18043 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
18044 line.
18045
18046 @kindex loop_continue
18047 @item loop_continue
18048 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
18049 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
18050 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
18051 the controlling expression.
18052
18053 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
18054 @item end
18055 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
18056 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
18057 @end table
18058
18059
18060 @node Output
18061 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
18062
18063 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
18064 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
18065 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
18066 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
18067 want.
18068
18069 @table @code
18070 @kindex echo
18071 @item echo @var{text}
18072 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
18073 @c because it is not in ANSI.
18074 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
18075 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
18076 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
18077 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
18078 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
18079 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
18080 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
18081 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
18082 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
18083
18084 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
18085 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
18086
18087 @smallexample
18088 echo This is some text\n\
18089 which is continued\n\
18090 onto several lines.\n
18091 @end smallexample
18092
18093 produces the same output as
18094
18095 @smallexample
18096 echo This is some text\n
18097 echo which is continued\n
18098 echo onto several lines.\n
18099 @end smallexample
18100
18101 @kindex output
18102 @item output @var{expression}
18103 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
18104 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
18105 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
18106 on expressions.
18107
18108 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
18109 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
18110 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
18111 Formats}, for more information.
18112
18113 @kindex printf
18114 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
18115 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
18116 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
18117 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
18118 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
18119 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
18120 executing the code below:
18121
18122 @smallexample
18123 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
18124 @end smallexample
18125
18126 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
18127 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
18128 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
18129 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
18130 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
18131 printed.
18132
18133 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
18134
18135 @smallexample
18136 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
18137 @end smallexample
18138
18139 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
18140 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
18141 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
18142
18143 @itemize @bullet
18144 @item
18145 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
18146
18147 @item
18148 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
18149 width.
18150
18151 @item
18152 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
18153 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
18154
18155 @item
18156 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
18157 supported.
18158
18159 @item
18160 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
18161
18162 @item
18163 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
18164 @end itemize
18165
18166 @noindent
18167 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
18168 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
18169 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
18170 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
18171
18172 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
18173 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
18174 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
18175 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
18176 supported.
18177
18178 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
18179 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
18180 together with a floating point specifier.
18181 letters:
18182
18183 @itemize @bullet
18184 @item
18185 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
18186
18187 @item
18188 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
18189
18190 @item
18191 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
18192 @end itemize
18193
18194 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
18195 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
18196 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
18197
18198 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
18199 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
18200
18201 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
18202 @smallexample
18203 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
18204 @end smallexample
18205
18206 @end table
18207
18208 @node Python
18209 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
18210 @cindex python scripting
18211 @cindex scripting with python
18212
18213 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
18214 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
18215 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
18216
18217 @menu
18218 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
18219 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
18220 @end menu
18221
18222 @node Python Commands
18223 @subsection Python Commands
18224 @cindex python commands
18225 @cindex commands to access python
18226
18227 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
18228 and one related setting:
18229
18230 @table @code
18231 @kindex python
18232 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
18233 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
18234
18235 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
18236 argument as a Python command. For example:
18237
18238 @smallexample
18239 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
18240 23
18241 @end smallexample
18242
18243 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
18244 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
18245 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
18246 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
18247 containing @code{end}. For example:
18248
18249 @smallexample
18250 (@value{GDBP}) python
18251 Type python script
18252 End with a line saying just "end".
18253 >print 23
18254 >end
18255 23
18256 @end smallexample
18257
18258 @kindex maint set python print-stack
18259 @item maint set python print-stack
18260 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
18261 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
18262 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
18263 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
18264 disabled.
18265 @end table
18266
18267 @node Python API
18268 @subsection Python API
18269 @cindex python api
18270 @cindex programming in python
18271
18272 @cindex python stdout
18273 @cindex python pagination
18274 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
18275 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
18276 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
18277 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
18278 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
18279
18280 @menu
18281 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
18282 * Exception Handling::
18283 * Values From Inferior::
18284 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
18285 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
18286 * Frames In Python:: Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
18287 @end menu
18288
18289 @node Basic Python
18290 @subsubsection Basic Python
18291
18292 @cindex python functions
18293 @cindex python module
18294 @cindex gdb module
18295 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
18296 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
18297 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
18298 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
18299
18300 @findex gdb.execute
18301 @defun execute command [from_tty]
18302 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18303 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
18304 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
18305 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
18306
18307 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
18308 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
18309 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
18310 @end defun
18311
18312 @findex gdb.get_parameter
18313 @defun get_parameter parameter
18314 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
18315 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
18316 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
18317 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
18318
18319 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
18320 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
18321 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
18322 @end defun
18323
18324 @findex gdb.history
18325 @defun history number
18326 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
18327 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
18328 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
18329 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
18330 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
18331 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
18332 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
18333 raised.
18334
18335 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
18336 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
18337 @end defun
18338
18339 @findex gdb.write
18340 @defun write string
18341 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
18342 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
18343 call this function.
18344 @end defun
18345
18346 @findex gdb.flush
18347 @defun flush
18348 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
18349 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
18350 function.
18351 @end defun
18352
18353 @node Exception Handling
18354 @subsubsection Exception Handling
18355 @cindex python exceptions
18356 @cindex exceptions, python
18357
18358 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
18359 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
18360 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
18361 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
18362 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
18363 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
18364 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
18365
18366 @smallexample
18367 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
18368 Traceback (most recent call last):
18369 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
18370 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
18371 @end smallexample
18372
18373 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
18374 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
18375 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
18376 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
18377 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
18378 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
18379 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
18380 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
18381 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
18382 traceback.
18383
18384 @node Values From Inferior
18385 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
18386 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
18387 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
18388
18389 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
18390 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
18391 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
18392 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
18393 fetching values when necessary.
18394
18395 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
18396 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
18397 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
18398
18399 @smallexample
18400 bar = some_val + 2
18401 @end smallexample
18402
18403 @noindent
18404 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
18405 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
18406
18407 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
18408 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
18409 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
18410 can access its @code{foo} element with:
18411
18412 @smallexample
18413 bar = some_val['foo']
18414 @end smallexample
18415
18416 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
18417
18418 The following attributes are provided:
18419
18420 @table @code
18421 @defmethod Value address
18422 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
18423 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
18424 this attribute holds @code{None}.
18425 @end defmethod
18426
18427 @cindex optimized out value in Python
18428 @defmethod Value is_optimized_out
18429 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
18430 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
18431 @end defmethod
18432 @end table
18433
18434 The following methods are provided:
18435
18436 @table @code
18437 @defmethod Value dereference
18438 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
18439 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
18440 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
18441
18442 @smallexample
18443 int *foo;
18444 @end smallexample
18445
18446 @noindent
18447 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
18448 @code{foo} points to like this:
18449
18450 @smallexample
18451 bar = foo.dereference ()
18452 @end smallexample
18453
18454 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
18455 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
18456 @end defmethod
18457
18458 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]}
18459 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
18460 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
18461 throw an exception.
18462
18463 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
18464 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
18465 language.
18466
18467 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
18468 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
18469 by a zero of the appropriate width.
18470
18471 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
18472 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
18473 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
18474 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
18475 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
18476 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
18477 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
18478 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
18479 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
18480
18481 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
18482 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
18483 @end defmethod
18484 @end table
18485
18486 @node Commands In Python
18487 @subsubsection Commands In Python
18488
18489 @cindex commands in python
18490 @cindex python commands
18491 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
18492 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
18493 class, most commonly using a subclass.
18494
18495 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
18496 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
18497 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
18498 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
18499
18500 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
18501 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
18502 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
18503 an exception is raised.
18504
18505 There is no support for multi-line commands.
18506
18507 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
18508 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
18509 new command in the help system.
18510
18511 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
18512 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
18513 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
18514 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
18515 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
18516 error will occur when completion is attempted.
18517
18518 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
18519 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
18520 registered.
18521
18522 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
18523 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
18524 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
18525 not documented.'' is used.
18526 @end defmethod
18527
18528 @cindex don't repeat Python command
18529 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
18530 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
18531 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
18532 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
18533 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
18534 @end defmethod
18535
18536 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
18537 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
18538
18539 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
18540 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
18541
18542 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
18543 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
18544 that the command came from elsewhere.
18545
18546 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
18547 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
18548 @end defmethod
18549
18550 @cindex completion of Python commands
18551 @defmethod Command complete text word
18552 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
18553 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
18554 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
18555 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
18556 complete}).
18557
18558 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
18559 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
18560 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
18561 using a word-breaking heuristic.
18562
18563 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
18564 @itemize @bullet
18565 @item
18566 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
18567 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
18568 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
18569 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
18570 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
18571 sequence are ignored.
18572
18573 @item
18574 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
18575 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
18576 function is invoked, and its result is used.
18577
18578 @item
18579 All other results are treated as though there were no available
18580 completions.
18581 @end itemize
18582 @end defmethod
18583
18584 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
18585 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
18586 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
18587 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
18588 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
18589 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
18590
18591 @table @code
18592 @findex COMMAND_NONE
18593 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
18594 @item COMMAND_NONE
18595 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
18596 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
18597
18598 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
18599 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
18600 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
18601 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
18602 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
18603 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18604 commands in this category.
18605
18606 @findex COMMAND_DATA
18607 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
18608 @item COMMAND_DATA
18609 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
18610 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
18611 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
18612 in this category.
18613
18614 @findex COMMAND_STACK
18615 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
18616 @item COMMAND_STACK
18617 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
18618 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
18619 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
18620 list of commands in this category.
18621
18622 @findex COMMAND_FILES
18623 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
18624 @item COMMAND_FILES
18625 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
18626 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
18627 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18628 commands in this category.
18629
18630 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
18631 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
18632 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
18633 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
18634 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
18635 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
18636 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
18637 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18638 commands in this category.
18639
18640 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
18641 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
18642 @item COMMAND_STATUS
18643 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
18644 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
18645 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
18646 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
18647
18648 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18649 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18650 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18651 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
18652 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
18653 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
18654 this category.
18655
18656 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18657 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18658 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18659 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
18660 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
18661 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18662 commands in this category.
18663
18664 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
18665 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
18666 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
18667 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
18668 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
18669 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
18670 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
18671 category.
18672
18673 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18674 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18675 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18676 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
18677 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
18678 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18679 commands in this category.
18680 @end table
18681
18682 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
18683 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
18684 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
18685 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
18686
18687 @table @code
18688 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
18689 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
18690 @item COMPLETE_NONE
18691 This constant means that no completion should be done.
18692
18693 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
18694 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
18695 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
18696 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
18697
18698 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
18699 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
18700 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
18701 This constant means that location completion should be done.
18702 @xref{Specify Location}.
18703
18704 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
18705 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
18706 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
18707 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
18708 command names.
18709
18710 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18711 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18712 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18713 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
18714 as the source.
18715 @end table
18716
18717 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
18718 implemented in Python:
18719
18720 @smallexample
18721 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
18722 """Greet the whole world."""
18723
18724 def __init__ (self):
18725 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
18726
18727 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
18728 print "Hello, World!"
18729
18730 HelloWorld ()
18731 @end smallexample
18732
18733 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
18734 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
18735 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
18736 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
18737
18738 @node Functions In Python
18739 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
18740
18741 @cindex writing convenience functions
18742 @cindex convenience functions in python
18743 @cindex python convenience functions
18744 @tindex gdb.Function
18745 @tindex Function
18746 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
18747 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
18748 class @code{gdb.Function}.
18749
18750 @defmethod Function __init__ name
18751 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
18752 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
18753 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
18754 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
18755 the given @var{name}.
18756
18757 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
18758 string for the new class.
18759 @end defmethod
18760
18761 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
18762 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
18763 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
18764 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
18765 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
18766 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
18767 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
18768 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
18769
18770 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
18771 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
18772 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
18773 @end defmethod
18774
18775 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
18776 be implemented in Python:
18777
18778 @smallexample
18779 class Greet (gdb.Function):
18780 """Return string to greet someone.
18781 Takes a name as argument."""
18782
18783 def __init__ (self):
18784 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
18785
18786 def invoke (self, name):
18787 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
18788
18789 Greet ()
18790 @end smallexample
18791
18792 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
18793 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
18794 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
18795 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
18796
18797 @node Frames In Python
18798 @subsubsection Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
18799
18800 @cindex frames in python
18801 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
18802 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
18803 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
18804 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
18805 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{RuntimeError}
18806 exception.
18807
18808 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
18809 operator, like:
18810
18811 @smallexample
18812 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
18813 True
18814 @end smallexample
18815
18816 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
18817
18818 @findex gdb.selected_frame
18819 @defun selected_frame
18820 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
18821 @end defun
18822
18823 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
18824 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
18825 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
18826 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
18827 @end defun
18828
18829 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
18830
18831 @table @code
18832 @defmethod Frame is_valid
18833 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
18834 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
18835 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
18836 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
18837 @end defmethod
18838
18839 @defmethod Frame name
18840 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
18841 obtained.
18842 @end defmethod
18843
18844 @defmethod Frame type
18845 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
18846 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
18847 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
18848 @end defmethod
18849
18850 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
18851 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
18852 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
18853 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
18854 function to a string.
18855 @end defmethod
18856
18857 @defmethod Frame pc
18858 Returns the frame's resume address.
18859 @end defmethod
18860
18861 @defmethod Frame older
18862 Return the frame that called this frame.
18863 @end defmethod
18864
18865 @defmethod Frame newer
18866 Return the frame called by this frame.
18867 @end defmethod
18868
18869 @defmethod Frame read_var variable
18870 Return the value of the given variable in this frame. @var{variable} must
18871 be a string.
18872 @end defmethod
18873 @end table
18874
18875 @node Interpreters
18876 @chapter Command Interpreters
18877 @cindex command interpreters
18878
18879 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
18880 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
18881 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
18882
18883 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
18884 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
18885 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
18886 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
18887
18888 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
18889 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
18890 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
18891 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
18892
18893 @table @code
18894 @item console
18895 @cindex console interpreter
18896 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
18897 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
18898 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
18899
18900 @item mi
18901 @cindex mi interpreter
18902 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
18903 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
18904 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
18905 Interface}.
18906
18907 @item mi2
18908 @cindex mi2 interpreter
18909 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
18910
18911 @item mi1
18912 @cindex mi1 interpreter
18913 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
18914
18915 @end table
18916
18917 @cindex invoke another interpreter
18918 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
18919 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
18920 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
18921 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
18922 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
18923 the IDE inoperable!
18924
18925 @kindex interpreter-exec
18926 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
18927 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
18928 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
18929 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
18930
18931 @smallexample
18932 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
18933 @end smallexample
18934
18935 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
18936 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
18937
18938 @node TUI
18939 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
18940 @cindex TUI
18941 @cindex Text User Interface
18942
18943 @menu
18944 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
18945 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
18946 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
18947 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
18948 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
18949 @end menu
18950
18951 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
18952 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
18953 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
18954 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
18955 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
18956 is available.
18957
18958 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
18959 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
18960 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
18961 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
18962 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
18963 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
18964
18965 @node TUI Overview
18966 @section TUI Overview
18967
18968 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
18969
18970 @table @emph
18971 @item command
18972 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
18973 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
18974 managed using readline.
18975
18976 @item source
18977 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
18978 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
18979
18980 @item assembly
18981 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
18982
18983 @item register
18984 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
18985 when their values change.
18986 @end table
18987
18988 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
18989 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
18990 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
18991 indicates the breakpoint type:
18992
18993 @table @code
18994 @item B
18995 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
18996
18997 @item b
18998 Breakpoint which was never hit.
18999
19000 @item H
19001 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
19002
19003 @item h
19004 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
19005 @end table
19006
19007 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
19008
19009 @table @code
19010 @item +
19011 Breakpoint is enabled.
19012
19013 @item -
19014 Breakpoint is disabled.
19015 @end table
19016
19017 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
19018 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
19019 changes.
19020
19021 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
19022 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
19023 layouts:
19024
19025 @itemize @bullet
19026 @item
19027 source only,
19028
19029 @item
19030 assembly only,
19031
19032 @item
19033 source and assembly,
19034
19035 @item
19036 source and registers, or
19037
19038 @item
19039 assembly and registers.
19040 @end itemize
19041
19042 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
19043
19044 @table @emph
19045 @item target
19046 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
19047 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19048
19049 @item process
19050 Gives the current process or thread number.
19051 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
19052
19053 @item function
19054 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
19055 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
19056 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
19057 the string @code{??} is displayed.
19058
19059 @item line
19060 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
19061 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
19062
19063 @item pc
19064 Indicates the current program counter address.
19065 @end table
19066
19067 @node TUI Keys
19068 @section TUI Key Bindings
19069 @cindex TUI key bindings
19070
19071 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
19072 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
19073 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
19074
19075 @table @kbd
19076 @kindex C-x C-a
19077 @item C-x C-a
19078 @kindex C-x a
19079 @itemx C-x a
19080 @kindex C-x A
19081 @itemx C-x A
19082 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
19083 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
19084 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
19085 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
19086 The screen is then refreshed.
19087
19088 @kindex C-x 1
19089 @item C-x 1
19090 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
19091 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
19092 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
19093
19094 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
19095
19096 @kindex C-x 2
19097 @item C-x 2
19098 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
19099 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
19100 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
19101 previous layout and the new one.
19102
19103 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
19104
19105 @kindex C-x o
19106 @item C-x o
19107 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
19108 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
19109 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
19110
19111 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
19112
19113 @kindex C-x s
19114 @item C-x s
19115 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
19116 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
19117 @end table
19118
19119 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
19120
19121 @table @asis
19122 @kindex PgUp
19123 @item @key{PgUp}
19124 Scroll the active window one page up.
19125
19126 @kindex PgDn
19127 @item @key{PgDn}
19128 Scroll the active window one page down.
19129
19130 @kindex Up
19131 @item @key{Up}
19132 Scroll the active window one line up.
19133
19134 @kindex Down
19135 @item @key{Down}
19136 Scroll the active window one line down.
19137
19138 @kindex Left
19139 @item @key{Left}
19140 Scroll the active window one column left.
19141
19142 @kindex Right
19143 @item @key{Right}
19144 Scroll the active window one column right.
19145
19146 @kindex C-L
19147 @item @kbd{C-L}
19148 Refresh the screen.
19149 @end table
19150
19151 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
19152 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
19153 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
19154 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
19155 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
19156
19157 @node TUI Single Key Mode
19158 @section TUI Single Key Mode
19159 @cindex TUI single key mode
19160
19161 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
19162 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
19163 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
19164
19165 @table @kbd
19166 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19167 @item c
19168 continue
19169
19170 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19171 @item d
19172 down
19173
19174 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19175 @item f
19176 finish
19177
19178 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19179 @item n
19180 next
19181
19182 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19183 @item q
19184 exit the SingleKey mode.
19185
19186 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19187 @item r
19188 run
19189
19190 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19191 @item s
19192 step
19193
19194 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19195 @item u
19196 up
19197
19198 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19199 @item v
19200 info locals
19201
19202 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19203 @item w
19204 where
19205 @end table
19206
19207 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
19208 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
19209 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
19210 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
19211 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
19212 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
19213
19214
19215 @node TUI Commands
19216 @section TUI-specific Commands
19217 @cindex TUI commands
19218
19219 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
19220 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
19221 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
19222 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
19223
19224 @table @code
19225 @item info win
19226 @kindex info win
19227 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
19228
19229 @item layout next
19230 @kindex layout
19231 Display the next layout.
19232
19233 @item layout prev
19234 Display the previous layout.
19235
19236 @item layout src
19237 Display the source window only.
19238
19239 @item layout asm
19240 Display the assembly window only.
19241
19242 @item layout split
19243 Display the source and assembly window.
19244
19245 @item layout regs
19246 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
19247
19248 @item focus next
19249 @kindex focus
19250 Make the next window active for scrolling.
19251
19252 @item focus prev
19253 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
19254
19255 @item focus src
19256 Make the source window active for scrolling.
19257
19258 @item focus asm
19259 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
19260
19261 @item focus regs
19262 Make the register window active for scrolling.
19263
19264 @item focus cmd
19265 Make the command window active for scrolling.
19266
19267 @item refresh
19268 @kindex refresh
19269 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
19270
19271 @item tui reg float
19272 @kindex tui reg
19273 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
19274
19275 @item tui reg general
19276 Show the general registers in the register window.
19277
19278 @item tui reg next
19279 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
19280 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
19281 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
19282 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
19283
19284 @item tui reg system
19285 Show the system registers in the register window.
19286
19287 @item update
19288 @kindex update
19289 Update the source window and the current execution point.
19290
19291 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
19292 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
19293 @kindex winheight
19294 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
19295 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
19296 decrease it.
19297
19298 @item tabset @var{nchars}
19299 @kindex tabset
19300 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
19301 @end table
19302
19303 @node TUI Configuration
19304 @section TUI Configuration Variables
19305 @cindex TUI configuration variables
19306
19307 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
19308
19309 @table @code
19310 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
19311 @kindex set tui border-kind
19312 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
19313 The possible values are the following:
19314 @table @code
19315 @item space
19316 Use a space character to draw the border.
19317
19318 @item ascii
19319 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
19320
19321 @item acs
19322 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
19323 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
19324 @end table
19325
19326 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
19327 @kindex set tui border-mode
19328 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
19329 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
19330 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
19331 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
19332 @table @code
19333 @item normal
19334 Use normal attributes to display the border.
19335
19336 @item standout
19337 Use standout mode.
19338
19339 @item reverse
19340 Use reverse video mode.
19341
19342 @item half
19343 Use half bright mode.
19344
19345 @item half-standout
19346 Use half bright and standout mode.
19347
19348 @item bold
19349 Use extra bright or bold mode.
19350
19351 @item bold-standout
19352 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
19353 @end table
19354 @end table
19355
19356 @node Emacs
19357 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
19358
19359 @cindex Emacs
19360 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
19361 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
19362 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
19363 @value{GDBN}.
19364
19365 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
19366 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
19367 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
19368 created Emacs buffer.
19369 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
19370
19371 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
19372 things:
19373
19374 @itemize @bullet
19375 @item
19376 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
19377 the GUD buffer.
19378
19379 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
19380 and output done by the program you are debugging.
19381
19382 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
19383 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
19384 in this way.
19385
19386 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
19387 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
19388 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
19389 stop.
19390
19391 @item
19392 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
19393
19394 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
19395 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
19396 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
19397 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
19398 and the source.
19399
19400 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
19401 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
19402 @end itemize
19403
19404 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
19405 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
19406 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
19407 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
19408
19409 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
19410 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
19411 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
19412 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
19413 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
19414 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
19415 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
19416 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
19417 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
19418
19419 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
19420 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
19421 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
19422 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19423
19424 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
19425 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
19426 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
19427 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
19428 one you want.
19429
19430 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
19431 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
19432
19433 @table @kbd
19434 @item C-h m
19435 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
19436
19437 @item C-c C-s
19438 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
19439 update the display window to show the current file and location.
19440
19441 @item C-c C-n
19442 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
19443 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
19444 to show the current file and location.
19445
19446 @item C-c C-i
19447 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
19448 display window accordingly.
19449
19450 @item C-c C-f
19451 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
19452 @code{finish} command.
19453
19454 @item C-c C-r
19455 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
19456 command.
19457
19458 @item C-c <
19459 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
19460 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
19461 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
19462
19463 @item C-c >
19464 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
19465 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
19466 @end table
19467
19468 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
19469 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
19470
19471 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
19472 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
19473 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
19474 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
19475 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
19476 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
19477 speedbar displays watch expressions.
19478
19479 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
19480 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
19481 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
19482 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
19483 frame.
19484
19485 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
19486 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
19487 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
19488 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
19489 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
19490 to correspond properly with the code.
19491
19492 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
19493 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
19494 Emacs Manual}).
19495
19496 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
19497 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
19498 @ignore
19499 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
19500 @kindex Epoch
19501 @kindex inspect
19502
19503 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
19504 called the @code{epoch}
19505 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
19506 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
19507 each value is printed in its own window.
19508 @end ignore
19509
19510
19511 @node GDB/MI
19512 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
19513
19514 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
19515
19516 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
19517 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
19518 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
19519 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
19520 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
19521 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
19522
19523 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
19524 in the form of a reference manual.
19525
19526 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
19527 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
19528 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
19529
19530 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
19531
19532 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
19533 This chapter uses the following notation:
19534
19535 @itemize @bullet
19536 @item
19537 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
19538
19539 @item
19540 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
19541 it may or may not be given.
19542
19543 @item
19544 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
19545 may repeat zero or more times.
19546
19547 @item
19548 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
19549 may repeat one or more times.
19550
19551 @item
19552 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
19553 @end itemize
19554
19555 @ignore
19556 @heading Dependencies
19557 @end ignore
19558
19559 @menu
19560 * GDB/MI General Design::
19561 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
19562 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
19563 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
19564 * GDB/MI Output Records::
19565 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
19566 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
19567 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
19568 * GDB/MI Program Context::
19569 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
19570 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
19571 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
19572 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
19573 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
19574 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
19575 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
19576 * GDB/MI File Commands::
19577 @ignore
19578 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
19579 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
19580 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
19581 @end ignore
19582 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
19583 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
19584 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
19585 @end menu
19586
19587 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19588 @node GDB/MI General Design
19589 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
19590 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
19591
19592 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
19593 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
19594 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
19595 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
19596 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
19597 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
19598 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
19599 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
19600 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
19601 a command and reported as part of that command response.
19602
19603 The important examples of notifications are:
19604 @itemize @bullet
19605
19606 @item
19607 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
19608 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
19609 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
19610 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
19611 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
19612 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
19613 command itself was successfully executed.
19614
19615 @item
19616 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
19617 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
19618 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
19619 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
19620 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
19621 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
19622
19623 @item
19624 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
19625 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
19626 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
19627 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
19628 orthogonal frontend design.
19629
19630 @end itemize
19631
19632 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
19633 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
19634 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
19635 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
19636 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
19637 the user interface.
19638
19639 @subsection Context management
19640
19641 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
19642 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
19643 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
19644 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
19645 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
19646 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
19647 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
19648 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
19649 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
19650
19651 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
19652 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
19653 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
19654 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
19655 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
19656 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
19657 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
19658 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
19659 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
19660 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
19661 for thread and frame to operate on.
19662
19663 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
19664 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
19665 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
19666 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
19667 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
19668 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
19669 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
19670 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
19671 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
19672 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
19673
19674 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
19675 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
19676 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
19677 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
19678 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
19679 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
19680 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
19681 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
19682 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
19683 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
19684 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
19685 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
19686 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
19687 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
19688 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
19689 @samp{--frame} options.
19690
19691 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
19692
19693 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
19694 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
19695 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
19696 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
19697 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
19698 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
19699 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
19700 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
19701 @code{-list-target-features} command.
19702
19703 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
19704 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
19705 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
19706 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
19707 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
19708 are running.
19709
19710 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
19711 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
19712 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
19713 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
19714 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
19715 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
19716 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
19717 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
19718 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
19719 @samp{--thread} option).
19720
19721 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
19722 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
19723 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
19724 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
19725
19726 @subsection Thread groups
19727 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
19728 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
19729 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
19730 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
19731 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
19732
19733 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
19734 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
19735 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
19736 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
19737 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
19738 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
19739 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
19740 into processes.
19741
19742 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
19743 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
19744 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
19745 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
19746 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
19747 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
19748 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
19749 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
19750 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
19751 the members of specific thread group.
19752
19753 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
19754 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
19755 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
19756 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
19757 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
19758 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
19759 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
19760 after attaching to that thread group.
19761
19762 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19763 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
19764 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
19765
19766 @menu
19767 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
19768 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
19769 @end menu
19770
19771 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
19772 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
19773
19774 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
19775 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
19776 @table @code
19777 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
19778 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
19779
19780 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
19781 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
19782 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
19783
19784 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
19785 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
19786 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
19787
19788 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19789 "any sequence of digits"
19790
19791 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
19792 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
19793
19794 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
19795 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
19796
19797 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
19798 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
19799
19800 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
19801 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
19802 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
19803
19804 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
19805 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
19806
19807 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19808 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19809 @end table
19810
19811 @noindent
19812 Notes:
19813
19814 @itemize @bullet
19815 @item
19816 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
19817 output is described below.
19818
19819 @item
19820 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
19821 finishes.
19822
19823 @item
19824 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
19825 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
19826 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
19827 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
19828 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
19829 @end itemize
19830
19831 Pragmatics:
19832
19833 @itemize @bullet
19834 @item
19835 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
19836
19837 @item
19838 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
19839 @end itemize
19840
19841 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
19842 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
19843
19844 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
19845 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
19846 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
19847 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
19848 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
19849 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
19850
19851 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
19852 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
19853 @var{token}.
19854
19855 @table @code
19856 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
19857 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
19858
19859 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
19860 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
19861
19862 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
19863 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
19864
19865 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
19866 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
19867
19868 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
19869 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
19870
19871 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
19872 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
19873
19874 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
19875 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
19876
19877 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
19878 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
19879
19880 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
19881 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
19882
19883 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
19884 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
19885 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
19886
19887 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
19888 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
19889
19890 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
19891 @code{ @var{string} }
19892
19893 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
19894 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
19895
19896 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
19897 @code{@var{c-string}}
19898
19899 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
19900 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
19901
19902 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
19903 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
19904 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
19905
19906 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
19907 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
19908
19909 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
19910 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
19911
19912 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
19913 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
19914
19915 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
19916 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
19917
19918 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19919 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19920
19921 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19922 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
19923 @end table
19924
19925 @noindent
19926 Notes:
19927
19928 @itemize @bullet
19929 @item
19930 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
19931
19932 @item
19933 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
19934 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
19935 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
19936 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
19937 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
19938 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
19939 prior command.
19940
19941 @item
19942 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19943 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
19944 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
19945 prefixed by @samp{+}.
19946
19947 @item
19948 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19949 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
19950 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
19951 @samp{*}.
19952
19953 @item
19954 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19955 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
19956 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
19957 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
19958
19959 @item
19960 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19961 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
19962 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
19963 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
19964
19965 @item
19966 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19967 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
19968 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
19969
19970 @item
19971 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19972 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
19973 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
19974 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
19975
19976 @item
19977 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19978 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
19979 @var{values}.
19980
19981
19982 @end itemize
19983
19984 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
19985 details about the various output records.
19986
19987 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19988 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
19989 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
19990
19991 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
19992 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
19993
19994 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
19995 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
19996 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
19997 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
19998 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
19999 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
20000
20001 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
20002 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
20003 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
20004
20005 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20006 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
20007 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
20008 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
20009
20010 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
20011 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
20012
20013 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
20014 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
20015 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
20016 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
20017 might change.
20018
20019 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
20020 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
20021 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
20022 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
20023
20024 @itemize @bullet
20025 @item
20026 New MI commands may be added.
20027
20028 @item
20029 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
20030
20031 @item
20032 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
20033 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
20034
20035 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
20036 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
20037
20038 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
20039 @c resolve inconsistencies.
20040 @end itemize
20041
20042 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
20043 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
20044 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
20045 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
20046 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
20047
20048 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
20049 @c version?
20050
20051 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
20052 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
20053 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
20054 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
20055 @cindex mailing lists
20056
20057 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20058 @node GDB/MI Output Records
20059 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
20060
20061 @menu
20062 * GDB/MI Result Records::
20063 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
20064 * GDB/MI Async Records::
20065 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
20066 @end menu
20067
20068 @node GDB/MI Result Records
20069 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
20070
20071 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20072 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
20073 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
20074 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
20075
20076 @table @code
20077 @findex ^done
20078 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
20079 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
20080 values.
20081
20082 @item "^running"
20083 @findex ^running
20084 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
20085 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
20086 running.
20087
20088 @item "^connected"
20089 @findex ^connected
20090 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
20091
20092 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
20093 @findex ^error
20094 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
20095 error message.
20096
20097 @item "^exit"
20098 @findex ^exit
20099 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
20100
20101 @end table
20102
20103 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
20104 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
20105
20106 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
20107 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20108 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
20109 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
20110 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
20111
20112 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
20113 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
20114 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
20115 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
20116 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
20117
20118 @table @code
20119 @item "~" @var{string-output}
20120 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
20121 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
20122
20123 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
20124 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
20125 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
20126 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
20127
20128 @item "&" @var{string-output}
20129 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
20130 internals.
20131 @end table
20132
20133 @node GDB/MI Async Records
20134 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
20135
20136 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20137 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
20138 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
20139 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
20140 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
20141 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
20142
20143 The following is the list of possible async records:
20144
20145 @table @code
20146
20147 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
20148 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
20149 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
20150 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
20151 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
20152 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
20153 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
20154 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
20155 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
20156 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
20157
20158 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}"
20159 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
20160 following values:
20161
20162 @table @code
20163 @item breakpoint-hit
20164 A breakpoint was reached.
20165 @item watchpoint-trigger
20166 A watchpoint was triggered.
20167 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
20168 A read watchpoint was triggered.
20169 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
20170 An access watchpoint was triggered.
20171 @item function-finished
20172 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
20173 @item location-reached
20174 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
20175 @item watchpoint-scope
20176 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
20177 @item end-stepping-range
20178 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
20179 similar CLI command was accomplished.
20180 @item exited-signalled
20181 The inferior exited because of a signal.
20182 @item exited
20183 The inferior exited.
20184 @item exited-normally
20185 The inferior exited normally.
20186 @item signal-received
20187 A signal was received by the inferior.
20188 @end table
20189
20190 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
20191 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
20192 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
20193 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
20194 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
20195 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
20196 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
20197 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
20198 several threads in the list.
20199
20200 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
20201 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
20202 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
20203 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
20204 thread group.
20205
20206 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
20207 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
20208 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
20209 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
20210 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
20211
20212 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
20213 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
20214 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
20215 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
20216 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
20217 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
20218 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
20219
20220 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
20221 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
20222 that thread.
20223
20224 @item =library-loaded,...
20225 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
20226 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
20227 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
20228 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
20229 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
20230 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
20231 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
20232 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
20233 library are loaded.
20234
20235 @item =library-unloaded,...
20236 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
20237 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
20238 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification
20239
20240 @end table
20241
20242 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
20243 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
20244
20245 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
20246 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
20247 fields:
20248
20249 @table @code
20250 @item level
20251 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
20252 zero. This field is always present.
20253
20254 @item func
20255 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
20256 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
20257
20258 @item addr
20259 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
20260
20261 @item file
20262 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
20263 address. This field may be absent.
20264
20265 @item line
20266 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
20267 may be absent.
20268
20269 @item from
20270 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
20271 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
20272
20273 @end table
20274
20275
20276 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20277 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
20278 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
20279 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
20280
20281 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
20282 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
20283 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
20284 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
20285
20286 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
20287 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
20288
20289 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
20290
20291 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
20292 information of the breakpoint.
20293
20294 @smallexample
20295 -> -break-insert main
20296 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
20297 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
20298 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
20299 <- (gdb)
20300 @end smallexample
20301
20302 @subheading Program Execution
20303
20304 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
20305 reason that execution stopped.
20306
20307 @smallexample
20308 -> -exec-run
20309 <- ^running
20310 <- (gdb)
20311 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
20312 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
20313 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
20314 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
20315 <- (gdb)
20316 -> -exec-continue
20317 <- ^running
20318 <- (gdb)
20319 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20320 <- (gdb)
20321 @end smallexample
20322
20323 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
20324
20325 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
20326
20327 @smallexample
20328 -> (gdb)
20329 <- -gdb-exit
20330 <- ^exit
20331 @end smallexample
20332
20333 @subheading A Bad Command
20334
20335 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
20336
20337 @smallexample
20338 -> -rubbish
20339 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
20340 <- (gdb)
20341 @end smallexample
20342
20343
20344 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20345 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
20346 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
20347
20348 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
20349 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
20350
20351 @subheading Motivation
20352
20353 The motivation for this collection of commands.
20354
20355 @subheading Introduction
20356
20357 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
20358
20359 @subheading Commands
20360
20361 For each command in the block, the following is described:
20362
20363 @subsubheading Synopsis
20364
20365 @smallexample
20366 -command @var{args}@dots{}
20367 @end smallexample
20368
20369 @subsubheading Result
20370
20371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20372
20373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
20374
20375 @subsubheading Example
20376
20377 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
20378 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
20379
20380
20381 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20382 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
20383 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
20384
20385 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
20386 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
20387 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
20388 breakpoints.
20389
20390 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
20391 @findex -break-after
20392
20393 @subsubheading Synopsis
20394
20395 @smallexample
20396 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
20397 @end smallexample
20398
20399 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
20400 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
20401 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
20402 @samp{-break-list} command below.
20403
20404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20405
20406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
20407
20408 @subsubheading Example
20409
20410 @smallexample
20411 (gdb)
20412 -break-insert main
20413 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
20414 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
20415 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
20416 (gdb)
20417 -break-after 1 3
20418 ~
20419 ^done
20420 (gdb)
20421 -break-list
20422 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20423 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20424 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20425 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20426 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20427 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20428 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20429 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20430 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20431 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
20432 (gdb)
20433 @end smallexample
20434
20435 @ignore
20436 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
20437 @findex -break-catch
20438
20439 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
20440 @findex -break-commands
20441 @end ignore
20442
20443
20444 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
20445 @findex -break-condition
20446
20447 @subsubheading Synopsis
20448
20449 @smallexample
20450 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
20451 @end smallexample
20452
20453 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
20454 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
20455 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
20456 command below).
20457
20458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20459
20460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
20461
20462 @subsubheading Example
20463
20464 @smallexample
20465 (gdb)
20466 -break-condition 1 1
20467 ^done
20468 (gdb)
20469 -break-list
20470 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20471 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20472 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20473 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20474 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20475 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20476 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20477 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20478 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20479 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
20480 (gdb)
20481 @end smallexample
20482
20483 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
20484 @findex -break-delete
20485
20486 @subsubheading Synopsis
20487
20488 @smallexample
20489 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20490 @end smallexample
20491
20492 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
20493 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
20494
20495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20496
20497 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
20498
20499 @subsubheading Example
20500
20501 @smallexample
20502 (gdb)
20503 -break-delete 1
20504 ^done
20505 (gdb)
20506 -break-list
20507 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20508 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20509 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20510 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20511 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20512 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20513 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20514 body=[]@}
20515 (gdb)
20516 @end smallexample
20517
20518 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
20519 @findex -break-disable
20520
20521 @subsubheading Synopsis
20522
20523 @smallexample
20524 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20525 @end smallexample
20526
20527 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
20528 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
20529
20530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20531
20532 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
20533
20534 @subsubheading Example
20535
20536 @smallexample
20537 (gdb)
20538 -break-disable 2
20539 ^done
20540 (gdb)
20541 -break-list
20542 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20543 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20544 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20545 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20546 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20547 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20548 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20549 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
20550 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20551 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
20552 (gdb)
20553 @end smallexample
20554
20555 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
20556 @findex -break-enable
20557
20558 @subsubheading Synopsis
20559
20560 @smallexample
20561 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20562 @end smallexample
20563
20564 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
20565
20566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20567
20568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
20569
20570 @subsubheading Example
20571
20572 @smallexample
20573 (gdb)
20574 -break-enable 2
20575 ^done
20576 (gdb)
20577 -break-list
20578 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20579 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20580 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20581 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20582 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20583 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20584 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20585 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20586 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20587 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
20588 (gdb)
20589 @end smallexample
20590
20591 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
20592 @findex -break-info
20593
20594 @subsubheading Synopsis
20595
20596 @smallexample
20597 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
20598 @end smallexample
20599
20600 @c REDUNDANT???
20601 Get information about a single breakpoint.
20602
20603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20604
20605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
20606
20607 @subsubheading Example
20608 N.A.
20609
20610 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
20611 @findex -break-insert
20612
20613 @subsubheading Synopsis
20614
20615 @smallexample
20616 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
20617 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
20618 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
20619 @end smallexample
20620
20621 @noindent
20622 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
20623
20624 @itemize @bullet
20625 @item function
20626 @c @item +offset
20627 @c @item -offset
20628 @c @item linenum
20629 @item filename:linenum
20630 @item filename:function
20631 @item *address
20632 @end itemize
20633
20634 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
20635
20636 @table @samp
20637 @item -t
20638 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
20639 @item -h
20640 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
20641 @item -c @var{condition}
20642 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
20643 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
20644 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
20645 @item -f
20646 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
20647 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
20648 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
20649 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
20650 cannot be parsed.
20651 @item -d
20652 Create a disabled breakpoint.
20653 @end table
20654
20655 @subsubheading Result
20656
20657 The result is in the form:
20658
20659 @smallexample
20660 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
20661 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
20662 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
20663 times="@var{times}"@}
20664 @end smallexample
20665
20666 @noindent
20667 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
20668 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
20669 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
20670 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
20671 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
20672 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
20673 which use the same output).
20674
20675 Note: this format is open to change.
20676 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
20677
20678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20679
20680 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
20681 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
20682
20683 @subsubheading Example
20684
20685 @smallexample
20686 (gdb)
20687 -break-insert main
20688 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
20689 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
20690 (gdb)
20691 -break-insert -t foo
20692 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
20693 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
20694 (gdb)
20695 -break-list
20696 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20697 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20698 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20699 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20700 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20701 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20702 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20703 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20704 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
20705 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
20706 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
20707 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
20708 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
20709 (gdb)
20710 -break-insert -r foo.*
20711 ~int foo(int, int);
20712 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
20713 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
20714 (gdb)
20715 @end smallexample
20716
20717 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
20718 @findex -break-list
20719
20720 @subsubheading Synopsis
20721
20722 @smallexample
20723 -break-list
20724 @end smallexample
20725
20726 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
20727
20728 @table @samp
20729 @item Number
20730 number of the breakpoint
20731 @item Type
20732 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
20733 @item Disposition
20734 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
20735 or @samp{nokeep}
20736 @item Enabled
20737 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
20738 @item Address
20739 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
20740 @item What
20741 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
20742 name, line number
20743 @item Times
20744 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
20745 @end table
20746
20747 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
20748 @code{body} field is an empty list.
20749
20750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20751
20752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
20753
20754 @subsubheading Example
20755
20756 @smallexample
20757 (gdb)
20758 -break-list
20759 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20760 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20761 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20762 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20763 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20764 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20765 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20766 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20767 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
20768 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20769 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20770 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
20771 (gdb)
20772 @end smallexample
20773
20774 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
20775
20776 @smallexample
20777 (gdb)
20778 -break-list
20779 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20780 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20781 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20782 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20783 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20784 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20785 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20786 body=[]@}
20787 (gdb)
20788 @end smallexample
20789
20790 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
20791 @findex -break-watch
20792
20793 @subsubheading Synopsis
20794
20795 @smallexample
20796 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
20797 @end smallexample
20798
20799 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
20800 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
20801 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
20802 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
20803 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
20804 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
20805 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
20806 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
20807
20808 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
20809 breakpoints inserted.
20810
20811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20812
20813 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
20814 @samp{rwatch}.
20815
20816 @subsubheading Example
20817
20818 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
20819
20820 @smallexample
20821 (gdb)
20822 -break-watch x
20823 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
20824 (gdb)
20825 -exec-continue
20826 ^running
20827 (gdb)
20828 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
20829 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
20830 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20831 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
20832 (gdb)
20833 @end smallexample
20834
20835 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
20836 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
20837 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
20838
20839 @smallexample
20840 (gdb)
20841 -break-watch C
20842 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
20843 (gdb)
20844 -exec-continue
20845 ^running
20846 (gdb)
20847 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
20848 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
20849 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20850 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20851 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
20852 (gdb)
20853 -exec-continue
20854 ^running
20855 (gdb)
20856 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
20857 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
20858 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20859 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20860 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20861 (gdb)
20862 @end smallexample
20863
20864 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
20865 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
20866 deleted.
20867
20868 @smallexample
20869 (gdb)
20870 -break-watch C
20871 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
20872 (gdb)
20873 -break-list
20874 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20875 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20876 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20877 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20878 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20879 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20880 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20881 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20882 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20883 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20884 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
20885 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
20886 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
20887 (gdb)
20888 -exec-continue
20889 ^running
20890 (gdb)
20891 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
20892 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
20893 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20894 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20895 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
20896 (gdb)
20897 -break-list
20898 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20899 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20900 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20901 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20902 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20903 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20904 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20905 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20906 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20907 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20908 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
20909 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
20910 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
20911 (gdb)
20912 -exec-continue
20913 ^running
20914 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
20915 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
20916 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20917 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20918 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20919 (gdb)
20920 -break-list
20921 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20922 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20923 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20924 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20925 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20926 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20927 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20928 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20929 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20930 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20931 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
20932 times="1"@}]@}
20933 (gdb)
20934 @end smallexample
20935
20936 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20937 @node GDB/MI Program Context
20938 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
20939
20940 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
20941 @findex -exec-arguments
20942
20943
20944 @subsubheading Synopsis
20945
20946 @smallexample
20947 -exec-arguments @var{args}
20948 @end smallexample
20949
20950 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
20951 @samp{-exec-run}.
20952
20953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20954
20955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
20956
20957 @subsubheading Example
20958
20959 @smallexample
20960 (gdb)
20961 -exec-arguments -v word
20962 ^done
20963 (gdb)
20964 @end smallexample
20965
20966
20967 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
20968 @findex -exec-show-arguments
20969
20970 @subsubheading Synopsis
20971
20972 @smallexample
20973 -exec-show-arguments
20974 @end smallexample
20975
20976 Print the arguments of the program.
20977
20978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20979
20980 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
20981
20982 @subsubheading Example
20983 N.A.
20984
20985
20986 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
20987 @findex -environment-cd
20988
20989 @subsubheading Synopsis
20990
20991 @smallexample
20992 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
20993 @end smallexample
20994
20995 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
20996
20997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20998
20999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
21000
21001 @subsubheading Example
21002
21003 @smallexample
21004 (gdb)
21005 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
21006 ^done
21007 (gdb)
21008 @end smallexample
21009
21010
21011 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
21012 @findex -environment-directory
21013
21014 @subsubheading Synopsis
21015
21016 @smallexample
21017 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
21018 @end smallexample
21019
21020 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
21021 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
21022 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
21023 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
21024 occurs as normal.
21025 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
21026 multiple directories in a single command
21027 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
21028 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
21029 If blanks are needed as
21030 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
21031 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
21032 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
21033 character must not be used
21034 in any directory name.
21035 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
21036
21037 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21038
21039 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
21040
21041 @subsubheading Example
21042
21043 @smallexample
21044 (gdb)
21045 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
21046 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
21047 (gdb)
21048 -environment-directory ""
21049 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
21050 (gdb)
21051 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
21052 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
21053 (gdb)
21054 -environment-directory -r
21055 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
21056 (gdb)
21057 @end smallexample
21058
21059
21060 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
21061 @findex -environment-path
21062
21063 @subsubheading Synopsis
21064
21065 @smallexample
21066 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
21067 @end smallexample
21068
21069 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
21070 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
21071 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
21072 supplied in addition to the
21073 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
21074 occurs as normal.
21075 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
21076 multiple directories in a single command
21077 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
21078 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
21079 If blanks are needed as
21080 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
21081 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
21082 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
21083 character must not be used
21084 in any directory name.
21085 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
21086
21087
21088 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21089
21090 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
21091
21092 @subsubheading Example
21093
21094 @smallexample
21095 (gdb)
21096 -environment-path
21097 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
21098 (gdb)
21099 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
21100 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
21101 (gdb)
21102 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
21103 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
21104 (gdb)
21105 @end smallexample
21106
21107
21108 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
21109 @findex -environment-pwd
21110
21111 @subsubheading Synopsis
21112
21113 @smallexample
21114 -environment-pwd
21115 @end smallexample
21116
21117 Show the current working directory.
21118
21119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21120
21121 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
21122
21123 @subsubheading Example
21124
21125 @smallexample
21126 (gdb)
21127 -environment-pwd
21128 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
21129 (gdb)
21130 @end smallexample
21131
21132 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21133 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
21134 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
21135
21136
21137 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
21138 @findex -thread-info
21139
21140 @subsubheading Synopsis
21141
21142 @smallexample
21143 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
21144 @end smallexample
21145
21146 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
21147 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
21148 threads. When printing information about all threads,
21149 also reports the current thread.
21150
21151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21152
21153 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
21154 about all threads.
21155
21156 @subsubheading Example
21157
21158 @smallexample
21159 -thread-info
21160 ^done,threads=[
21161 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
21162 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
21163 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
21164 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
21165 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
21166 current-thread-id="1"
21167 (gdb)
21168 @end smallexample
21169
21170 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
21171
21172 @table @code
21173 @item stopped
21174 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
21175 threads.
21176
21177 @item running
21178 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
21179 threads.
21180
21181 @end table
21182
21183 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
21184 @findex -thread-list-ids
21185
21186 @subsubheading Synopsis
21187
21188 @smallexample
21189 -thread-list-ids
21190 @end smallexample
21191
21192 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
21193 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
21194
21195 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
21196 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
21197
21198 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21199
21200 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
21201
21202 @subsubheading Example
21203
21204 @smallexample
21205 (gdb)
21206 -thread-list-ids
21207 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
21208 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
21209 (gdb)
21210 @end smallexample
21211
21212
21213 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
21214 @findex -thread-select
21215
21216 @subsubheading Synopsis
21217
21218 @smallexample
21219 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
21220 @end smallexample
21221
21222 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
21223 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
21224
21225 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
21226 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
21227
21228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21229
21230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
21231
21232 @subsubheading Example
21233
21234 @smallexample
21235 (gdb)
21236 -exec-next
21237 ^running
21238 (gdb)
21239 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
21240 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
21241 (gdb)
21242 -thread-list-ids
21243 ^done,
21244 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
21245 number-of-threads="3"
21246 (gdb)
21247 -thread-select 3
21248 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
21249 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
21250 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
21251 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
21252 (gdb)
21253 @end smallexample
21254
21255 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21256 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
21257 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
21258
21259 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
21260 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
21261 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
21262 other cases.
21263
21264 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
21265 @findex -exec-continue
21266
21267 @subsubheading Synopsis
21268
21269 @smallexample
21270 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
21271 @end smallexample
21272
21273 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
21274 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
21275 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
21276 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
21277 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
21278 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
21279 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
21280 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
21281 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
21282 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
21283 thread group are resumed.
21284
21285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21286
21287 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
21288
21289 @subsubheading Example
21290
21291 @smallexample
21292 -exec-continue
21293 ^running
21294 (gdb)
21295 @@Hello world
21296 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
21297 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
21298 line="13"@}
21299 (gdb)
21300 @end smallexample
21301
21302
21303 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
21304 @findex -exec-finish
21305
21306 @subsubheading Synopsis
21307
21308 @smallexample
21309 -exec-finish
21310 @end smallexample
21311
21312 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
21313 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
21314
21315 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21316
21317 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
21318
21319 @subsubheading Example
21320
21321 Function returning @code{void}.
21322
21323 @smallexample
21324 -exec-finish
21325 ^running
21326 (gdb)
21327 @@hello from foo
21328 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
21329 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
21330 (gdb)
21331 @end smallexample
21332
21333 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
21334 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
21335 value itself.
21336
21337 @smallexample
21338 -exec-finish
21339 ^running
21340 (gdb)
21341 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
21342 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
21343 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21344 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
21345 (gdb)
21346 @end smallexample
21347
21348
21349 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
21350 @findex -exec-interrupt
21351
21352 @subsubheading Synopsis
21353
21354 @smallexample
21355 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
21356 @end smallexample
21357
21358 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
21359 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
21360 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
21361 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
21362 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
21363
21364 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
21365 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
21366 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
21367 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
21368
21369 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
21370 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
21371 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
21372 threads in that group will be interrupted.
21373
21374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21375
21376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
21377
21378 @subsubheading Example
21379
21380 @smallexample
21381 (gdb)
21382 111-exec-continue
21383 111^running
21384
21385 (gdb)
21386 222-exec-interrupt
21387 222^done
21388 (gdb)
21389 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
21390 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21391 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
21392 (gdb)
21393
21394 (gdb)
21395 -exec-interrupt
21396 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
21397 (gdb)
21398 @end smallexample
21399
21400
21401 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
21402 @findex -exec-next
21403
21404 @subsubheading Synopsis
21405
21406 @smallexample
21407 -exec-next
21408 @end smallexample
21409
21410 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
21411 of the next source line is reached.
21412
21413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21414
21415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
21416
21417 @subsubheading Example
21418
21419 @smallexample
21420 -exec-next
21421 ^running
21422 (gdb)
21423 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
21424 (gdb)
21425 @end smallexample
21426
21427
21428 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
21429 @findex -exec-next-instruction
21430
21431 @subsubheading Synopsis
21432
21433 @smallexample
21434 -exec-next-instruction
21435 @end smallexample
21436
21437 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
21438 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
21439 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
21440 printed as well.
21441
21442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21443
21444 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
21445
21446 @subsubheading Example
21447
21448 @smallexample
21449 (gdb)
21450 -exec-next-instruction
21451 ^running
21452
21453 (gdb)
21454 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21455 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
21456 (gdb)
21457 @end smallexample
21458
21459
21460 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
21461 @findex -exec-return
21462
21463 @subsubheading Synopsis
21464
21465 @smallexample
21466 -exec-return
21467 @end smallexample
21468
21469 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
21470 Displays the new current frame.
21471
21472 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21473
21474 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
21475
21476 @subsubheading Example
21477
21478 @smallexample
21479 (gdb)
21480 200-break-insert callee4
21481 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
21482 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
21483 (gdb)
21484 000-exec-run
21485 000^running
21486 (gdb)
21487 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
21488 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21489 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21490 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
21491 (gdb)
21492 205-break-delete
21493 205^done
21494 (gdb)
21495 111-exec-return
21496 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
21497 args=[@{name="strarg",
21498 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21499 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21500 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21501 (gdb)
21502 @end smallexample
21503
21504
21505 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
21506 @findex -exec-run
21507
21508 @subsubheading Synopsis
21509
21510 @smallexample
21511 -exec-run
21512 @end smallexample
21513
21514 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
21515 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
21516 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
21517 the program has exited exceptionally.
21518
21519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21520
21521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
21522
21523 @subsubheading Examples
21524
21525 @smallexample
21526 (gdb)
21527 -break-insert main
21528 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
21529 (gdb)
21530 -exec-run
21531 ^running
21532 (gdb)
21533 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
21534 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
21535 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
21536 (gdb)
21537 @end smallexample
21538
21539 @noindent
21540 Program exited normally:
21541
21542 @smallexample
21543 (gdb)
21544 -exec-run
21545 ^running
21546 (gdb)
21547 x = 55
21548 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
21549 (gdb)
21550 @end smallexample
21551
21552 @noindent
21553 Program exited exceptionally:
21554
21555 @smallexample
21556 (gdb)
21557 -exec-run
21558 ^running
21559 (gdb)
21560 x = 55
21561 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
21562 (gdb)
21563 @end smallexample
21564
21565 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
21566 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
21567
21568 @smallexample
21569 (gdb)
21570 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
21571 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
21572 @end smallexample
21573
21574
21575 @c @subheading -exec-signal
21576
21577
21578 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
21579 @findex -exec-step
21580
21581 @subsubheading Synopsis
21582
21583 @smallexample
21584 -exec-step
21585 @end smallexample
21586
21587 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
21588 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
21589 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
21590 function.
21591
21592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21593
21594 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
21595
21596 @subsubheading Example
21597
21598 Stepping into a function:
21599
21600 @smallexample
21601 -exec-step
21602 ^running
21603 (gdb)
21604 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21605 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
21606 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
21607 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
21608 (gdb)
21609 @end smallexample
21610
21611 Regular stepping:
21612
21613 @smallexample
21614 -exec-step
21615 ^running
21616 (gdb)
21617 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
21618 (gdb)
21619 @end smallexample
21620
21621
21622 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
21623 @findex -exec-step-instruction
21624
21625 @subsubheading Synopsis
21626
21627 @smallexample
21628 -exec-step-instruction
21629 @end smallexample
21630
21631 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
21632 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
21633 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
21634 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
21635 well.
21636
21637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21638
21639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
21640
21641 @subsubheading Example
21642
21643 @smallexample
21644 (gdb)
21645 -exec-step-instruction
21646 ^running
21647
21648 (gdb)
21649 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21650 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21651 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
21652 (gdb)
21653 -exec-step-instruction
21654 ^running
21655
21656 (gdb)
21657 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21658 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21659 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
21660 (gdb)
21661 @end smallexample
21662
21663
21664 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
21665 @findex -exec-until
21666
21667 @subsubheading Synopsis
21668
21669 @smallexample
21670 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
21671 @end smallexample
21672
21673 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
21674 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
21675 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
21676 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
21677
21678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21679
21680 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
21681
21682 @subsubheading Example
21683
21684 @smallexample
21685 (gdb)
21686 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
21687 ^running
21688 (gdb)
21689 x = 55
21690 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
21691 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
21692 (gdb)
21693 @end smallexample
21694
21695 @ignore
21696 @subheading -file-clear
21697 Is this going away????
21698 @end ignore
21699
21700 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21701 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
21702 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
21703
21704
21705 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
21706 @findex -stack-info-frame
21707
21708 @subsubheading Synopsis
21709
21710 @smallexample
21711 -stack-info-frame
21712 @end smallexample
21713
21714 Get info on the selected frame.
21715
21716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21717
21718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
21719 (without arguments).
21720
21721 @subsubheading Example
21722
21723 @smallexample
21724 (gdb)
21725 -stack-info-frame
21726 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21727 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21728 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
21729 (gdb)
21730 @end smallexample
21731
21732 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
21733 @findex -stack-info-depth
21734
21735 @subsubheading Synopsis
21736
21737 @smallexample
21738 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
21739 @end smallexample
21740
21741 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
21742 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
21743
21744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21745
21746 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21747
21748 @subsubheading Example
21749
21750 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
21751
21752 @smallexample
21753 (gdb)
21754 -stack-info-depth
21755 ^done,depth="12"
21756 (gdb)
21757 -stack-info-depth 4
21758 ^done,depth="4"
21759 (gdb)
21760 -stack-info-depth 12
21761 ^done,depth="12"
21762 (gdb)
21763 -stack-info-depth 11
21764 ^done,depth="11"
21765 (gdb)
21766 -stack-info-depth 13
21767 ^done,depth="12"
21768 (gdb)
21769 @end smallexample
21770
21771 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
21772 @findex -stack-list-arguments
21773
21774 @subsubheading Synopsis
21775
21776 @smallexample
21777 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
21778 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21779 @end smallexample
21780
21781 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
21782 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
21783 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
21784 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
21785 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
21786 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
21787 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
21788 which case only existing frames will be returned.
21789
21790 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
21791 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
21792 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
21793
21794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21795
21796 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
21797 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
21798 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
21799
21800 @subsubheading Example
21801
21802 @smallexample
21803 (gdb)
21804 -stack-list-frames
21805 ^done,
21806 stack=[
21807 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21808 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21809 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
21810 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21811 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21812 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
21813 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
21814 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21815 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
21816 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
21817 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21818 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
21819 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
21820 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21821 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
21822 (gdb)
21823 -stack-list-arguments 0
21824 ^done,
21825 stack-args=[
21826 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
21827 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
21828 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
21829 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
21830 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
21831 (gdb)
21832 -stack-list-arguments 1
21833 ^done,
21834 stack-args=[
21835 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
21836 frame=@{level="1",
21837 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
21838 frame=@{level="2",args=[
21839 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21840 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
21841 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
21842 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21843 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
21844 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
21845 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
21846 (gdb)
21847 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
21848 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
21849 (gdb)
21850 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
21851 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
21852 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21853 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
21854 (gdb)
21855 @end smallexample
21856
21857 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
21858
21859
21860 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
21861 @findex -stack-list-frames
21862
21863 @subsubheading Synopsis
21864
21865 @smallexample
21866 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21867 @end smallexample
21868
21869 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
21870 following info:
21871
21872 @table @samp
21873 @item @var{level}
21874 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
21875 @item @var{addr}
21876 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
21877 @item @var{func}
21878 Function name.
21879 @item @var{file}
21880 File name of the source file where the function lives.
21881 @item @var{line}
21882 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
21883 @end table
21884
21885 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
21886 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
21887 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
21888 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
21889 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
21890 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
21891 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
21892
21893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21894
21895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
21896
21897 @subsubheading Example
21898
21899 Full stack backtrace:
21900
21901 @smallexample
21902 (gdb)
21903 -stack-list-frames
21904 ^done,stack=
21905 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
21906 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
21907 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21908 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21909 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21910 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21911 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21912 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21913 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21914 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21915 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21916 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21917 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21918 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21919 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21920 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21921 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21922 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21923 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21924 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21925 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21926 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21927 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
21928 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
21929 (gdb)
21930 @end smallexample
21931
21932 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
21933
21934 @smallexample
21935 (gdb)
21936 -stack-list-frames 3 5
21937 ^done,stack=
21938 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21939 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21940 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21941 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21942 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21943 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
21944 (gdb)
21945 @end smallexample
21946
21947 Show a single frame:
21948
21949 @smallexample
21950 (gdb)
21951 -stack-list-frames 3 3
21952 ^done,stack=
21953 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21954 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
21955 (gdb)
21956 @end smallexample
21957
21958
21959 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
21960 @findex -stack-list-locals
21961
21962 @subsubheading Synopsis
21963
21964 @smallexample
21965 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
21966 @end smallexample
21967
21968 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
21969 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
21970 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
21971 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
21972 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
21973 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
21974 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
21975 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
21976 more detail.
21977
21978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21979
21980 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
21981
21982 @subsubheading Example
21983
21984 @smallexample
21985 (gdb)
21986 -stack-list-locals 0
21987 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
21988 (gdb)
21989 -stack-list-locals --all-values
21990 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
21991 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
21992 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
21993 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
21994 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
21995 (gdb)
21996 @end smallexample
21997
21998
21999 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
22000 @findex -stack-select-frame
22001
22002 @subsubheading Synopsis
22003
22004 @smallexample
22005 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
22006 @end smallexample
22007
22008 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
22009 the stack.
22010
22011 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
22012 option to every command.
22013
22014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22015
22016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
22017 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
22018
22019 @subsubheading Example
22020
22021 @smallexample
22022 (gdb)
22023 -stack-select-frame 2
22024 ^done
22025 (gdb)
22026 @end smallexample
22027
22028 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22029 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
22030 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
22031
22032 @ignore
22033
22034 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
22035
22036 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
22037 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
22038 used by @code{Insight}.
22039
22040 The two main reasons for that are:
22041
22042 @enumerate 1
22043 @item
22044 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
22045
22046 @item
22047 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
22048 now).
22049 @end enumerate
22050
22051 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
22052 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
22053 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
22054 hints about their use.
22055
22056 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
22057 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
22058 least, the following operations:
22059
22060 @itemize @bullet
22061 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
22062 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
22063 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
22064 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
22065 @end itemize
22066
22067 @end ignore
22068
22069 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
22070
22071 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
22072
22073 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
22074 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
22075 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
22076 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
22077 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
22078 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
22079 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
22080 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
22081 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
22082 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
22083 object, or to change display format.
22084
22085 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
22086 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
22087 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
22088 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
22089 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
22090 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
22091 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
22092 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
22093 child will be created.
22094
22095 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
22096 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
22097 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
22098 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
22099 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
22100
22101 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
22102 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
22103 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
22104 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
22105 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
22106 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
22107 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
22108 variables that frontend has created.
22109
22110 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
22111 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
22112 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
22113 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
22114 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
22115 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
22116 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
22117 implicitly updated.
22118
22119 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
22120 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
22121 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
22122 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
22123 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
22124 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
22125 frame. Consider this example:
22126
22127 @smallexample
22128 void do_work(...)
22129 @{
22130 struct work_state state;
22131
22132 if (...)
22133 do_work(...);
22134 @}
22135 @end smallexample
22136
22137 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
22138 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
22139 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
22140 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
22141 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
22142
22143 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
22144 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
22145 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
22146 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
22147 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
22148 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
22149
22150 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
22151 access this functionality:
22152
22153 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
22154 @item @strong{Operation}
22155 @tab @strong{Description}
22156
22157 @item @code{-var-create}
22158 @tab create a variable object
22159 @item @code{-var-delete}
22160 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
22161 @item @code{-var-set-format}
22162 @tab set the display format of this variable
22163 @item @code{-var-show-format}
22164 @tab show the display format of this variable
22165 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
22166 @tab tells how many children this object has
22167 @item @code{-var-list-children}
22168 @tab return a list of the object's children
22169 @item @code{-var-info-type}
22170 @tab show the type of this variable object
22171 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
22172 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
22173 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
22174 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
22175 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
22176 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
22177 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
22178 @tab get the value of this variable
22179 @item @code{-var-assign}
22180 @tab set the value of this variable
22181 @item @code{-var-update}
22182 @tab update the variable and its children
22183 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
22184 @tab set frozeness attribute
22185 @end multitable
22186
22187 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
22188 how it can be used.
22189
22190 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
22191
22192 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
22193 @findex -var-create
22194
22195 @subsubheading Synopsis
22196
22197 @smallexample
22198 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
22199 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
22200 @end smallexample
22201
22202 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
22203 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
22204 register.
22205
22206 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
22207 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
22208 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
22209 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
22210 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
22211
22212 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
22213 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
22214 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
22215 object must be created.
22216
22217 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
22218 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
22219
22220 @itemize @bullet
22221 @item
22222 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
22223
22224 @item
22225 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
22226
22227 @item
22228 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
22229 @end itemize
22230
22231 @subsubheading Result
22232
22233 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
22234 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
22235 the @value{GDBN} CLI. If a fixed variable object is bound to a
22236 specific thread, the thread is is also printed:
22237
22238 @smallexample
22239 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}"
22240 @end smallexample
22241
22242
22243 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
22244 @findex -var-delete
22245
22246 @subsubheading Synopsis
22247
22248 @smallexample
22249 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
22250 @end smallexample
22251
22252 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
22253 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
22254
22255 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
22256
22257
22258 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
22259 @findex -var-set-format
22260
22261 @subsubheading Synopsis
22262
22263 @smallexample
22264 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
22265 @end smallexample
22266
22267 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
22268 @var{format-spec}.
22269
22270 @anchor{-var-set-format}
22271 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
22272
22273 @smallexample
22274 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
22275 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
22276 @end smallexample
22277
22278 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
22279 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
22280 for pointers, etc.).
22281
22282 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
22283 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
22284
22285 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
22286 @findex -var-show-format
22287
22288 @subsubheading Synopsis
22289
22290 @smallexample
22291 -var-show-format @var{name}
22292 @end smallexample
22293
22294 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
22295
22296 @smallexample
22297 @var{format} @expansion{}
22298 @var{format-spec}
22299 @end smallexample
22300
22301
22302 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
22303 @findex -var-info-num-children
22304
22305 @subsubheading Synopsis
22306
22307 @smallexample
22308 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
22309 @end smallexample
22310
22311 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
22312
22313 @smallexample
22314 numchild=@var{n}
22315 @end smallexample
22316
22317
22318 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
22319 @findex -var-list-children
22320
22321 @subsubheading Synopsis
22322
22323 @smallexample
22324 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
22325 @end smallexample
22326 @anchor{-var-list-children}
22327
22328 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
22329 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
22330 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
22331 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
22332 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
22333 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
22334 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
22335 and unions.
22336
22337 @subsubheading Example
22338
22339 @smallexample
22340 (gdb)
22341 -var-list-children n
22342 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
22343 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
22344 (gdb)
22345 -var-list-children --all-values n
22346 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
22347 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
22348 @end smallexample
22349
22350
22351 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
22352 @findex -var-info-type
22353
22354 @subsubheading Synopsis
22355
22356 @smallexample
22357 -var-info-type @var{name}
22358 @end smallexample
22359
22360 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
22361 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
22362 @value{GDBN} CLI:
22363
22364 @smallexample
22365 type=@var{typename}
22366 @end smallexample
22367
22368
22369 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
22370 @findex -var-info-expression
22371
22372 @subsubheading Synopsis
22373
22374 @smallexample
22375 -var-info-expression @var{name}
22376 @end smallexample
22377
22378 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
22379 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
22380 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
22381
22382 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
22383 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
22384
22385 @smallexample
22386 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
22387 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
22388 @end smallexample
22389
22390 @noindent
22391 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
22392
22393 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
22394 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
22395 is of limited use.
22396
22397 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
22398 @findex -var-info-path-expression
22399
22400 @subsubheading Synopsis
22401
22402 @smallexample
22403 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
22404 @end smallexample
22405
22406 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
22407 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
22408 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
22409 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
22410 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
22411 watchpoint from a variable object.
22412
22413 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
22414 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
22415 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
22416 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
22417 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
22418 @smallexample
22419 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
22420 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
22421 @end smallexample
22422
22423 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
22424 @findex -var-show-attributes
22425
22426 @subsubheading Synopsis
22427
22428 @smallexample
22429 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
22430 @end smallexample
22431
22432 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
22433
22434 @smallexample
22435 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
22436 @end smallexample
22437
22438 @noindent
22439 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
22440
22441 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
22442 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
22443
22444 @subsubheading Synopsis
22445
22446 @smallexample
22447 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
22448 @end smallexample
22449
22450 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
22451 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
22452 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
22453 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
22454 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
22455 the current display format will be used. The current display format
22456 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
22457
22458 @smallexample
22459 value=@var{value}
22460 @end smallexample
22461
22462 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
22463 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
22464
22465 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
22466 @findex -var-assign
22467
22468 @subsubheading Synopsis
22469
22470 @smallexample
22471 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
22472 @end smallexample
22473
22474 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
22475 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
22476 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
22477 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
22478
22479 @subsubheading Example
22480
22481 @smallexample
22482 (gdb)
22483 -var-assign var1 3
22484 ^done,value="3"
22485 (gdb)
22486 -var-update *
22487 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
22488 (gdb)
22489 @end smallexample
22490
22491 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
22492 @findex -var-update
22493
22494 @subsubheading Synopsis
22495
22496 @smallexample
22497 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
22498 @end smallexample
22499
22500 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
22501 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
22502 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
22503 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
22504 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
22505 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
22506 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
22507 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
22508 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
22509 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
22510 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
22511 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
22512 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
22513
22514 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
22515 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
22516 diagnostic.
22517
22518 @subsubheading Example
22519
22520 @smallexample
22521 (gdb)
22522 -var-assign var1 3
22523 ^done,value="3"
22524 (gdb)
22525 -var-update --all-values var1
22526 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
22527 type_changed="false"@}]
22528 (gdb)
22529 @end smallexample
22530
22531 @anchor{-var-update}
22532 The field in_scope may take three values:
22533
22534 @table @code
22535 @item "true"
22536 The variable object's current value is valid.
22537
22538 @item "false"
22539 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
22540 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
22541 scope.
22542
22543 @item "invalid"
22544 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
22545 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
22546 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
22547 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
22548 objects.
22549 @end table
22550
22551 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
22552 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
22553
22554 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
22555 @findex -var-set-frozen
22556 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
22557
22558 @subsubheading Synopsis
22559
22560 @smallexample
22561 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
22562 @end smallexample
22563
22564 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
22565 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
22566 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
22567 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
22568 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
22569 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
22570 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
22571 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
22572 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
22573 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
22574 @code{-var-update} does.
22575
22576 @subsubheading Example
22577
22578 @smallexample
22579 (gdb)
22580 -var-set-frozen V 1
22581 ^done
22582 (gdb)
22583 @end smallexample
22584
22585
22586 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22587 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
22588 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
22589
22590 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
22591 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
22592 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
22593 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
22594
22595 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
22596 @c @subheading -data-assign
22597 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
22598 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
22599 @c set variable
22600 @c @subsubheading Example
22601 @c N.A.
22602
22603 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
22604 @findex -data-disassemble
22605
22606 @subsubheading Synopsis
22607
22608 @smallexample
22609 -data-disassemble
22610 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
22611 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
22612 -- @var{mode}
22613 @end smallexample
22614
22615 @noindent
22616 Where:
22617
22618 @table @samp
22619 @item @var{start-addr}
22620 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
22621 @item @var{end-addr}
22622 is the end address
22623 @item @var{filename}
22624 is the name of the file to disassemble
22625 @item @var{linenum}
22626 is the line number to disassemble around
22627 @item @var{lines}
22628 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
22629 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
22630 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
22631 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
22632 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
22633 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
22634 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
22635 are displayed.
22636 @item @var{mode}
22637 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
22638 disassembly).
22639 @end table
22640
22641 @subsubheading Result
22642
22643 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
22644
22645 @itemize @bullet
22646 @item Address
22647 @item Func-name
22648 @item Offset
22649 @item Instruction
22650 @end itemize
22651
22652 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
22653 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
22654
22655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22656
22657 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
22658
22659 @subsubheading Example
22660
22661 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
22662
22663 @smallexample
22664 (gdb)
22665 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
22666 ^done,
22667 asm_insns=[
22668 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22669 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22670 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22671 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22672 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
22673 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
22674 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
22675 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22676 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
22677 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
22678 (gdb)
22679 @end smallexample
22680
22681 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
22682 @code{main}.
22683
22684 @smallexample
22685 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
22686 ^done,asm_insns=[
22687 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22688 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22689 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22690 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22691 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22692 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22693 [@dots{}]
22694 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
22695 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
22696 (gdb)
22697 @end smallexample
22698
22699 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
22700
22701 @smallexample
22702 (gdb)
22703 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
22704 ^done,asm_insns=[
22705 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22706 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22707 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22708 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22709 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22710 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
22711 (gdb)
22712 @end smallexample
22713
22714 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
22715
22716 @smallexample
22717 (gdb)
22718 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
22719 ^done,asm_insns=[
22720 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
22721 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22722 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22723 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22724 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
22725 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
22726 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22727 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22728 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22729 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22730 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22731 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
22732 (gdb)
22733 @end smallexample
22734
22735
22736 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
22737 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
22738
22739 @subsubheading Synopsis
22740
22741 @smallexample
22742 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
22743 @end smallexample
22744
22745 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
22746 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
22747 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
22748
22749 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22750
22751 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
22752 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
22753 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
22754
22755 @subsubheading Example
22756
22757 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
22758 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
22759 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
22760 output.
22761
22762 @smallexample
22763 211-data-evaluate-expression A
22764 211^done,value="1"
22765 (gdb)
22766 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
22767 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
22768 (gdb)
22769 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
22770 411^done,value="4"
22771 (gdb)
22772 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
22773 511^done,value="4"
22774 (gdb)
22775 @end smallexample
22776
22777
22778 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
22779 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
22780
22781 @subsubheading Synopsis
22782
22783 @smallexample
22784 -data-list-changed-registers
22785 @end smallexample
22786
22787 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
22788
22789 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22790
22791 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
22792 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
22793
22794 @subsubheading Example
22795
22796 On a PPC MBX board:
22797
22798 @smallexample
22799 (gdb)
22800 -exec-continue
22801 ^running
22802
22803 (gdb)
22804 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
22805 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
22806 line="5"@}
22807 (gdb)
22808 -data-list-changed-registers
22809 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
22810 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
22811 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
22812 (gdb)
22813 @end smallexample
22814
22815
22816 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
22817 @findex -data-list-register-names
22818
22819 @subsubheading Synopsis
22820
22821 @smallexample
22822 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
22823 @end smallexample
22824
22825 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
22826 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
22827 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
22828 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
22829 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
22830 include empty register names.
22831
22832 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22833
22834 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
22835 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
22836 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
22837
22838 @subsubheading Example
22839
22840 For the PPC MBX board:
22841 @smallexample
22842 (gdb)
22843 -data-list-register-names
22844 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
22845 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
22846 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
22847 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
22848 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
22849 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
22850 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
22851 (gdb)
22852 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
22853 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
22854 (gdb)
22855 @end smallexample
22856
22857 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
22858 @findex -data-list-register-values
22859
22860 @subsubheading Synopsis
22861
22862 @smallexample
22863 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
22864 @end smallexample
22865
22866 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
22867 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
22868 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
22869 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
22870
22871 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
22872
22873 @table @code
22874 @item x
22875 Hexadecimal
22876 @item o
22877 Octal
22878 @item t
22879 Binary
22880 @item d
22881 Decimal
22882 @item r
22883 Raw
22884 @item N
22885 Natural
22886 @end table
22887
22888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22889
22890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
22891 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
22892
22893 @subsubheading Example
22894
22895 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
22896 don't appear in the actual output):
22897
22898 @smallexample
22899 (gdb)
22900 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
22901 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
22902 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
22903 (gdb)
22904 -data-list-register-values x
22905 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
22906 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
22907 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
22908 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
22909 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
22910 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
22911 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
22912 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
22913 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
22914 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
22915 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
22916 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
22917 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
22918 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
22919 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
22920 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
22921 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
22922 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
22923 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
22924 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
22925 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
22926 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
22927 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
22928 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
22929 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
22930 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
22931 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
22932 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
22933 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
22934 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
22935 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
22936 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
22937 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
22938 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
22939 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
22940 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
22941 (gdb)
22942 @end smallexample
22943
22944
22945 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
22946 @findex -data-read-memory
22947
22948 @subsubheading Synopsis
22949
22950 @smallexample
22951 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
22952 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
22953 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
22954 @end smallexample
22955
22956 @noindent
22957 where:
22958
22959 @table @samp
22960 @item @var{address}
22961 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
22962 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
22963 quoted using the C convention.
22964
22965 @item @var{word-format}
22966 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
22967 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
22968 ,Output Formats}).
22969
22970 @item @var{word-size}
22971 The size of each memory word in bytes.
22972
22973 @item @var{nr-rows}
22974 The number of rows in the output table.
22975
22976 @item @var{nr-cols}
22977 The number of columns in the output table.
22978
22979 @item @var{aschar}
22980 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
22981 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
22982 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
22983 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
22984
22985 @item @var{byte-offset}
22986 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
22987 @end table
22988
22989 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
22990 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
22991 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
22992 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
22993 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
22994 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
22995 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
22996 @samp{addr}.
22997
22998 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
22999 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
23000 @samp{prev-page}.
23001
23002 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23003
23004 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
23005 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
23006
23007 @subsubheading Example
23008
23009 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
23010 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
23011 word. Display each word in hex.
23012
23013 @smallexample
23014 (gdb)
23015 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
23016 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
23017 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
23018 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
23019 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
23020 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
23021 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
23022 (gdb)
23023 @end smallexample
23024
23025 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
23026 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
23027
23028 @smallexample
23029 (gdb)
23030 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
23031 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
23032 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
23033 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
23034 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
23035 (gdb)
23036 @end smallexample
23037
23038 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
23039 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
23040 used as the non-printable character.
23041
23042 @smallexample
23043 (gdb)
23044 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
23045 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
23046 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
23047 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
23048 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23049 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23050 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23051 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23052 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
23053 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
23054 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
23055 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
23056 (gdb)
23057 @end smallexample
23058
23059 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23060 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
23061 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
23062
23063 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
23064
23065 @c @subheading -trace-actions
23066
23067 @c @subheading -trace-delete
23068
23069 @c @subheading -trace-disable
23070
23071 @c @subheading -trace-dump
23072
23073 @c @subheading -trace-enable
23074
23075 @c @subheading -trace-exists
23076
23077 @c @subheading -trace-find
23078
23079 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
23080
23081 @c @subheading -trace-info
23082
23083 @c @subheading -trace-insert
23084
23085 @c @subheading -trace-list
23086
23087 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
23088
23089 @c @subheading -trace-save
23090
23091 @c @subheading -trace-start
23092
23093 @c @subheading -trace-stop
23094
23095
23096 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23097 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
23098 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
23099
23100
23101 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
23102 @findex -symbol-info-address
23103
23104 @subsubheading Synopsis
23105
23106 @smallexample
23107 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
23108 @end smallexample
23109
23110 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
23111
23112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23113
23114 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
23115
23116 @subsubheading Example
23117 N.A.
23118
23119
23120 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
23121 @findex -symbol-info-file
23122
23123 @subsubheading Synopsis
23124
23125 @smallexample
23126 -symbol-info-file
23127 @end smallexample
23128
23129 Show the file for the symbol.
23130
23131 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23132
23133 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
23134 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
23135
23136 @subsubheading Example
23137 N.A.
23138
23139
23140 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
23141 @findex -symbol-info-function
23142
23143 @subsubheading Synopsis
23144
23145 @smallexample
23146 -symbol-info-function
23147 @end smallexample
23148
23149 Show which function the symbol lives in.
23150
23151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23152
23153 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
23154
23155 @subsubheading Example
23156 N.A.
23157
23158
23159 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
23160 @findex -symbol-info-line
23161
23162 @subsubheading Synopsis
23163
23164 @smallexample
23165 -symbol-info-line
23166 @end smallexample
23167
23168 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
23169
23170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23171
23172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
23173 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
23174
23175 @subsubheading Example
23176 N.A.
23177
23178
23179 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
23180 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
23181
23182 @subsubheading Synopsis
23183
23184 @smallexample
23185 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
23186 @end smallexample
23187
23188 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
23189
23190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23191
23192 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
23193
23194 @subsubheading Example
23195 N.A.
23196
23197
23198 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
23199 @findex -symbol-list-functions
23200
23201 @subsubheading Synopsis
23202
23203 @smallexample
23204 -symbol-list-functions
23205 @end smallexample
23206
23207 List the functions in the executable.
23208
23209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23210
23211 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
23212 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23213
23214 @subsubheading Example
23215 N.A.
23216
23217
23218 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
23219 @findex -symbol-list-lines
23220
23221 @subsubheading Synopsis
23222
23223 @smallexample
23224 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
23225 @end smallexample
23226
23227 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
23228 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
23229 ascending PC order.
23230
23231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23232
23233 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
23234
23235 @subsubheading Example
23236 @smallexample
23237 (gdb)
23238 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
23239 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
23240 (gdb)
23241 @end smallexample
23242
23243
23244 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
23245 @findex -symbol-list-types
23246
23247 @subsubheading Synopsis
23248
23249 @smallexample
23250 -symbol-list-types
23251 @end smallexample
23252
23253 List all the type names.
23254
23255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23256
23257 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
23258 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23259
23260 @subsubheading Example
23261 N.A.
23262
23263
23264 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
23265 @findex -symbol-list-variables
23266
23267 @subsubheading Synopsis
23268
23269 @smallexample
23270 -symbol-list-variables
23271 @end smallexample
23272
23273 List all the global and static variable names.
23274
23275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23276
23277 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23278
23279 @subsubheading Example
23280 N.A.
23281
23282
23283 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
23284 @findex -symbol-locate
23285
23286 @subsubheading Synopsis
23287
23288 @smallexample
23289 -symbol-locate
23290 @end smallexample
23291
23292 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23293
23294 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
23295
23296 @subsubheading Example
23297 N.A.
23298
23299
23300 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
23301 @findex -symbol-type
23302
23303 @subsubheading Synopsis
23304
23305 @smallexample
23306 -symbol-type @var{variable}
23307 @end smallexample
23308
23309 Show type of @var{variable}.
23310
23311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23312
23313 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
23314 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
23315
23316 @subsubheading Example
23317 N.A.
23318
23319
23320 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23321 @node GDB/MI File Commands
23322 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
23323
23324 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
23325 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
23326
23327 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
23328 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
23329
23330 @subsubheading Synopsis
23331
23332 @smallexample
23333 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
23334 @end smallexample
23335
23336 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
23337 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
23338 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
23339 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
23340 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
23341 notification.
23342
23343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23344
23345 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
23346
23347 @subsubheading Example
23348
23349 @smallexample
23350 (gdb)
23351 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23352 ^done
23353 (gdb)
23354 @end smallexample
23355
23356
23357 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
23358 @findex -file-exec-file
23359
23360 @subsubheading Synopsis
23361
23362 @smallexample
23363 -file-exec-file @var{file}
23364 @end smallexample
23365
23366 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
23367 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
23368 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
23369 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
23370 notification.
23371
23372 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23373
23374 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
23375
23376 @subsubheading Example
23377
23378 @smallexample
23379 (gdb)
23380 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23381 ^done
23382 (gdb)
23383 @end smallexample
23384
23385
23386 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
23387 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
23388
23389 @subsubheading Synopsis
23390
23391 @smallexample
23392 -file-list-exec-sections
23393 @end smallexample
23394
23395 List the sections of the current executable file.
23396
23397 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23398
23399 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
23400 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
23401 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
23402
23403 @subsubheading Example
23404 N.A.
23405
23406
23407 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
23408 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
23409
23410 @subsubheading Synopsis
23411
23412 @smallexample
23413 -file-list-exec-source-file
23414 @end smallexample
23415
23416 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
23417 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
23418 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
23419 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
23420
23421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23422
23423 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
23424
23425 @subsubheading Example
23426
23427 @smallexample
23428 (gdb)
23429 123-file-list-exec-source-file
23430 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
23431 (gdb)
23432 @end smallexample
23433
23434
23435 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
23436 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
23437
23438 @subsubheading Synopsis
23439
23440 @smallexample
23441 -file-list-exec-source-files
23442 @end smallexample
23443
23444 List the source files for the current executable.
23445
23446 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
23447 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
23448
23449 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23450
23451 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
23452 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
23453
23454 @subsubheading Example
23455 @smallexample
23456 (gdb)
23457 -file-list-exec-source-files
23458 ^done,files=[
23459 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
23460 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
23461 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
23462 (gdb)
23463 @end smallexample
23464
23465 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
23466 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
23467
23468 @subsubheading Synopsis
23469
23470 @smallexample
23471 -file-list-shared-libraries
23472 @end smallexample
23473
23474 List the shared libraries in the program.
23475
23476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23477
23478 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
23479
23480 @subsubheading Example
23481 N.A.
23482
23483
23484 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
23485 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
23486
23487 @subsubheading Synopsis
23488
23489 @smallexample
23490 -file-list-symbol-files
23491 @end smallexample
23492
23493 List symbol files.
23494
23495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23496
23497 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
23498
23499 @subsubheading Example
23500 N.A.
23501
23502
23503 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
23504 @findex -file-symbol-file
23505
23506 @subsubheading Synopsis
23507
23508 @smallexample
23509 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
23510 @end smallexample
23511
23512 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
23513 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
23514 produced, except for a completion notification.
23515
23516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23517
23518 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
23519
23520 @subsubheading Example
23521
23522 @smallexample
23523 (gdb)
23524 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23525 ^done
23526 (gdb)
23527 @end smallexample
23528
23529 @ignore
23530 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23531 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
23532 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
23533
23534 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
23535
23536 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
23537
23538 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
23539
23540 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
23541
23542 @c @subheading -overlay-map
23543
23544 @c @subheading -overlay-off
23545
23546 @c @subheading -overlay-on
23547
23548 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
23549
23550 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23551 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
23552 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
23553
23554 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
23555
23556 @c @subheading -signal-handle
23557
23558 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
23559
23560 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
23561 @end ignore
23562
23563
23564 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23565 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
23566 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
23567
23568
23569 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
23570 @findex -target-attach
23571
23572 @subsubheading Synopsis
23573
23574 @smallexample
23575 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
23576 @end smallexample
23577
23578 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
23579 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
23580 group, the id previously returned by
23581 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
23582
23583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23584
23585 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
23586
23587 @subsubheading Example
23588 @smallexample
23589 (gdb)
23590 -target-attach 34
23591 =thread-created,id="1"
23592 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
23593 ^done
23594 (gdb)
23595 @end smallexample
23596
23597 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
23598 @findex -target-compare-sections
23599
23600 @subsubheading Synopsis
23601
23602 @smallexample
23603 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
23604 @end smallexample
23605
23606 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
23607 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
23608
23609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23610
23611 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
23612
23613 @subsubheading Example
23614 N.A.
23615
23616
23617 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
23618 @findex -target-detach
23619
23620 @subsubheading Synopsis
23621
23622 @smallexample
23623 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
23624 @end smallexample
23625
23626 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
23627 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
23628 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
23629
23630 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23631
23632 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
23633
23634 @subsubheading Example
23635
23636 @smallexample
23637 (gdb)
23638 -target-detach
23639 ^done
23640 (gdb)
23641 @end smallexample
23642
23643
23644 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
23645 @findex -target-disconnect
23646
23647 @subsubheading Synopsis
23648
23649 @smallexample
23650 -target-disconnect
23651 @end smallexample
23652
23653 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
23654 generally not resumed.
23655
23656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23657
23658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
23659
23660 @subsubheading Example
23661
23662 @smallexample
23663 (gdb)
23664 -target-disconnect
23665 ^done
23666 (gdb)
23667 @end smallexample
23668
23669
23670 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
23671 @findex -target-download
23672
23673 @subsubheading Synopsis
23674
23675 @smallexample
23676 -target-download
23677 @end smallexample
23678
23679 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
23680 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
23681
23682 @table @samp
23683 @item section
23684 The name of the section.
23685 @item section-sent
23686 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
23687 @item section-size
23688 The size of the section.
23689 @item total-sent
23690 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
23691 @item total-size
23692 The size of the overall executable to download.
23693 @end table
23694
23695 @noindent
23696 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
23697 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
23698
23699 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
23700 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
23701
23702 @table @samp
23703 @item section
23704 The name of the section.
23705 @item section-size
23706 The size of the section.
23707 @item total-size
23708 The size of the overall executable to download.
23709 @end table
23710
23711 @noindent
23712 At the end, a summary is printed.
23713
23714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23715
23716 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
23717
23718 @subsubheading Example
23719
23720 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
23721 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
23722
23723 @smallexample
23724 (gdb)
23725 -target-download
23726 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
23727 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
23728 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
23729 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
23730 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
23731 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
23732 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
23733 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
23734 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
23735 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
23736 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
23737 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
23738 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
23739 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
23740 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
23741 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
23742 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
23743 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
23744 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
23745 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
23746 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
23747 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
23748 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
23749 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
23750 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
23751 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
23752 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
23753 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23754 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23755 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
23756 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
23757 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
23758 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
23759 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
23760 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
23761 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
23762 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
23763 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
23764 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
23765 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
23766 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
23767 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
23768 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
23769 write-rate="429"
23770 (gdb)
23771 @end smallexample
23772
23773
23774 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
23775 @findex -target-exec-status
23776
23777 @subsubheading Synopsis
23778
23779 @smallexample
23780 -target-exec-status
23781 @end smallexample
23782
23783 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
23784 not, for instance).
23785
23786 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23787
23788 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
23789
23790 @subsubheading Example
23791 N.A.
23792
23793
23794 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
23795 @findex -target-list-available-targets
23796
23797 @subsubheading Synopsis
23798
23799 @smallexample
23800 -target-list-available-targets
23801 @end smallexample
23802
23803 List the possible targets to connect to.
23804
23805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23806
23807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
23808
23809 @subsubheading Example
23810 N.A.
23811
23812
23813 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
23814 @findex -target-list-current-targets
23815
23816 @subsubheading Synopsis
23817
23818 @smallexample
23819 -target-list-current-targets
23820 @end smallexample
23821
23822 Describe the current target.
23823
23824 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23825
23826 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
23827 other things).
23828
23829 @subsubheading Example
23830 N.A.
23831
23832
23833 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
23834 @findex -target-list-parameters
23835
23836 @subsubheading Synopsis
23837
23838 @smallexample
23839 -target-list-parameters
23840 @end smallexample
23841
23842 @c ????
23843
23844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23845
23846 No equivalent.
23847
23848 @subsubheading Example
23849 N.A.
23850
23851
23852 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
23853 @findex -target-select
23854
23855 @subsubheading Synopsis
23856
23857 @smallexample
23858 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
23859 @end smallexample
23860
23861 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
23862
23863 @table @samp
23864 @item @var{type}
23865 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
23866 @item @var{parameters}
23867 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
23868 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
23869 @end table
23870
23871 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
23872 which the target program is, in the following form:
23873
23874 @smallexample
23875 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
23876 args=[@var{arg list}]
23877 @end smallexample
23878
23879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23880
23881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
23882
23883 @subsubheading Example
23884
23885 @smallexample
23886 (gdb)
23887 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
23888 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
23889 (gdb)
23890 @end smallexample
23891
23892 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23893 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
23894 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
23895
23896
23897 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
23898 @findex -target-file-put
23899
23900 @subsubheading Synopsis
23901
23902 @smallexample
23903 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
23904 @end smallexample
23905
23906 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
23907 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
23908
23909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23910
23911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
23912
23913 @subsubheading Example
23914
23915 @smallexample
23916 (gdb)
23917 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
23918 ^done
23919 (gdb)
23920 @end smallexample
23921
23922
23923 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
23924 @findex -target-file-get
23925
23926 @subsubheading Synopsis
23927
23928 @smallexample
23929 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
23930 @end smallexample
23931
23932 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
23933 on the host system.
23934
23935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23936
23937 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
23938
23939 @subsubheading Example
23940
23941 @smallexample
23942 (gdb)
23943 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
23944 ^done
23945 (gdb)
23946 @end smallexample
23947
23948
23949 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
23950 @findex -target-file-delete
23951
23952 @subsubheading Synopsis
23953
23954 @smallexample
23955 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
23956 @end smallexample
23957
23958 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
23959
23960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23961
23962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
23963
23964 @subsubheading Example
23965
23966 @smallexample
23967 (gdb)
23968 -target-file-delete remotefile
23969 ^done
23970 (gdb)
23971 @end smallexample
23972
23973
23974 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23975 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
23976 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
23977
23978 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
23979
23980 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
23981 @findex -gdb-exit
23982
23983 @subsubheading Synopsis
23984
23985 @smallexample
23986 -gdb-exit
23987 @end smallexample
23988
23989 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
23990
23991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23992
23993 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
23994
23995 @subsubheading Example
23996
23997 @smallexample
23998 (gdb)
23999 -gdb-exit
24000 ^exit
24001 @end smallexample
24002
24003
24004 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
24005 @findex -exec-abort
24006
24007 @subsubheading Synopsis
24008
24009 @smallexample
24010 -exec-abort
24011 @end smallexample
24012
24013 Kill the inferior running program.
24014
24015 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24016
24017 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
24018
24019 @subsubheading Example
24020 N.A.
24021
24022
24023 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
24024 @findex -gdb-set
24025
24026 @subsubheading Synopsis
24027
24028 @smallexample
24029 -gdb-set
24030 @end smallexample
24031
24032 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
24033 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
24034
24035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24036
24037 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
24038
24039 @subsubheading Example
24040
24041 @smallexample
24042 (gdb)
24043 -gdb-set $foo=3
24044 ^done
24045 (gdb)
24046 @end smallexample
24047
24048
24049 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
24050 @findex -gdb-show
24051
24052 @subsubheading Synopsis
24053
24054 @smallexample
24055 -gdb-show
24056 @end smallexample
24057
24058 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
24059
24060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24061
24062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
24063
24064 @subsubheading Example
24065
24066 @smallexample
24067 (gdb)
24068 -gdb-show annotate
24069 ^done,value="0"
24070 (gdb)
24071 @end smallexample
24072
24073 @c @subheading -gdb-source
24074
24075
24076 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
24077 @findex -gdb-version
24078
24079 @subsubheading Synopsis
24080
24081 @smallexample
24082 -gdb-version
24083 @end smallexample
24084
24085 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
24086
24087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24088
24089 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
24090 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
24091
24092 @subsubheading Example
24093
24094 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
24095 @c box in TeX.
24096 @smallexample
24097 (gdb)
24098 -gdb-version
24099 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
24100 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
24101 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
24102 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
24103 ~ certain conditions.
24104 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
24105 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
24106 ~ details.
24107 ~This GDB was configured as
24108 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
24109 ^done
24110 (gdb)
24111 @end smallexample
24112
24113 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
24114 @findex -list-features
24115
24116 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
24117 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
24118 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
24119 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
24120 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
24121 startup.
24122
24123 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
24124 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
24125 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
24126 is given below.
24127
24128 Example output:
24129
24130 @smallexample
24131 (gdb) -list-features
24132 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
24133 @end smallexample
24134
24135 The current list of features is:
24136
24137 @table @samp
24138 @item frozen-varobjs
24139 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
24140 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
24141 of @code{-varobj-create}.
24142 @item pending-breakpoints
24143 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
24144 @item thread-info
24145 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
24146
24147 @end table
24148
24149 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
24150 @findex -list-target-features
24151
24152 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
24153 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
24154 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
24155 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
24156 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
24157 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
24158 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
24159 Example output:
24160
24161 @smallexample
24162 (gdb) -list-features
24163 ^done,result=["async"]
24164 @end smallexample
24165
24166 The current list of features is:
24167
24168 @table @samp
24169 @item async
24170 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
24171 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
24172 while the target is running.
24173
24174 @end table
24175
24176 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
24177 @findex -list-thread-groups
24178
24179 @subheading Synopsis
24180
24181 @smallexample
24182 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ @var{group} ]
24183 @end smallexample
24184
24185 When used without the @var{group} parameter, lists top-level thread
24186 groups that are being debugged. When used with the @var{group}
24187 parameter, the children of the specified group are listed. The
24188 children can be either threads, or other groups. At present,
24189 @value{GDBN} will not report both threads and groups as children at
24190 the same time, but it may change in future.
24191
24192 With the @samp{--available} option, instead of reporting groups that
24193 are been debugged, GDB will report all thread groups available on the
24194 target. Using the @samp{--available} option together with @var{group}
24195 is not allowed.
24196
24197 @subheading Example
24198
24199 @smallexample
24200 @value{GDBP}
24201 -list-thread-groups
24202 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
24203 -list-thread-groups 17
24204 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
24205 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
24206 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
24207 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
24208 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
24209 @end smallexample
24210
24211 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
24212 @findex -interpreter-exec
24213
24214 @subheading Synopsis
24215
24216 @smallexample
24217 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
24218 @end smallexample
24219 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
24220
24221 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
24222
24223 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24224
24225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
24226
24227 @subheading Example
24228
24229 @smallexample
24230 (gdb)
24231 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
24232 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
24233 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
24234 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
24235 ^done
24236 (gdb)
24237 @end smallexample
24238
24239 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
24240 @findex -inferior-tty-set
24241
24242 @subheading Synopsis
24243
24244 @smallexample
24245 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24246 @end smallexample
24247
24248 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
24249
24250 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24251
24252 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
24253
24254 @subheading Example
24255
24256 @smallexample
24257 (gdb)
24258 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24259 ^done
24260 (gdb)
24261 @end smallexample
24262
24263 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
24264 @findex -inferior-tty-show
24265
24266 @subheading Synopsis
24267
24268 @smallexample
24269 -inferior-tty-show
24270 @end smallexample
24271
24272 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
24273
24274 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24275
24276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
24277
24278 @subheading Example
24279
24280 @smallexample
24281 (gdb)
24282 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24283 ^done
24284 (gdb)
24285 -inferior-tty-show
24286 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
24287 (gdb)
24288 @end smallexample
24289
24290 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
24291 @findex -enable-timings
24292
24293 @subheading Synopsis
24294
24295 @smallexample
24296 -enable-timings [yes | no]
24297 @end smallexample
24298
24299 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
24300 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
24301 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
24302 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
24303
24304 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24305
24306 No equivalent.
24307
24308 @subheading Example
24309
24310 @smallexample
24311 (gdb)
24312 -enable-timings
24313 ^done
24314 (gdb)
24315 -break-insert main
24316 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24317 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
24318 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
24319 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
24320 (gdb)
24321 -enable-timings no
24322 ^done
24323 (gdb)
24324 -exec-run
24325 ^running
24326 (gdb)
24327 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
24328 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
24329 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
24330 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
24331 (gdb)
24332 @end smallexample
24333
24334 @node Annotations
24335 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
24336
24337 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
24338 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
24339 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
24340 relatively high level.
24341
24342 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
24343 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
24344
24345 @ignore
24346 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
24347 @end ignore
24348
24349 @menu
24350 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
24351 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
24352 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
24353 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
24354 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
24355 * Annotations for Running::
24356 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
24357 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
24358 @end menu
24359
24360 @node Annotations Overview
24361 @section What is an Annotation?
24362 @cindex annotations
24363
24364 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
24365 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
24366 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
24367 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
24368 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
24369 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
24370 cannot contain newline characters.
24371
24372 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
24373 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
24374 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
24375 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
24376 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
24377 means those three characters as output.
24378
24379 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
24380 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
24381 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
24382 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
24383 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
24384 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
24385 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
24386 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
24387 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
24388
24389 @table @code
24390 @kindex set annotate
24391 @item set annotate @var{level}
24392 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
24393 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
24394
24395 @item show annotate
24396 @kindex show annotate
24397 Show the current annotation level.
24398 @end table
24399
24400 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
24401
24402 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
24403
24404 @smallexample
24405 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
24406 GNU gdb 6.0
24407 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
24408 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
24409 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
24410 under certain conditions.
24411 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
24412 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
24413 for details.
24414 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
24415
24416 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
24417 (@value{GDBP})
24418 ^Z^Zprompt
24419 @kbd{quit}
24420
24421 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
24422 $
24423 @end smallexample
24424
24425 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
24426 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
24427 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
24428 output from @value{GDBN}.
24429
24430 @node Server Prefix
24431 @section The Server Prefix
24432 @cindex server prefix
24433
24434 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
24435 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
24436 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
24437 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
24438 a transparent manner.
24439
24440 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24441 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24442 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24443
24444 @node Prompting
24445 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
24446
24447 @cindex annotations for prompts
24448 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
24449 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
24450 over, etc.
24451
24452 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
24453 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
24454 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
24455 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
24456 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
24457 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
24458 features the following annotations:
24459
24460 @smallexample
24461 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
24462 ^Z^Zprompt
24463 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
24464 @end smallexample
24465
24466 The input types are
24467
24468 @table @code
24469 @findex pre-prompt annotation
24470 @findex prompt annotation
24471 @findex post-prompt annotation
24472 @item prompt
24473 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
24474
24475 @findex pre-commands annotation
24476 @findex commands annotation
24477 @findex post-commands annotation
24478 @item commands
24479 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
24480 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
24481
24482 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
24483 @findex overload-choice annotation
24484 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
24485 @item overload-choice
24486 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
24487
24488 @findex pre-query annotation
24489 @findex query annotation
24490 @findex post-query annotation
24491 @item query
24492 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
24493
24494 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
24495 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
24496 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
24497 @item prompt-for-continue
24498 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
24499 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
24500 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
24501 presence of annotations.
24502 @end table
24503
24504 @node Errors
24505 @section Errors
24506 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
24507
24508 @findex quit annotation
24509 @smallexample
24510 ^Z^Zquit
24511 @end smallexample
24512
24513 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
24514
24515 @findex error annotation
24516 @smallexample
24517 ^Z^Zerror
24518 @end smallexample
24519
24520 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
24521
24522 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
24523 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
24524 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
24525 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
24526 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
24527 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
24528 to the top level.
24529
24530 @findex error-begin annotation
24531 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
24532
24533 @smallexample
24534 ^Z^Zerror-begin
24535 @end smallexample
24536
24537 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
24538 message.
24539
24540 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
24541 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
24542 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
24543
24544 @node Invalidation
24545 @section Invalidation Notices
24546
24547 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
24548 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
24549 changed.
24550
24551 @table @code
24552 @findex frames-invalid annotation
24553 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
24554
24555 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
24556 have changed.
24557
24558 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
24559 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
24560
24561 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
24562 deleted a breakpoint.
24563 @end table
24564
24565 @node Annotations for Running
24566 @section Running the Program
24567 @cindex annotations for running programs
24568
24569 @findex starting annotation
24570 @findex stopping annotation
24571 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
24572 @code{step} or @code{continue},
24573
24574 @smallexample
24575 ^Z^Zstarting
24576 @end smallexample
24577
24578 is output. When the program stops,
24579
24580 @smallexample
24581 ^Z^Zstopped
24582 @end smallexample
24583
24584 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
24585 annotations describe how the program stopped.
24586
24587 @table @code
24588 @findex exited annotation
24589 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
24590 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
24591 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
24592
24593 @findex signalled annotation
24594 @findex signal-name annotation
24595 @findex signal-name-end annotation
24596 @findex signal-string annotation
24597 @findex signal-string-end annotation
24598 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
24599 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
24600 annotation continues:
24601
24602 @smallexample
24603 @var{intro-text}
24604 ^Z^Zsignal-name
24605 @var{name}
24606 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
24607 @var{middle-text}
24608 ^Z^Zsignal-string
24609 @var{string}
24610 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
24611 @var{end-text}
24612 @end smallexample
24613
24614 @noindent
24615 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
24616 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
24617 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
24618 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
24619 user's benefit and have no particular format.
24620
24621 @findex signal annotation
24622 @item ^Z^Zsignal
24623 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
24624 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
24625 terminated with it.
24626
24627 @findex breakpoint annotation
24628 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
24629 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
24630
24631 @findex watchpoint annotation
24632 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
24633 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
24634 @end table
24635
24636 @node Source Annotations
24637 @section Displaying Source
24638 @cindex annotations for source display
24639
24640 @findex source annotation
24641 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
24642
24643 @smallexample
24644 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
24645 @end smallexample
24646
24647 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
24648 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
24649 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
24650 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
24651 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
24652 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
24653 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
24654 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
24655 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
24656 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
24657 depend on the language).
24658
24659 @node GDB Bugs
24660 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
24661 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
24662 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
24663
24664 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
24665
24666 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
24667 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
24668 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
24669 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
24670
24671 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
24672 information that enables us to fix the bug.
24673
24674 @menu
24675 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
24676 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
24677 @end menu
24678
24679 @node Bug Criteria
24680 @section Have You Found a Bug?
24681 @cindex bug criteria
24682
24683 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
24684
24685 @itemize @bullet
24686 @cindex fatal signal
24687 @cindex debugger crash
24688 @cindex crash of debugger
24689 @item
24690 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
24691 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
24692
24693 @cindex error on valid input
24694 @item
24695 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
24696 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
24697 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
24698
24699 @cindex invalid input
24700 @item
24701 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
24702 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
24703 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
24704 for traditional practice''.
24705
24706 @item
24707 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
24708 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
24709 @end itemize
24710
24711 @node Bug Reporting
24712 @section How to Report Bugs
24713 @cindex bug reports
24714 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
24715
24716 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
24717 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
24718 contact that organization first.
24719
24720 You can find contact information for many support companies and
24721 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
24722 distribution.
24723 @c should add a web page ref...
24724
24725 @ifset BUGURL
24726 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
24727 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24728 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
24729 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
24730 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
24731 be used.
24732
24733 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
24734 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
24735 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
24736 @samp{bug-gdb}.
24737
24738 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
24739 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
24740 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
24741 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
24742 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
24743 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
24744 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
24745 bug reports to the mailing list.
24746 @end ifset
24747 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
24748 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24749 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
24750 @end ifclear
24751 @end ifset
24752
24753 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
24754 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
24755 fact or leave it out, state it!
24756
24757 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
24758 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
24759 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
24760 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
24761 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
24762 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
24763 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
24764 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
24765 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
24766
24767 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
24768 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
24769 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
24770 self-contained.
24771
24772 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
24773 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
24774 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
24775 bugs properly.
24776
24777 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
24778
24779 @itemize @bullet
24780 @item
24781 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
24782 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
24783 version}.
24784
24785 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
24786 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
24787
24788 @item
24789 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
24790 version number.
24791
24792 @item
24793 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
24794 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
24795
24796 @item
24797 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
24798 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
24799 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
24800 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
24801 those compilers.
24802
24803 @item
24804 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
24805 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
24806 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
24807 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
24808
24809 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
24810 and then we might not encounter the bug.
24811
24812 @item
24813 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
24814 reproduce the bug.
24815
24816 @item
24817 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
24818 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
24819
24820 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
24821 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
24822 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
24823 a chance to make a mistake.
24824
24825 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
24826 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
24827 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
24828 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
24829 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
24830 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
24831 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
24832 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
24833
24834 @pindex script
24835 @cindex recording a session script
24836 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
24837 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
24838 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
24839 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
24840
24841 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
24842 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
24843
24844 @item
24845 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
24846 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
24847 it by context, not by line number.
24848
24849 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
24850 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
24851
24852 @end itemize
24853
24854 Here are some things that are not necessary:
24855
24856 @itemize @bullet
24857 @item
24858 A description of the envelope of the bug.
24859
24860 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
24861 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
24862 changes will not affect it.
24863
24864 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
24865 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
24866 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
24867 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
24868
24869 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
24870 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
24871 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
24872 less time, and so on.
24873
24874 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
24875 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
24876
24877 @item
24878 A patch for the bug.
24879
24880 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
24881 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
24882 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
24883 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
24884
24885 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
24886 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
24887 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
24888 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
24889
24890 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
24891 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
24892 help us to understand.
24893
24894 @item
24895 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
24896
24897 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
24898 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
24899 @end itemize
24900
24901 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
24902 @c and consists of the two following files:
24903 @c rluser.texinfo
24904 @c inc-hist.texinfo
24905 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
24906 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
24907 @include rluser.texi
24908 @include inc-hist.texinfo
24909
24910
24911 @node Formatting Documentation
24912 @appendix Formatting Documentation
24913
24914 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
24915 @cindex reference card
24916 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
24917 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
24918 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
24919 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
24920 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
24921 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
24922
24923 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
24924 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
24925
24926 @smallexample
24927 make refcard.dvi
24928 @end smallexample
24929
24930 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
24931 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
24932 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
24933 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
24934 your @sc{dvi} output program.
24935
24936 @cindex documentation
24937
24938 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
24939 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
24940 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
24941 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
24942 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
24943 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
24944
24945 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
24946 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
24947 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
24948 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
24949 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
24950 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
24951 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
24952 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
24953
24954 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
24955 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
24956 @code{makeinfo}.
24957
24958 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
24959 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
24960 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
24961
24962 @smallexample
24963 cd gdb
24964 make gdb.info
24965 @end smallexample
24966
24967 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
24968 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
24969 Texinfo definitions file.
24970
24971 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
24972 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
24973 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
24974 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
24975 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
24976 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
24977 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
24978
24979 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
24980 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
24981 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
24982 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
24983 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
24984 directory.
24985
24986 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
24987 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
24988 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
24989 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
24990
24991 @smallexample
24992 make gdb.dvi
24993 @end smallexample
24994
24995 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
24996
24997 @node Installing GDB
24998 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
24999 @cindex installation
25000
25001 @menu
25002 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
25003 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
25004 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
25005 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
25006 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
25007 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
25008 @end menu
25009
25010 @node Requirements
25011 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
25012 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
25013
25014 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
25015 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
25016
25017 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
25018 @table @asis
25019 @item ISO C90 compiler
25020 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
25021 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
25022
25023 @end table
25024
25025 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
25026 @table @asis
25027 @item Expat
25028 @anchor{Expat}
25029 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
25030 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
25031 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
25032 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
25033 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
25034 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
25035
25036 Expat is used for:
25037
25038 @itemize @bullet
25039 @item
25040 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
25041 @item
25042 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
25043 @item
25044 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
25045 @item
25046 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
25047 @end itemize
25048
25049 @item zlib
25050 @cindex compressed debug sections
25051 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
25052 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
25053 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
25054 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
25055 information in such binaries.
25056
25057 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
25058 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
25059 @url{http://zlib.net}.
25060
25061 @item iconv
25062 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
25063 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
25064 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
25065 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
25066
25067 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
25068 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
25069 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
25070
25071 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
25072 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
25073 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
25074 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
25075 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
25076 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
25077 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
25078 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
25079 @end table
25080
25081 @node Running Configure
25082 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
25083 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
25084 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
25085 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
25086 build the @code{gdb} program.
25087 @iftex
25088 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
25089 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
25090 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
25091 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
25092 @end iftex
25093
25094 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
25095 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
25096 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
25097
25098 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
25099 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
25100
25101 @table @code
25102 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
25103 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
25104
25105 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
25106 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
25107
25108 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
25109 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
25110
25111 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
25112 @sc{gnu} include files
25113
25114 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
25115 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
25116
25117 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
25118 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
25119
25120 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
25121 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
25122
25123 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
25124 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
25125
25126 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
25127 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
25128 @end table
25129
25130 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
25131 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
25132 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
25133
25134 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
25135 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
25136 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
25137 argument.
25138
25139 For example:
25140
25141 @smallexample
25142 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
25143 ./configure @var{host}
25144 make
25145 @end smallexample
25146
25147 @noindent
25148 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
25149 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
25150 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
25151 correct value by examining your system.)
25152
25153 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
25154 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
25155 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
25156 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
25157
25158 @need 750
25159 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
25160 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
25161 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
25162
25163 @smallexample
25164 sh configure @var{host}
25165 @end smallexample
25166
25167 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
25168 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
25169 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
25170 @file{configure}
25171 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
25172 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
25173
25174 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
25175 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
25176 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
25177 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
25178 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
25179 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
25180 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
25181 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
25182 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
25183
25184 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
25185 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
25186 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
25187 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
25188 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
25189
25190 @node Separate Objdir
25191 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
25192
25193 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
25194 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
25195 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
25196 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
25197 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
25198 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
25199 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
25200 program specified there.
25201
25202 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
25203 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
25204 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
25205 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
25206 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
25207 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
25208
25209 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
25210 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
25211
25212 @smallexample
25213 @group
25214 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
25215 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
25216 cd ../gdb-sun4
25217 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
25218 make
25219 @end group
25220 @end smallexample
25221
25222 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
25223 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
25224 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
25225 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
25226 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
25227 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
25228
25229 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
25230 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
25231 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
25232 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
25233 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
25234
25235 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
25236 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
25237 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
25238 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
25239 You specify a cross-debugging target by
25240 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
25241
25242 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
25243 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
25244 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
25245
25246 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
25247 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
25248 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
25249 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
25250 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
25251
25252 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
25253 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
25254 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
25255 with each other.
25256
25257 @node Config Names
25258 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
25259
25260 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
25261 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
25262 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
25263 of information in the following pattern:
25264
25265 @smallexample
25266 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
25267 @end smallexample
25268
25269 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
25270 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
25271 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
25272
25273 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
25274 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
25275 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
25276 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
25277 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
25278 abbreviations---for example:
25279
25280 @smallexample
25281 % sh config.sub i386-linux
25282 i386-pc-linux-gnu
25283 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
25284 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
25285 % sh config.sub hp9k700
25286 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
25287 % sh config.sub sun4
25288 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
25289 % sh config.sub sun3
25290 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
25291 % sh config.sub i986v
25292 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
25293 @end smallexample
25294
25295 @noindent
25296 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
25297 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
25298
25299 @node Configure Options
25300 @section @file{configure} Options
25301
25302 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
25303 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
25304 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
25305 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
25306
25307 @smallexample
25308 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
25309 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
25310 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
25311 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
25312 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
25313 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
25314 @var{host}
25315 @end smallexample
25316
25317 @noindent
25318 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
25319 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
25320 @samp{--}.
25321
25322 @table @code
25323 @item --help
25324 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
25325
25326 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
25327 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
25328 @file{@var{dir}}.
25329
25330 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
25331 Configure the source to install programs under directory
25332 @file{@var{dir}}.
25333
25334 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
25335 @need 2000
25336 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
25337 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
25338 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
25339 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
25340 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
25341 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
25342 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
25343 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
25344 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
25345 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
25346 @var{dirname}.
25347
25348 @item --norecursion
25349 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
25350 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
25351
25352 @item --target=@var{target}
25353 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
25354 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
25355 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
25356
25357 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
25358
25359 @item @var{host} @dots{}
25360 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
25361
25362 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
25363 @end table
25364
25365 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
25366 needed for special purposes only.
25367
25368 @node System-wide configuration
25369 @section System-wide configuration and settings
25370 @cindex system-wide init file
25371
25372 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
25373 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
25374 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
25375
25376 Here is the corresponding configure option:
25377
25378 @table @code
25379 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
25380 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
25381 @var{file}.
25382 @end table
25383
25384 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
25385 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
25386
25387 @itemize @bullet
25388 @item
25389 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
25390 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
25391 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
25392 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
25393 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
25394 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
25395
25396 @item
25397 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
25398 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
25399 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
25400 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
25401 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
25402 @end itemize
25403
25404 @node Maintenance Commands
25405 @appendix Maintenance Commands
25406 @cindex maintenance commands
25407 @cindex internal commands
25408
25409 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
25410 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
25411 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
25412 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
25413 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
25414
25415 @table @code
25416 @kindex maint agent
25417 @item maint agent @var{expression}
25418 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
25419 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
25420 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
25421
25422 @kindex maint info breakpoints
25423 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
25424 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
25425 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
25426 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
25427 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
25428 is shown:
25429
25430 @table @code
25431 @item breakpoint
25432 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
25433
25434 @item watchpoint
25435 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
25436
25437 @item longjmp
25438 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
25439 @code{longjmp} calls.
25440
25441 @item longjmp resume
25442 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
25443
25444 @item until
25445 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
25446
25447 @item finish
25448 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
25449
25450 @item shlib events
25451 Shared library events.
25452
25453 @end table
25454
25455 @kindex set displaced-stepping
25456 @kindex show displaced-stepping
25457 @cindex displaced stepping support
25458 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
25459 @item set displaced-stepping
25460 @itemx show displaced-stepping
25461 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
25462 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
25463 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
25464 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
25465 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
25466
25467 @table @code
25468 @item set displaced-stepping on
25469 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
25470 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
25471
25472 @item set displaced-stepping off
25473 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
25474 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
25475
25476 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
25477 @item set displaced-stepping auto
25478 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
25479 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
25480 architecture supports displaced stepping.
25481 @end table
25482
25483 @kindex maint check-symtabs
25484 @item maint check-symtabs
25485 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
25486
25487 @kindex maint cplus first_component
25488 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
25489 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
25490
25491 @kindex maint cplus namespace
25492 @item maint cplus namespace
25493 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
25494
25495 @kindex maint demangle
25496 @item maint demangle @var{name}
25497 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
25498
25499 @kindex maint deprecate
25500 @kindex maint undeprecate
25501 @cindex deprecated commands
25502 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
25503 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
25504 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
25505 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
25506 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
25507 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
25508 the replacement as part of the warning.
25509
25510 @kindex maint dump-me
25511 @item maint dump-me
25512 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
25513 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
25514 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
25515 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
25516
25517 @kindex maint internal-error
25518 @kindex maint internal-warning
25519 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
25520 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
25521 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
25522 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
25523 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
25524 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
25525 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
25526 @value{GDBN} session.
25527
25528 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
25529 used as the text of the error or warning message.
25530
25531 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
25532
25533 @smallexample
25534 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
25535 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
25536 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
25537 debugging may prove unreliable.
25538 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
25539 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
25540 (@value{GDBP})
25541 @end smallexample
25542
25543 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
25544 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
25545
25546 @kindex maint set internal-error
25547 @kindex maint show internal-error
25548 @kindex maint set internal-warning
25549 @kindex maint show internal-warning
25550 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
25551 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
25552 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
25553 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
25554 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
25555 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
25556 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
25557 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
25558 described in the table below.
25559
25560 @table @samp
25561 @item quit
25562 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
25563 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
25564
25565 @item corefile
25566 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
25567 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
25568 @end table
25569
25570 @kindex maint packet
25571 @item maint packet @var{text}
25572 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
25573 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
25574 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
25575 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
25576 checksum.
25577
25578 @kindex maint print architecture
25579 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25580 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
25581 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
25582
25583 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
25584 @item maint print c-tdesc
25585 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
25586 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
25587 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
25588
25589 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
25590 @item maint print dummy-frames
25591 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
25592
25593 @smallexample
25594 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
25595 @dots{}
25596 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
25597 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
25598 58 return (a + b);
25599 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
25600 @dots{}
25601 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
25602 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
25603 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
25604 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
25605 (@value{GDBP})
25606 @end smallexample
25607
25608 Takes an optional file parameter.
25609
25610 @kindex maint print registers
25611 @kindex maint print raw-registers
25612 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
25613 @kindex maint print register-groups
25614 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25615 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25616 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25617 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25618 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
25619
25620 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
25621 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
25622 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
25623 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
25624 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
25625 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
25626
25627 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
25628 write the information.
25629
25630 @kindex maint print reggroups
25631 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25632 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
25633 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
25634 information.
25635
25636 The register groups info looks like this:
25637
25638 @smallexample
25639 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
25640 Group Type
25641 general user
25642 float user
25643 all user
25644 vector user
25645 system user
25646 save internal
25647 restore internal
25648 @end smallexample
25649
25650 @kindex flushregs
25651 @item flushregs
25652 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
25653
25654 @kindex maint print objfiles
25655 @cindex info for known object files
25656 @item maint print objfiles
25657 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
25658 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
25659 and symtabs.
25660
25661 @kindex maint print statistics
25662 @cindex bcache statistics
25663 @item maint print statistics
25664 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
25665 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
25666 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
25667 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
25668 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
25669 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
25670 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
25671 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
25672 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
25673 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
25674 lengths.
25675
25676 @kindex maint print target-stack
25677 @cindex target stack description
25678 @item maint print target-stack
25679 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
25680 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
25681 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
25682 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
25683 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
25684 address.
25685
25686 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
25687 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
25688
25689 @kindex maint print type
25690 @cindex type chain of a data type
25691 @item maint print type @var{expr}
25692 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
25693 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
25694 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
25695 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
25696 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
25697
25698 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
25699 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
25700 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
25701 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
25702 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
25703
25704 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
25705 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
25706 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
25707 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
25708 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
25709 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
25710 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
25711 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
25712 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
25713
25714 @kindex maint set profile
25715 @kindex maint show profile
25716 @cindex profiling GDB
25717 @item maint set profile
25718 @itemx maint show profile
25719 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
25720
25721 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
25722 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
25723 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
25724 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
25725 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
25726 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
25727 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
25728
25729 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
25730 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
25731
25732 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
25733 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
25734 @item maint show-debug-regs
25735 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
25736 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
25737 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
25738 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
25739 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
25740
25741 @kindex maint space
25742 @cindex memory used by commands
25743 @item maint space
25744 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
25745 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
25746 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
25747 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
25748 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25749
25750 @kindex maint time
25751 @cindex time of command execution
25752 @item maint time
25753 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
25754 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
25755 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
25756 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
25757 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
25758 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
25759 it's not possibly currently
25760 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
25761 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25762
25763 @kindex maint translate-address
25764 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
25765 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
25766 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
25767 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
25768 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
25769 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
25770 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
25771
25772 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
25773 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
25774 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
25775
25776 @end table
25777
25778 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
25779 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
25780
25781 @table @code
25782 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
25783 @kindex set watchdog
25784 @cindex watchdog timer
25785 @cindex timeout for commands
25786 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
25787 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
25788 reports and error and the command is aborted.
25789
25790 @item show watchdog
25791 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
25792 @end table
25793
25794 @node Remote Protocol
25795 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
25796
25797 @menu
25798 * Overview::
25799 * Packets::
25800 * Stop Reply Packets::
25801 * General Query Packets::
25802 * Register Packet Format::
25803 * Tracepoint Packets::
25804 * Host I/O Packets::
25805 * Interrupts::
25806 * Notification Packets::
25807 * Remote Non-Stop::
25808 * Packet Acknowledgment::
25809 * Examples::
25810 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
25811 * Library List Format::
25812 * Memory Map Format::
25813 @end menu
25814
25815 @node Overview
25816 @section Overview
25817
25818 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
25819 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
25820 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
25821 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
25822
25823 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
25824 transmitted and received data, respectively.
25825
25826 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
25827 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
25828 @cindex remote serial protocol
25829 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
25830 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
25831 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
25832 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
25833 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
25834
25835 @smallexample
25836 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25837 @end smallexample
25838 @noindent
25839
25840 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
25841 @noindent
25842 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
25843 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
25844 eight bit unsigned checksum).
25845
25846 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
25847 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
25848
25849 @smallexample
25850 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25851 @end smallexample
25852
25853 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
25854 @noindent
25855 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
25856 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
25857 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
25858
25859 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
25860 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
25861 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
25862 retransmission):
25863
25864 @smallexample
25865 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25866 <- @code{+}
25867 @end smallexample
25868 @noindent
25869
25870 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
25871 once a connection is established.
25872 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
25873
25874 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
25875 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
25876 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
25877 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
25878 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
25879 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
25880 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
25881
25882 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
25883 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
25884 exceptions).
25885
25886 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
25887 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
25888 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
25889 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
25890
25891 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
25892 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
25893 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
25894
25895 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
25896 @anchor{Binary Data}
25897 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
25898 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
25899 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
25900 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
25901 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
25902 binary data.
25903
25904 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
25905 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
25906 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
25907 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
25908 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
25909 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
25910 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
25911 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
25912 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
25913 (described next).
25914
25915 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
25916 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
25917 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
25918 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
25919 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
25920 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
25921 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
25922 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
25923 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
25924 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
25925 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
25926 3}} more times.
25927
25928 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
25929 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
25930 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
25931 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
25932 @samp{0*"00}.
25933
25934 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
25935 error number. That number is not well defined.
25936
25937 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
25938 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
25939 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
25940 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
25941 on that response.
25942
25943 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
25944 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
25945 optional.
25946
25947 @node Packets
25948 @section Packets
25949
25950 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
25951 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
25952 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
25953 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
25954
25955 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
25956 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
25957 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
25958 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
25959 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
25960 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
25961 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
25962 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
25963 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
25964 @var{baz}.
25965
25966 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
25967 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
25968 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
25969 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
25970 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
25971 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
25972 pick any thread.
25973
25974 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
25975 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
25976 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
25977 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
25978 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
25979 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
25980 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
25981 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
25982 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
25983 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
25984 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
25985 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
25986 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
25987
25988 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
25989 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
25990 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
25991 more information.
25992
25993 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
25994 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
25995
25996 Here are the packet descriptions.
25997
25998 @table @samp
25999
26000 @item !
26001 @cindex @samp{!} packet
26002 @anchor{extended mode}
26003 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
26004 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
26005 debugged.
26006
26007 Reply:
26008 @table @samp
26009 @item OK
26010 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
26011 @end table
26012
26013 @item ?
26014 @cindex @samp{?} packet
26015 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
26016 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
26017 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
26018
26019 Reply:
26020 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26021
26022 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
26023 @cindex @samp{A} packet
26024 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
26025 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
26026 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
26027
26028 Reply:
26029 @table @samp
26030 @item OK
26031 The arguments were set.
26032 @item E @var{NN}
26033 An error occurred.
26034 @end table
26035
26036 @item b @var{baud}
26037 @cindex @samp{b} packet
26038 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
26039 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
26040
26041 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
26042 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
26043 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
26044
26045 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
26046 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
26047 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
26048 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
26049 of view, nothing actually happened.}
26050
26051 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
26052 @cindex @samp{B} packet
26053 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
26054 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
26055
26056 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
26057 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
26058
26059 @item bc
26060 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
26061 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
26062 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
26063
26064 Reply:
26065 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26066
26067 @item bs
26068 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
26069 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
26070 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
26071
26072 Reply:
26073 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26074
26075 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
26076 @cindex @samp{c} packet
26077 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
26078 resume at current address.
26079
26080 Reply:
26081 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26082
26083 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
26084 @cindex @samp{C} packet
26085 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
26086 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
26087
26088 Reply:
26089 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26090
26091 @item d
26092 @cindex @samp{d} packet
26093 Toggle debug flag.
26094
26095 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
26096 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
26097
26098 @item D
26099 @itemx D;@var{pid}
26100 @cindex @samp{D} packet
26101 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
26102 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
26103 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
26104
26105 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
26106 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
26107 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
26108 big-endian hex string.
26109
26110 Reply:
26111 @table @samp
26112 @item OK
26113 for success
26114 @item E @var{NN}
26115 for an error
26116 @end table
26117
26118 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
26119 @cindex @samp{F} packet
26120 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
26121 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
26122 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
26123
26124 @item g
26125 @anchor{read registers packet}
26126 @cindex @samp{g} packet
26127 Read general registers.
26128
26129 Reply:
26130 @table @samp
26131 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26132 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
26133 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
26134 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
26135 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
26136 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
26137 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
26138 @item E @var{NN}
26139 for an error.
26140 @end table
26141
26142 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
26143 @cindex @samp{G} packet
26144 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
26145 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
26146
26147 Reply:
26148 @table @samp
26149 @item OK
26150 for success
26151 @item E @var{NN}
26152 for an error
26153 @end table
26154
26155 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
26156 @cindex @samp{H} packet
26157 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
26158 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
26159 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
26160 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
26161 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26162
26163 Reply:
26164 @table @samp
26165 @item OK
26166 for success
26167 @item E @var{NN}
26168 for an error
26169 @end table
26170
26171 @c FIXME: JTC:
26172 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
26173 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
26174 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
26175 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
26176 @c described. For example:
26177 @c
26178 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
26179 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
26180 @c otherwise returns current registers.
26181 @c
26182 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
26183 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
26184 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
26185
26186 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
26187 @anchor{cycle step packet}
26188 @cindex @samp{i} packet
26189 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
26190 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
26191 step starting at that address.
26192
26193 @item I
26194 @cindex @samp{I} packet
26195 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
26196 step packet}.
26197
26198 @item k
26199 @cindex @samp{k} packet
26200 Kill request.
26201
26202 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
26203 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
26204 thread?)}.
26205
26206 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
26207 @cindex @samp{m} packet
26208 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
26209 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
26210
26211 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
26212 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
26213 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
26214 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
26215 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
26216 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
26217 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
26218 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
26219
26220 Reply:
26221 @table @samp
26222 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26223 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
26224 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
26225 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
26226 @item E @var{NN}
26227 @var{NN} is errno
26228 @end table
26229
26230 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26231 @cindex @samp{M} packet
26232 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
26233 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
26234 hexadecimal number.
26235
26236 Reply:
26237 @table @samp
26238 @item OK
26239 for success
26240 @item E @var{NN}
26241 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
26242 written).
26243 @end table
26244
26245 @item p @var{n}
26246 @cindex @samp{p} packet
26247 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
26248 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
26249 register value is encoded.
26250
26251 Reply:
26252 @table @samp
26253 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26254 the register's value
26255 @item E @var{NN}
26256 for an error
26257 @item
26258 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
26259 @end table
26260
26261 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
26262 @anchor{write register packet}
26263 @cindex @samp{P} packet
26264 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
26265 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
26266 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
26267
26268 Reply:
26269 @table @samp
26270 @item OK
26271 for success
26272 @item E @var{NN}
26273 for an error
26274 @end table
26275
26276 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
26277 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
26278 @cindex @samp{q} packet
26279 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
26280 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
26281 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
26282
26283 @item r
26284 @cindex @samp{r} packet
26285 Reset the entire system.
26286
26287 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
26288
26289 @item R @var{XX}
26290 @cindex @samp{R} packet
26291 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
26292 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26293
26294 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
26295
26296 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
26297 @cindex @samp{s} packet
26298 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
26299 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
26300
26301 Reply:
26302 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26303
26304 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
26305 @anchor{step with signal packet}
26306 @cindex @samp{S} packet
26307 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
26308 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
26309
26310 Reply:
26311 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26312
26313 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
26314 @cindex @samp{t} packet
26315 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
26316 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
26317 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
26318
26319 @item T @var{thread-id}
26320 @cindex @samp{T} packet
26321 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
26322
26323 Reply:
26324 @table @samp
26325 @item OK
26326 thread is still alive
26327 @item E @var{NN}
26328 thread is dead
26329 @end table
26330
26331 @item v
26332 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
26333 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
26334
26335 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
26336 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
26337 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
26338 The process ID is a
26339 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
26340 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
26341 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
26342
26343 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
26344 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
26345 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
26346 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
26347 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
26348 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
26349 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
26350 @c stopping or restarting threads.
26351
26352 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26353
26354 Reply:
26355 @table @samp
26356 @item E @var{nn}
26357 for an error
26358 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26359 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26360 @item OK
26361 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
26362 @end table
26363
26364 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
26365 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
26366 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
26367 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
26368 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
26369 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
26370 in their current state in non-stop mode.
26371 Specifying multiple
26372 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
26373 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26374
26375 Currently supported actions are:
26376
26377 @table @samp
26378 @item c
26379 Continue.
26380 @item C @var{sig}
26381 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26382 @item s
26383 Step.
26384 @item S @var{sig}
26385 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26386 @item t
26387 Stop.
26388 @item T @var{sig}
26389 Stop with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26390 @end table
26391
26392 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
26393 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
26394 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
26395
26396 The @samp{t} and @samp{T} actions are only relevant in non-stop mode
26397 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
26398 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
26399 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
26400 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
26401 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
26402 as an implementation detail.
26403
26404 Reply:
26405 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26406
26407 @item vCont?
26408 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
26409 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
26410
26411 Reply:
26412 @table @samp
26413 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
26414 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
26415 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
26416 @item
26417 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
26418 @end table
26419
26420 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
26421 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
26422 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
26423 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
26424
26425 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
26426 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
26427 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
26428 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
26429 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
26430 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
26431 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
26432 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
26433 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
26434 packet is received.
26435
26436 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
26437 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
26438 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
26439 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
26440 @var{thread-id}.
26441
26442 Reply:
26443 @table @samp
26444 @item OK
26445 for success
26446 @item E @var{NN}
26447 for an error
26448 @end table
26449
26450 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26451 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
26452 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
26453 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
26454 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
26455 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
26456 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
26457 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
26458 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
26459 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
26460 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
26461 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
26462
26463
26464 Reply:
26465 @table @samp
26466 @item OK
26467 for success
26468 @item E.memtype
26469 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
26470 @item E @var{NN}
26471 for an error
26472 @end table
26473
26474 @item vFlashDone
26475 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
26476 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
26477 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
26478 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
26479 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
26480 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
26481 request is completed.
26482
26483 @item vKill;@var{pid}
26484 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
26485 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
26486 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
26487 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
26488 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26489
26490 Reply:
26491 @table @samp
26492 @item E @var{nn}
26493 for an error
26494 @item OK
26495 for success
26496 @end table
26497
26498 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
26499 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
26500 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
26501 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
26502 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
26503 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
26504 state.
26505
26506 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
26507
26508 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26509
26510 Reply:
26511 @table @samp
26512 @item E @var{nn}
26513 for an error
26514 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26515 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26516 @end table
26517
26518 @item vStopped
26519 @anchor{vStopped packet}
26520 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
26521
26522 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
26523 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
26524
26525 Reply:
26526 @table @samp
26527 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26528 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26529 @item OK
26530 if there are no unreported stop events
26531 @end table
26532
26533 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26534 @anchor{X packet}
26535 @cindex @samp{X} packet
26536 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
26537 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
26538 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
26539
26540 Reply:
26541 @table @samp
26542 @item OK
26543 for success
26544 @item E @var{NN}
26545 for an error
26546 @end table
26547
26548 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
26549 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
26550 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
26551 @cindex @samp{z} packet
26552 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
26553 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
26554 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
26555 @var{length} bytes.
26556
26557 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
26558 separately.
26559
26560 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
26561 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
26562 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
26563 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
26564 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
26565 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
26566
26567 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
26568 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
26569 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
26570 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
26571 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
26572 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
26573
26574 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
26575 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
26576 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
26577 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
26578 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
26579
26580 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
26581 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
26582 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
26583 target, is not defined.}
26584
26585 Reply:
26586 @table @samp
26587 @item OK
26588 success
26589 @item
26590 not supported
26591 @item E @var{NN}
26592 for an error
26593 @end table
26594
26595 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
26596 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
26597 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
26598 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
26599 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
26600 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
26601
26602 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
26603 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
26604
26605 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
26606 movement.}
26607
26608 Reply:
26609 @table @samp
26610 @item OK
26611 success
26612 @item
26613 not supported
26614 @item E @var{NN}
26615 for an error
26616 @end table
26617
26618 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
26619 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
26620 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
26621 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
26622 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
26623
26624 Reply:
26625 @table @samp
26626 @item OK
26627 success
26628 @item
26629 not supported
26630 @item E @var{NN}
26631 for an error
26632 @end table
26633
26634 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
26635 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
26636 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
26637 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
26638 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
26639
26640 Reply:
26641 @table @samp
26642 @item OK
26643 success
26644 @item
26645 not supported
26646 @item E @var{NN}
26647 for an error
26648 @end table
26649
26650 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
26651 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
26652 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
26653 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
26654 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
26655
26656 Reply:
26657 @table @samp
26658 @item OK
26659 success
26660 @item
26661 not supported
26662 @item E @var{NN}
26663 for an error
26664 @end table
26665
26666 @end table
26667
26668 @node Stop Reply Packets
26669 @section Stop Reply Packets
26670 @cindex stop reply packets
26671
26672 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
26673 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
26674 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
26675 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
26676 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
26677 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
26678 @value{GDBN} source code.
26679
26680 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
26681 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
26682 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
26683 components.
26684
26685 @table @samp
26686
26687 @item S @var{AA}
26688 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
26689 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
26690 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
26691
26692 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
26693 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
26694 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
26695 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
26696 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
26697 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
26698 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
26699 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
26700
26701 @itemize @bullet
26702 @item
26703 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
26704 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
26705 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
26706 two-digit hex number.
26707
26708 @item
26709 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
26710 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26711
26712 @item
26713 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
26714 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
26715 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
26716 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
26717
26718 @item
26719 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
26720 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
26721 future.
26722 @end itemize
26723
26724 The currently defined stop reasons are:
26725
26726 @table @samp
26727 @item watch
26728 @itemx rwatch
26729 @itemx awatch
26730 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
26731 hex.
26732
26733 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
26734 @item library
26735 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
26736 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
26737 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
26738
26739 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
26740 @item replaylog
26741 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
26742 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
26743 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
26744 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
26745 for more information.
26746
26747
26748 @end table
26749
26750 @item W @var{AA}
26751 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26752 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
26753 applicable to certain targets.
26754
26755 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
26756 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
26757 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26758 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26759
26760 @item X @var{AA}
26761 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26762 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
26763
26764 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
26765 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
26766 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
26767 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26768
26769 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
26770 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
26771 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
26772 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
26773 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
26774
26775 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
26776 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
26777 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
26778 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
26779 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
26780 system calls.
26781
26782 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
26783 this very system call.
26784
26785 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
26786 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
26787 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
26788 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
26789 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
26790 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
26791
26792 @end table
26793
26794 @node General Query Packets
26795 @section General Query Packets
26796 @cindex remote query requests
26797
26798 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
26799 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
26800 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
26801 sending information to and from the stub.
26802
26803 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
26804 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
26805 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
26806 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
26807 conventions:
26808
26809 @itemize @bullet
26810 @item
26811 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
26812 @item
26813 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
26814 letter.
26815 @item
26816 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
26817 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
26818 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
26819 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
26820 @end itemize
26821
26822 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
26823 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
26824 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
26825 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
26826 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
26827 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
26828 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
26829 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
26830 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
26831 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
26832 packet.}.
26833
26834 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
26835 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
26836 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
26837 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
26838 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
26839
26840 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
26841
26842 @table @samp
26843
26844 @item qC
26845 @cindex current thread, remote request
26846 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
26847 Return the current thread ID.
26848
26849 Reply:
26850 @table @samp
26851 @item QC @var{thread-id}
26852 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
26853 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26854 @item @r{(anything else)}
26855 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
26856 @end table
26857
26858 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
26859 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
26860 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
26861 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
26862 Reply:
26863 @table @samp
26864 @item E @var{NN}
26865 An error (such as memory fault)
26866 @item C @var{crc32}
26867 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
26868 @end table
26869
26870 @item qfThreadInfo
26871 @itemx qsThreadInfo
26872 @cindex list active threads, remote request
26873 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
26874 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
26875 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
26876 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
26877 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
26878 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
26879 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
26880 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
26881
26882 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
26883
26884 Reply:
26885 @table @samp
26886 @item m @var{thread-id}
26887 A single thread ID
26888 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
26889 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
26890 @item l
26891 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
26892 @end table
26893
26894 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
26895 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
26896 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
26897 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
26898 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
26899 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
26900 fields.
26901
26902 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
26903 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
26904 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
26905 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
26906 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
26907
26908 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
26909 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
26910
26911 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
26912 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
26913 information associated with the variable.)
26914
26915 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
26916 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
26917 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
26918 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
26919 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
26920 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
26921
26922 Reply:
26923 @table @samp
26924 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
26925 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
26926 local storage requested.
26927
26928 @item E @var{nn}
26929 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26930
26931 @item
26932 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
26933 @end table
26934
26935 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
26936 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
26937 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
26938 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
26939 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
26940 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
26941 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
26942
26943 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
26944
26945 Reply:
26946 @table @samp
26947 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
26948 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
26949 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
26950 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
26951 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
26952 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
26953 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
26954 @end table
26955
26956 @item qOffsets
26957 @cindex section offsets, remote request
26958 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
26959 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
26960 image.
26961
26962 Reply:
26963 @table @samp
26964 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
26965 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
26966 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
26967 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
26968 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
26969 segments by the supplied offsets.
26970
26971 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
26972 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
26973 to the @code{Bss} section.}
26974
26975 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
26976 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
26977 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
26978 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
26979 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
26980 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
26981 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
26982 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
26983 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
26984 @end table
26985
26986 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
26987 @cindex thread information, remote request
26988 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
26989 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
26990 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
26991 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
26992
26993 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
26994 (see below).
26995
26996 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
26997
26998 @item QNonStop:1
26999 @item QNonStop:0
27000 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
27001 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
27002 @anchor{QNonStop}
27003 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
27004 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
27005
27006 Reply:
27007 @table @samp
27008 @item OK
27009 The request succeeded.
27010
27011 @item E @var{nn}
27012 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
27013
27014 @item
27015 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
27016 the stub.
27017 @end table
27018
27019 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27020 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27021 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
27022 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
27023
27024 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
27025 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
27026 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
27027 @anchor{QPassSignals}
27028 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
27029 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
27030 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
27031 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
27032 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
27033 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
27034 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
27035 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
27036 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
27037
27038 Reply:
27039 @table @samp
27040 @item OK
27041 The request succeeded.
27042
27043 @item E @var{nn}
27044 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
27045
27046 @item
27047 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
27048 the stub.
27049 @end table
27050
27051 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
27052 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
27053 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27054 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27055
27056 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
27057 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
27058 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
27059 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
27060 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
27061 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
27062 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
27063 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
27064 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
27065
27066 Reply:
27067 @table @samp
27068 @item OK
27069 A command response with no output.
27070 @item @var{OUTPUT}
27071 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
27072 @item E @var{NN}
27073 Indicate a badly formed request.
27074 @item
27075 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
27076 @end table
27077
27078 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
27079 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
27080 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
27081 packets.)
27082
27083 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
27084 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
27085 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
27086 @anchor{qSearch memory}
27087 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
27088 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
27089 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
27090
27091 Reply:
27092 @table @samp
27093 @item 0
27094 The pattern was not found.
27095 @item 1,address
27096 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
27097 @item E @var{NN}
27098 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
27099 @item
27100 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
27101 @end table
27102
27103 @item QStartNoAckMode
27104 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
27105 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
27106 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
27107 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
27108
27109 Reply:
27110 @table @samp
27111 @item OK
27112 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
27113 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
27114 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
27115 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
27116 @item
27117 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
27118 @end table
27119
27120 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
27121 @cindex supported packets, remote query
27122 @cindex features of the remote protocol
27123 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
27124 @anchor{qSupported}
27125 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
27126 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
27127 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
27128 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
27129 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
27130 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
27131 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
27132 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
27133 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
27134 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
27135 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
27136 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
27137 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
27138 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
27139
27140 Reply:
27141 @table @samp
27142 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
27143 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
27144 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
27145 possible forms).
27146 @item
27147 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
27148 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
27149 @end table
27150
27151 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
27152 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
27153 are:
27154
27155 @table @samp
27156 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
27157 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
27158 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
27159 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
27160 @item @var{name}+
27161 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
27162 need an associated value.
27163 @item @var{name}-
27164 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
27165 @item @var{name}?
27166 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
27167 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
27168 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
27169 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
27170 @end table
27171
27172 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
27173 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
27174 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
27175 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
27176 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
27177
27178 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
27179 are defined:
27180
27181 @table @samp
27182 @item multiprocess
27183 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
27184 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
27185 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
27186 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
27187 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
27188 @end table
27189
27190 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
27191 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
27192 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
27193 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
27194 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
27195 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
27196 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
27197 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
27198 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
27199 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
27200 all the features it supports.
27201
27202 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
27203 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
27204
27205 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
27206 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
27207 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
27208 form response.
27209
27210 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
27211 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
27212 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
27213 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
27214
27215 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
27216 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
27217 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
27218 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
27219 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
27220
27221 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
27222
27223 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
27224 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
27225 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
27226 @item Feature Name
27227 @tab Value Required
27228 @tab Default
27229 @tab Probe Allowed
27230
27231 @item @samp{PacketSize}
27232 @tab Yes
27233 @tab @samp{-}
27234 @tab No
27235
27236 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
27237 @tab No
27238 @tab @samp{-}
27239 @tab Yes
27240
27241 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
27242 @tab No
27243 @tab @samp{-}
27244 @tab Yes
27245
27246 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
27247 @tab No
27248 @tab @samp{-}
27249 @tab Yes
27250
27251 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
27252 @tab No
27253 @tab @samp{-}
27254 @tab Yes
27255
27256 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
27257 @tab No
27258 @tab @samp{-}
27259 @tab Yes
27260
27261 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
27262 @tab No
27263 @tab @samp{-}
27264 @tab Yes
27265
27266 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
27267 @tab No
27268 @tab @samp{-}
27269 @tab Yes
27270
27271 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
27272 @tab No
27273 @tab @samp{-}
27274 @tab Yes
27275
27276 @item @samp{QNonStop}
27277 @tab No
27278 @tab @samp{-}
27279 @tab Yes
27280
27281 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
27282 @tab No
27283 @tab @samp{-}
27284 @tab Yes
27285
27286 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
27287 @tab No
27288 @tab @samp{-}
27289 @tab Yes
27290
27291 @item @samp{multiprocess}
27292 @tab No
27293 @tab @samp{-}
27294 @tab No
27295
27296 @end multitable
27297
27298 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
27299
27300 @table @samp
27301 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
27302 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
27303 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
27304 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
27305 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
27306 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
27307 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
27308 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
27309 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
27310 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
27311
27312 @item qXfer:auxv:read
27313 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
27314 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
27315
27316 @item qXfer:features:read
27317 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
27318 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
27319
27320 @item qXfer:libraries:read
27321 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
27322 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
27323
27324 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
27325 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
27326 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
27327
27328 @item qXfer:spu:read
27329 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
27330 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
27331
27332 @item qXfer:spu:write
27333 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
27334 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
27335
27336 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
27337 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
27338 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
27339
27340 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
27341 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
27342 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
27343
27344 @item QNonStop
27345 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
27346 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
27347
27348 @item QPassSignals
27349 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
27350 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
27351
27352 @item QStartNoAckMode
27353 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
27354 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
27355
27356 @item multiprocess
27357 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
27358 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
27359 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
27360 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
27361 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
27362 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
27363 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
27364 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
27365 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
27366 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
27367 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
27368
27369 @item qXfer:osdata:read
27370 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
27371 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
27372
27373 @end table
27374
27375 @item qSymbol::
27376 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
27377 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
27378 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
27379 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
27380
27381 Reply:
27382 @table @samp
27383 @item OK
27384 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
27385 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
27386 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
27387 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
27388 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
27389 below.
27390 @end table
27391
27392 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
27393 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
27394
27395 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
27396 target has previously requested.
27397
27398 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
27399 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
27400 will be empty.
27401
27402 Reply:
27403 @table @samp
27404 @item OK
27405 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
27406 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
27407 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
27408 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
27409 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
27410 @end table
27411
27412 @item QTDP
27413 @itemx QTFrame
27414 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
27415
27416 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
27417 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
27418 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
27419 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
27420 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
27421 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
27422 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
27423 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
27424 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
27425 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
27426 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
27427
27428 Reply:
27429 @table @samp
27430 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
27431 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
27432 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
27433 the thread's attributes.
27434 @end table
27435
27436 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
27437 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
27438 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
27439 packets.)
27440
27441 @item QTStart
27442 @itemx QTStop
27443 @itemx QTinit
27444 @itemx QTro
27445 @itemx qTStatus
27446 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
27447
27448 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27449 @cindex read special object, remote request
27450 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
27451 @anchor{qXfer read}
27452 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
27453 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
27454 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
27455 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
27456 additional details about what data to access.
27457
27458 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
27459 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
27460 formats, listed below.
27461
27462 @table @samp
27463 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27464 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
27465 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
27466 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
27467
27468 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27469 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27470
27471 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27472 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
27473 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
27474 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
27475 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
27476
27477 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27478 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27479
27480 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27481 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
27482 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
27483 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
27484 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27485
27486 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
27487 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
27488 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
27489
27490 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27491 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27492
27493 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27494 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
27495 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
27496 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
27497 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27498
27499 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27500 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27501
27502 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27503 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
27504 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
27505 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
27506 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27507
27508 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27509 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27510 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27511
27512 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27513 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
27514 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
27515 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
27516 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
27517 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
27518 in that context to be accessed.
27519
27520 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27521 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27522 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27523
27524 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27525 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
27526 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
27527 @xref{Operating System Information}.
27528
27529 @end table
27530
27531 Reply:
27532 @table @samp
27533 @item m @var{data}
27534 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
27535 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
27536 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
27537 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
27538 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
27539 request.
27540
27541 @item l @var{data}
27542 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
27543 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
27544 than the @var{length} in the request.
27545
27546 @item l
27547 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
27548 There is no more data to be read.
27549
27550 @item E00
27551 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
27552
27553 @item E @var{nn}
27554 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
27555 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
27556
27557 @item
27558 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
27559 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
27560 @end table
27561
27562 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27563 @cindex write data into object, remote request
27564 @anchor{qXfer write}
27565 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
27566 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
27567 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
27568 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
27569 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
27570 to access.
27571
27572 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
27573 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
27574 formats, listed below.
27575
27576 @table @samp
27577 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27578 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
27579 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
27580 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
27581 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
27582
27583 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27584 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27585 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27586
27587 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27588 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
27589 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
27590 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
27591 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
27592 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
27593 in that context to be accessed.
27594
27595 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27596 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27597 @end table
27598
27599 Reply:
27600 @table @samp
27601 @item @var{nn}
27602 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
27603 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
27604
27605 @item E00
27606 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
27607
27608 @item E @var{nn}
27609 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
27610 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
27611
27612 @item
27613 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
27614 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
27615 @end table
27616
27617 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
27618 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
27619 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
27620 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
27621 must respond with an empty packet.
27622
27623 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
27624 @cindex query attached, remote request
27625 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
27626 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
27627 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
27628 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
27629 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
27630 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
27631 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
27632
27633 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
27634 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
27635 the @code{quit} command.
27636
27637 Reply:
27638 @table @samp
27639 @item 1
27640 The remote server attached to an existing process.
27641 @item 0
27642 The remote server created a new process.
27643 @item E @var{NN}
27644 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
27645 @end table
27646
27647 @end table
27648
27649 @node Register Packet Format
27650 @section Register Packet Format
27651
27652 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
27653 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
27654 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
27655 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
27656 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
27657 most-significant - least-significant.
27658
27659 @table @r
27660
27661 @item MIPS32
27662
27663 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
27664 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
27665 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
27666
27667 @item MIPS64
27668
27669 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
27670 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
27671 as @code{MIPS32}.
27672
27673 @end table
27674
27675 @node Tracepoint Packets
27676 @section Tracepoint Packets
27677 @cindex tracepoint packets
27678 @cindex packets, tracepoint
27679
27680 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
27681 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
27682
27683 @table @samp
27684
27685 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
27686 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
27687 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
27688 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
27689 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
27690 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
27691 tracepoint's actions.
27692
27693 Replies:
27694 @table @samp
27695 @item OK
27696 The packet was understood and carried out.
27697 @item
27698 The packet was not recognized.
27699 @end table
27700
27701 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
27702 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
27703 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
27704 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
27705 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
27706 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
27707 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
27708
27709 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
27710 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
27711 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
27712 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
27713 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
27714 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
27715 tracepoint actions.
27716
27717 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
27718 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
27719 following forms:
27720
27721 @table @samp
27722
27723 @item R @var{mask}
27724 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
27725 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
27726 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
27727 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
27728 not fit in a 32-bit word.
27729
27730 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
27731 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
27732 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
27733 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
27734 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
27735 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
27736 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
27737
27738 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
27739 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
27740 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
27741 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
27742 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
27743 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
27744 packet).
27745
27746 @end table
27747
27748 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
27749 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
27750 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
27751 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
27752 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
27753 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
27754 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
27755 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
27756
27757 Replies:
27758 @table @samp
27759 @item OK
27760 The packet was understood and carried out.
27761 @item
27762 The packet was not recognized.
27763 @end table
27764
27765 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
27766 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
27767 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
27768 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
27769
27770 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
27771 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
27772 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
27773 one of the following forms:
27774
27775 @table @samp
27776 @item F @var{f}
27777 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
27778 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
27779 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
27780
27781 @item T @var{t}
27782 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
27783 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
27784
27785 @end table
27786
27787 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
27788 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27789 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
27790 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
27791
27792 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
27793 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27794 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
27795 is a hexadecimal number.
27796
27797 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
27798 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27799 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
27800 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
27801 numbers.
27802
27803 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
27804 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
27805 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
27806
27807 @item QTStart
27808 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
27809 hits in the trace frame buffer.
27810
27811 @item QTStop
27812 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
27813
27814 @item QTinit
27815 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
27816
27817 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
27818 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
27819 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
27820 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
27821
27822 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
27823 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
27824 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
27825 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
27826
27827 @item qTStatus
27828 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
27829
27830 Replies:
27831 @table @samp
27832 @item T0
27833 There is no trace experiment running.
27834 @item T1
27835 There is a trace experiment running.
27836 @end table
27837
27838 @end table
27839
27840
27841 @node Host I/O Packets
27842 @section Host I/O Packets
27843 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
27844 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
27845
27846 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
27847 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
27848 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
27849 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
27850 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
27851 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
27852 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
27853 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
27854 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
27855 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
27856
27857 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
27858 its arguments. They have this format:
27859
27860 @table @samp
27861
27862 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
27863 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
27864 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
27865 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
27866 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
27867 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
27868 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
27869 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
27870 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
27871
27872 @end table
27873
27874 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
27875
27876 @table @samp
27877
27878 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
27879 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
27880 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
27881 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
27882 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
27883 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
27884 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
27885 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
27886 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
27887 @var{attachment}.
27888
27889 @item
27890 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
27891
27892 @end table
27893
27894 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
27895
27896 @table @samp
27897 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
27898 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
27899 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
27900 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
27901 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
27902 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
27903 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
27904
27905 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
27906 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
27907 -1 if an error occurs.
27908
27909 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
27910 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
27911 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
27912 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
27913 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
27914 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
27915 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
27916 @var{count} was zero.
27917
27918 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
27919 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
27920 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
27921 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
27922 some characters were escaped.
27923
27924 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
27925 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
27926 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
27927 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
27928 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
27929 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
27930 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
27931 error occurred.
27932
27933 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
27934 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
27935 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
27936
27937 @end table
27938
27939 @node Interrupts
27940 @section Interrupts
27941 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
27942
27943 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
27944 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
27945 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
27946 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
27947
27948 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
27949 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
27950 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
27951 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
27952 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
27953
27954 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
27955 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
27956 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
27957 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
27958 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
27959 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
27960 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
27961 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
27962
27963 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
27964 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
27965 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
27966 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
27967 currently-executing threads and processes.
27968 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
27969 running program, it should send one of the stop
27970 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
27971 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
27972 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
27973 Interrupts received while the
27974 program is stopped are discarded.
27975
27976 @node Notification Packets
27977 @section Notification Packets
27978 @cindex notification packets
27979 @cindex packets, notification
27980
27981 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
27982 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
27983 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
27984 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
27985 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
27986 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
27987 is not a problem.
27988
27989 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
27990 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
27991 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
27992 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
27993 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
27994 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
27995 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
27996
27997 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
27998 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
27999
28000 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
28001 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
28002 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
28003 not they understand it.
28004
28005 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
28006 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
28007 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
28008 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
28009 recipients.
28010
28011 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
28012 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
28013 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
28014 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
28015 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
28016
28017 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
28018 defined:
28019
28020 @table @samp
28021 @item Stop: @var{reply}
28022 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
28023 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
28024 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
28025 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
28026 @value{GDBN}.
28027 @end table
28028
28029 @node Remote Non-Stop
28030 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
28031
28032 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
28033 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
28034 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
28035 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28036
28037 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
28038 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
28039 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
28040 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
28041 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
28042 probe the target state after a mode change.
28043
28044 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
28045 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
28046 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
28047 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
28048 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
28049 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
28050 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
28051 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
28052 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
28053 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
28054 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
28055
28056 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
28057 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
28058 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
28059 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
28060 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
28061 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
28062 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
28063 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
28064 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
28065 sending any queued stop events.
28066
28067 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
28068 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
28069 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
28070 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
28071 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
28072 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
28073 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
28074
28075 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
28076 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
28077 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
28078 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
28079 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
28080 process normally.
28081
28082 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
28083 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
28084 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
28085 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
28086 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
28087 should process normally.
28088
28089 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
28090 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
28091 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
28092 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
28093 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
28094
28095 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
28096 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
28097 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
28098 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
28099 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
28100 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
28101 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
28102 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
28103 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
28104 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
28105 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
28106 @samp{OK}.
28107
28108 @node Packet Acknowledgment
28109 @section Packet Acknowledgment
28110
28111 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
28112 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
28113 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
28114 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
28115 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
28116 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
28117 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
28118
28119 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
28120 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
28121 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
28122 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
28123 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
28124
28125 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
28126 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
28127 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
28128 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
28129
28130 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
28131 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
28132 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
28133 @pxref{qSupported}.
28134 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
28135 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
28136 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
28137 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
28138 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
28139 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
28140 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
28141
28142 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
28143 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
28144 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
28145 connection.
28146 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
28147 new connection is established,
28148 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
28149 for the current connection, once disabled.
28150
28151 @node Examples
28152 @section Examples
28153
28154 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
28155 does not get any direct output:
28156
28157 @smallexample
28158 -> @code{R00}
28159 <- @code{+}
28160 @emph{target restarts}
28161 -> @code{?}
28162 <- @code{+}
28163 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
28164 -> @code{+}
28165 @end smallexample
28166
28167 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
28168
28169 @smallexample
28170 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
28171 <- @code{+}
28172 -> @code{s}
28173 <- @code{+}
28174 @emph{time passes}
28175 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
28176 -> @code{+}
28177 -> @code{g}
28178 <- @code{+}
28179 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
28180 -> @code{+}
28181 @end smallexample
28182
28183 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
28184 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
28185 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
28186
28187 @menu
28188 * File-I/O Overview::
28189 * Protocol Basics::
28190 * The F Request Packet::
28191 * The F Reply Packet::
28192 * The Ctrl-C Message::
28193 * Console I/O::
28194 * List of Supported Calls::
28195 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
28196 * Constants::
28197 * File-I/O Examples::
28198 @end menu
28199
28200 @node File-I/O Overview
28201 @subsection File-I/O Overview
28202 @cindex file-i/o overview
28203
28204 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
28205 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
28206 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
28207 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
28208 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
28209 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
28210
28211 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
28212 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
28213 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
28214 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
28215 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
28216
28217 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
28218 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
28219 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
28220 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
28221 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
28222 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
28223 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
28224
28225 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
28226 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
28227 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
28228 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
28229 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
28230
28231 @smallexample
28232 (@value{GDBP}) continue
28233 <- target requests 'system call X'
28234 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
28235 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
28236 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
28237 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
28238 @end smallexample
28239
28240 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
28241 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
28242 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
28243 system are not supported by this protocol.
28244
28245 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
28246
28247 @node Protocol Basics
28248 @subsection Protocol Basics
28249 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
28250
28251 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
28252 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
28253 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
28254 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
28255 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
28256 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
28257 to call the appropriate host system call:
28258
28259 @itemize @bullet
28260 @item
28261 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
28262
28263 @item
28264 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
28265 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
28266 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
28267 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
28268
28269 @end itemize
28270
28271 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
28272
28273 @itemize @bullet
28274 @item
28275 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
28276 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
28277 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
28278 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
28279 packet.
28280
28281 @item
28282 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
28283 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
28284
28285 @item
28286 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
28287
28288 @item
28289 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
28290
28291 @item
28292 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
28293 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
28294 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
28295 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
28296 packet.
28297
28298 @end itemize
28299
28300 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
28301 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
28302
28303 @itemize @bullet
28304 @item
28305 Return value.
28306
28307 @item
28308 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
28309
28310 @item
28311 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
28312
28313 @end itemize
28314
28315 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
28316 the latest continue or step action.
28317
28318 @node The F Request Packet
28319 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
28320 @cindex file-i/o request packet
28321 @cindex @code{F} request packet
28322
28323 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
28324
28325 @table @samp
28326 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
28327
28328 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
28329 This is just the name of the function.
28330
28331 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
28332 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
28333 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
28334 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
28335 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
28336 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
28337 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
28338
28339 @end table
28340
28341
28342
28343 @node The F Reply Packet
28344 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
28345 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
28346 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
28347
28348 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
28349
28350 @table @samp
28351
28352 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
28353
28354 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
28355
28356 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
28357 representation.
28358 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
28359
28360 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
28361 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
28362 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
28363
28364 @smallexample
28365 F0,0,C
28366 @end smallexample
28367
28368 @noindent
28369 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
28370
28371 @smallexample
28372 F-1,4,C
28373 @end smallexample
28374
28375 @noindent
28376 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
28377
28378 @end table
28379
28380
28381 @node The Ctrl-C Message
28382 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
28383 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
28384
28385 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
28386 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
28387 the target should behave as if it had
28388 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
28389 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
28390 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
28391 packet.
28392
28393 It's important for the target to know in which
28394 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
28395
28396 @itemize @bullet
28397 @item
28398 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
28399
28400 @item
28401 The system call on the host has been finished.
28402
28403 @end itemize
28404
28405 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
28406 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
28407 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
28408 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
28409 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
28410 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
28411
28412 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
28413 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
28414 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
28415 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
28416 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
28417 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
28418 or the full action has been completed.
28419
28420 @node Console I/O
28421 @subsection Console I/O
28422 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
28423
28424 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
28425 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
28426 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
28427 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
28428 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
28429 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
28430 conditions is met:
28431
28432 @itemize @bullet
28433 @item
28434 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
28435 @code{read}
28436 system call is treated as finished.
28437
28438 @item
28439 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
28440 newline.
28441
28442 @item
28443 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
28444 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
28445
28446 @end itemize
28447
28448 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
28449 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
28450 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
28451 is stopped at the user's request.
28452
28453
28454 @node List of Supported Calls
28455 @subsection List of Supported Calls
28456 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
28457
28458 @menu
28459 * open::
28460 * close::
28461 * read::
28462 * write::
28463 * lseek::
28464 * rename::
28465 * unlink::
28466 * stat/fstat::
28467 * gettimeofday::
28468 * isatty::
28469 * system::
28470 @end menu
28471
28472 @node open
28473 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
28474 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
28475
28476 @table @asis
28477 @item Synopsis:
28478 @smallexample
28479 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
28480 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
28481 @end smallexample
28482
28483 @item Request:
28484 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
28485
28486 @noindent
28487 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
28488
28489 @table @code
28490 @item O_CREAT
28491 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
28492 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
28493 are concerned.
28494
28495 @item O_EXCL
28496 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
28497 an error and open() fails.
28498
28499 @item O_TRUNC
28500 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
28501 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
28502 truncated to zero length.
28503
28504 @item O_APPEND
28505 The file is opened in append mode.
28506
28507 @item O_RDONLY
28508 The file is opened for reading only.
28509
28510 @item O_WRONLY
28511 The file is opened for writing only.
28512
28513 @item O_RDWR
28514 The file is opened for reading and writing.
28515 @end table
28516
28517 @noindent
28518 Other bits are silently ignored.
28519
28520
28521 @noindent
28522 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
28523
28524 @table @code
28525 @item S_IRUSR
28526 User has read permission.
28527
28528 @item S_IWUSR
28529 User has write permission.
28530
28531 @item S_IRGRP
28532 Group has read permission.
28533
28534 @item S_IWGRP
28535 Group has write permission.
28536
28537 @item S_IROTH
28538 Others have read permission.
28539
28540 @item S_IWOTH
28541 Others have write permission.
28542 @end table
28543
28544 @noindent
28545 Other bits are silently ignored.
28546
28547
28548 @item Return value:
28549 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
28550 occurred.
28551
28552 @item Errors:
28553
28554 @table @code
28555 @item EEXIST
28556 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
28557
28558 @item EISDIR
28559 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
28560
28561 @item EACCES
28562 The requested access is not allowed.
28563
28564 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28565 @var{pathname} was too long.
28566
28567 @item ENOENT
28568 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
28569
28570 @item ENODEV
28571 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
28572
28573 @item EROFS
28574 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
28575 write access was requested.
28576
28577 @item EFAULT
28578 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
28579
28580 @item ENOSPC
28581 No space on device to create the file.
28582
28583 @item EMFILE
28584 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
28585
28586 @item ENFILE
28587 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
28588 has been reached.
28589
28590 @item EINTR
28591 The call was interrupted by the user.
28592 @end table
28593
28594 @end table
28595
28596 @node close
28597 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
28598 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
28599
28600 @table @asis
28601 @item Synopsis:
28602 @smallexample
28603 int close(int fd);
28604 @end smallexample
28605
28606 @item Request:
28607 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
28608
28609 @item Return value:
28610 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
28611
28612 @item Errors:
28613
28614 @table @code
28615 @item EBADF
28616 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
28617
28618 @item EINTR
28619 The call was interrupted by the user.
28620 @end table
28621
28622 @end table
28623
28624 @node read
28625 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
28626 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
28627
28628 @table @asis
28629 @item Synopsis:
28630 @smallexample
28631 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
28632 @end smallexample
28633
28634 @item Request:
28635 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
28636
28637 @item Return value:
28638 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
28639 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
28640 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
28641
28642 @item Errors:
28643
28644 @table @code
28645 @item EBADF
28646 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
28647 reading.
28648
28649 @item EFAULT
28650 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28651
28652 @item EINTR
28653 The call was interrupted by the user.
28654 @end table
28655
28656 @end table
28657
28658 @node write
28659 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
28660 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
28661
28662 @table @asis
28663 @item Synopsis:
28664 @smallexample
28665 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
28666 @end smallexample
28667
28668 @item Request:
28669 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
28670
28671 @item Return value:
28672 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
28673 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
28674 is returned.
28675
28676 @item Errors:
28677
28678 @table @code
28679 @item EBADF
28680 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
28681 writing.
28682
28683 @item EFAULT
28684 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28685
28686 @item EFBIG
28687 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
28688 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
28689
28690 @item ENOSPC
28691 No space on device to write the data.
28692
28693 @item EINTR
28694 The call was interrupted by the user.
28695 @end table
28696
28697 @end table
28698
28699 @node lseek
28700 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
28701 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
28702
28703 @table @asis
28704 @item Synopsis:
28705 @smallexample
28706 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
28707 @end smallexample
28708
28709 @item Request:
28710 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
28711
28712 @var{flag} is one of:
28713
28714 @table @code
28715 @item SEEK_SET
28716 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
28717
28718 @item SEEK_CUR
28719 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
28720 bytes.
28721
28722 @item SEEK_END
28723 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
28724 bytes.
28725 @end table
28726
28727 @item Return value:
28728 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
28729 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
28730 value of -1 is returned.
28731
28732 @item Errors:
28733
28734 @table @code
28735 @item EBADF
28736 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
28737
28738 @item ESPIPE
28739 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
28740
28741 @item EINVAL
28742 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
28743
28744 @item EINTR
28745 The call was interrupted by the user.
28746 @end table
28747
28748 @end table
28749
28750 @node rename
28751 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
28752 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
28753
28754 @table @asis
28755 @item Synopsis:
28756 @smallexample
28757 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
28758 @end smallexample
28759
28760 @item Request:
28761 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
28762
28763 @item Return value:
28764 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28765
28766 @item Errors:
28767
28768 @table @code
28769 @item EISDIR
28770 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
28771 directory.
28772
28773 @item EEXIST
28774 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
28775
28776 @item EBUSY
28777 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
28778 process.
28779
28780 @item EINVAL
28781 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
28782 of itself.
28783
28784 @item ENOTDIR
28785 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
28786 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
28787 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
28788
28789 @item EFAULT
28790 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
28791
28792 @item EACCES
28793 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28794
28795 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28796
28797 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
28798
28799 @item ENOENT
28800 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
28801
28802 @item EROFS
28803 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
28804
28805 @item ENOSPC
28806 The device containing the file has no room for the new
28807 directory entry.
28808
28809 @item EINTR
28810 The call was interrupted by the user.
28811 @end table
28812
28813 @end table
28814
28815 @node unlink
28816 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
28817 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
28818
28819 @table @asis
28820 @item Synopsis:
28821 @smallexample
28822 int unlink(const char *pathname);
28823 @end smallexample
28824
28825 @item Request:
28826 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
28827
28828 @item Return value:
28829 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28830
28831 @item Errors:
28832
28833 @table @code
28834 @item EACCES
28835 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28836
28837 @item EPERM
28838 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
28839
28840 @item EBUSY
28841 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
28842 being used by another process.
28843
28844 @item EFAULT
28845 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28846
28847 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28848 @var{pathname} was too long.
28849
28850 @item ENOENT
28851 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
28852
28853 @item ENOTDIR
28854 A component of the path is not a directory.
28855
28856 @item EROFS
28857 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
28858
28859 @item EINTR
28860 The call was interrupted by the user.
28861 @end table
28862
28863 @end table
28864
28865 @node stat/fstat
28866 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
28867 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
28868 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
28869
28870 @table @asis
28871 @item Synopsis:
28872 @smallexample
28873 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
28874 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
28875 @end smallexample
28876
28877 @item Request:
28878 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
28879 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
28880
28881 @item Return value:
28882 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28883
28884 @item Errors:
28885
28886 @table @code
28887 @item EBADF
28888 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
28889
28890 @item ENOENT
28891 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
28892 path is an empty string.
28893
28894 @item ENOTDIR
28895 A component of the path is not a directory.
28896
28897 @item EFAULT
28898 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28899
28900 @item EACCES
28901 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28902
28903 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28904 @var{pathname} was too long.
28905
28906 @item EINTR
28907 The call was interrupted by the user.
28908 @end table
28909
28910 @end table
28911
28912 @node gettimeofday
28913 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
28914 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
28915
28916 @table @asis
28917 @item Synopsis:
28918 @smallexample
28919 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
28920 @end smallexample
28921
28922 @item Request:
28923 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
28924
28925 @item Return value:
28926 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
28927
28928 @item Errors:
28929
28930 @table @code
28931 @item EINVAL
28932 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
28933
28934 @item EFAULT
28935 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28936 @end table
28937
28938 @end table
28939
28940 @node isatty
28941 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
28942 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
28943
28944 @table @asis
28945 @item Synopsis:
28946 @smallexample
28947 int isatty(int fd);
28948 @end smallexample
28949
28950 @item Request:
28951 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
28952
28953 @item Return value:
28954 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
28955
28956 @item Errors:
28957
28958 @table @code
28959 @item EINTR
28960 The call was interrupted by the user.
28961 @end table
28962
28963 @end table
28964
28965 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
28966 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
28967 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
28968 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
28969 needed.
28970
28971
28972 @node system
28973 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
28974 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
28975
28976 @table @asis
28977 @item Synopsis:
28978 @smallexample
28979 int system(const char *command);
28980 @end smallexample
28981
28982 @item Request:
28983 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
28984
28985 @item Return value:
28986 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
28987 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
28988 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
28989 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
28990 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
28991 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
28992 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
28993
28994 @item Errors:
28995
28996 @table @code
28997 @item EINTR
28998 The call was interrupted by the user.
28999 @end table
29000
29001 @end table
29002
29003 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
29004 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
29005 the host is simplified before it's returned
29006 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
29007 is discarded, and the return value consists
29008 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
29009
29010 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
29011 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
29012 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
29013
29014 @table @code
29015 @item set remote system-call-allowed
29016 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
29017 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
29018 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
29019
29020 @item show remote system-call-allowed
29021 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
29022 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
29023 protocol.
29024 @end table
29025
29026 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
29027 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
29028 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
29029
29030 @menu
29031 * Integral Datatypes::
29032 * Pointer Values::
29033 * Memory Transfer::
29034 * struct stat::
29035 * struct timeval::
29036 @end menu
29037
29038 @node Integral Datatypes
29039 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
29040 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
29041
29042 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
29043 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
29044 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
29045
29046 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
29047 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
29048
29049 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
29050
29051 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
29052 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
29053
29054 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
29055
29056 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
29057 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
29058 byte order.
29059
29060 @node Pointer Values
29061 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
29062 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
29063
29064 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
29065 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
29066 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
29067 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
29068
29069 @smallexample
29070 @code{1aaf/12}
29071 @end smallexample
29072
29073 @noindent
29074 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
29075 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
29076 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
29077 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
29078
29079 @smallexample
29080 @code{123456/d}
29081 @end smallexample
29082
29083 @node Memory Transfer
29084 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
29085 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
29086
29087 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
29088 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
29089 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
29090 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
29091 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
29092 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
29093 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
29094
29095
29096 @node struct stat
29097 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
29098 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
29099
29100 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
29101 is defined as follows:
29102
29103 @smallexample
29104 struct stat @{
29105 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
29106 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
29107 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
29108 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
29109 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
29110 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
29111 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
29112 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
29113 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
29114 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
29115 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
29116 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
29117 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
29118 @};
29119 @end smallexample
29120
29121 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
29122 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
29123 structure is of size 64 bytes.
29124
29125 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
29126 range of values.
29127
29128 @table @code
29129
29130 @item st_dev
29131 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
29132
29133 @item st_ino
29134 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
29135
29136 @item st_mode
29137 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
29138 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
29139
29140 @item st_uid
29141 @itemx st_gid
29142 @itemx st_rdev
29143 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
29144
29145 @item st_atime
29146 @itemx st_mtime
29147 @itemx st_ctime
29148 These values have a host and file system dependent
29149 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
29150 support exact timing values.
29151 @end table
29152
29153 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
29154 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
29155 continuing.
29156
29157 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
29158 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
29159 get truncated on the target.
29160
29161 @node struct timeval
29162 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
29163 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
29164
29165 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
29166 is defined as follows:
29167
29168 @smallexample
29169 struct timeval @{
29170 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
29171 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
29172 @};
29173 @end smallexample
29174
29175 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
29176 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
29177 structure is of size 8 bytes.
29178
29179 @node Constants
29180 @subsection Constants
29181 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
29182
29183 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
29184 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
29185 values before and after the call as needed.
29186
29187 @menu
29188 * Open Flags::
29189 * mode_t Values::
29190 * Errno Values::
29191 * Lseek Flags::
29192 * Limits::
29193 @end menu
29194
29195 @node Open Flags
29196 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
29197 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
29198
29199 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
29200
29201 @smallexample
29202 O_RDONLY 0x0
29203 O_WRONLY 0x1
29204 O_RDWR 0x2
29205 O_APPEND 0x8
29206 O_CREAT 0x200
29207 O_TRUNC 0x400
29208 O_EXCL 0x800
29209 @end smallexample
29210
29211 @node mode_t Values
29212 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
29213 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
29214
29215 All values are given in octal representation.
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 S_IFREG 0100000
29219 S_IFDIR 040000
29220 S_IRUSR 0400
29221 S_IWUSR 0200
29222 S_IXUSR 0100
29223 S_IRGRP 040
29224 S_IWGRP 020
29225 S_IXGRP 010
29226 S_IROTH 04
29227 S_IWOTH 02
29228 S_IXOTH 01
29229 @end smallexample
29230
29231 @node Errno Values
29232 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
29233 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
29234
29235 All values are given in decimal representation.
29236
29237 @smallexample
29238 EPERM 1
29239 ENOENT 2
29240 EINTR 4
29241 EBADF 9
29242 EACCES 13
29243 EFAULT 14
29244 EBUSY 16
29245 EEXIST 17
29246 ENODEV 19
29247 ENOTDIR 20
29248 EISDIR 21
29249 EINVAL 22
29250 ENFILE 23
29251 EMFILE 24
29252 EFBIG 27
29253 ENOSPC 28
29254 ESPIPE 29
29255 EROFS 30
29256 ENAMETOOLONG 91
29257 EUNKNOWN 9999
29258 @end smallexample
29259
29260 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
29261 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
29262
29263 @node Lseek Flags
29264 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
29265 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
29266
29267 @smallexample
29268 SEEK_SET 0
29269 SEEK_CUR 1
29270 SEEK_END 2
29271 @end smallexample
29272
29273 @node Limits
29274 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
29275 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
29276
29277 All values are given in decimal representation.
29278
29279 @smallexample
29280 INT_MIN -2147483648
29281 INT_MAX 2147483647
29282 UINT_MAX 4294967295
29283 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
29284 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
29285 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
29286 @end smallexample
29287
29288 @node File-I/O Examples
29289 @subsection File-I/O Examples
29290 @cindex file-i/o examples
29291
29292 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
29293 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
29294
29295 @smallexample
29296 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
29297 @emph{request memory read from target}
29298 -> @code{m1234,6}
29299 <- XXXXXX
29300 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
29301 -> @code{F6}
29302 @end smallexample
29303
29304 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
29305 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
29306
29307 @smallexample
29308 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29309 @emph{request memory write to target}
29310 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
29311 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
29312 -> @code{F6}
29313 @end smallexample
29314
29315 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
29316 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
29317
29318 @smallexample
29319 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29320 -> @code{F-1,9}
29321 @end smallexample
29322
29323 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
29324 host is called:
29325
29326 @smallexample
29327 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29328 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
29329 <- @code{T02}
29330 @end smallexample
29331
29332 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
29333 host is called:
29334
29335 @smallexample
29336 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29337 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
29338 <- @code{T02}
29339 @end smallexample
29340
29341 @node Library List Format
29342 @section Library List Format
29343 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
29344
29345 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
29346 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
29347 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
29348 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
29349 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
29350 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
29351 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
29352 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
29353 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
29354 are loaded.
29355
29356 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
29357 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
29358 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
29359 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
29360
29361 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
29362 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
29363 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
29364 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
29365 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
29366 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
29367
29368 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29369 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
29370
29371 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
29372 offset, looks like this:
29373
29374 @smallexample
29375 <library-list>
29376 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
29377 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
29378 </library>
29379 </library-list>
29380 @end smallexample
29381
29382 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
29383 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
29384
29385 @smallexample
29386 <library-list>
29387 <library name="sharedlib.o">
29388 <section address="0x10000000"/>
29389 <section address="0x20000000"/>
29390 <section address="0x30000000"/>
29391 </library>
29392 </library-list>
29393 @end smallexample
29394
29395 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
29399 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
29400 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
29401 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
29402 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
29403 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
29404 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
29405 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
29406 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
29407 @end smallexample
29408
29409 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
29410 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
29411 section for each library.
29412
29413 @node Memory Map Format
29414 @section Memory Map Format
29415 @cindex memory map format
29416
29417 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
29418 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
29419 memory map.
29420
29421 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
29422 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
29423 lists memory regions.
29424
29425 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29426 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
29427
29428 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
29429
29430 @smallexample
29431 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29432 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
29433 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
29434 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
29435 <memory-map>
29436 region...
29437 </memory-map>
29438 @end smallexample
29439
29440 Each region can be either:
29441
29442 @itemize
29443
29444 @item
29445 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
29446 bytes from there:
29447
29448 @smallexample
29449 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
29450 @end smallexample
29451
29452
29453 @item
29454 A region of read-only memory:
29455
29456 @smallexample
29457 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
29458 @end smallexample
29459
29460
29461 @item
29462 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
29463 bytes in length:
29464
29465 @smallexample
29466 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
29467 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
29468 </memory>
29469 @end smallexample
29470
29471 @end itemize
29472
29473 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
29474 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
29475 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
29476
29477 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
29478
29479 @smallexample
29480 <!-- ................................................... -->
29481 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
29482 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
29483 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
29484 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
29485 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
29486 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
29487 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
29488 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
29489 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
29490 and its type, or device. -->
29491 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
29492 start CDATA #REQUIRED
29493 length CDATA #REQUIRED
29494 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
29495 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
29496 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
29497 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
29498 @end smallexample
29499
29500 @include agentexpr.texi
29501
29502 @node Target Descriptions
29503 @appendix Target Descriptions
29504 @cindex target descriptions
29505
29506 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
29507 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
29508 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
29509
29510 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
29511 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
29512 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
29513 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
29514 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
29515 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
29516 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
29517
29518 @itemize @bullet
29519 @item
29520 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
29521 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
29522 @item
29523 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
29524 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
29525 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
29526 @item
29527 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
29528 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
29529 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
29530 @end itemize
29531
29532 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
29533 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
29534 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
29535 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
29536 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
29537
29538 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29539 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
29540
29541 @menu
29542 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
29543 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
29544 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
29545 descriptions.
29546 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
29547 @end menu
29548
29549 @node Retrieving Descriptions
29550 @section Retrieving Descriptions
29551
29552 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
29553 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
29554 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
29555 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
29556 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
29557 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
29558 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
29559 Format}.
29560
29561 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
29562 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
29563 specify a file are:
29564
29565 @table @code
29566 @cindex set tdesc filename
29567 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
29568 Read the target description from @var{path}.
29569
29570 @cindex unset tdesc filename
29571 @item unset tdesc filename
29572 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
29573 will use the description supplied by the current target.
29574
29575 @cindex show tdesc filename
29576 @item show tdesc filename
29577 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
29578 @end table
29579
29580
29581 @node Target Description Format
29582 @section Target Description Format
29583 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
29584
29585 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
29586 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
29587 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
29588 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
29589 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
29590 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
29591 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
29592
29593 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
29594 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
29595 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
29596 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
29597
29598 Here is a simple target description:
29599
29600 @smallexample
29601 <target version="1.0">
29602 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
29603 </target>
29604 @end smallexample
29605
29606 @noindent
29607 This minimal description only says that the target uses
29608 the x86-64 architecture.
29609
29610 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
29611 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
29612 are explained further below.
29613
29614 @smallexample
29615 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29616 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
29617 <target version="1.0">
29618 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
29619 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
29620 </target>
29621 @end smallexample
29622
29623 @noindent
29624 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
29625 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
29626 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
29627 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
29628 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
29629 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
29630 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
29631 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
29632 the version mismatch.
29633
29634 @subsection Inclusion
29635 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
29636 @cindex XInclude
29637 @ifnotinfo
29638 @cindex <xi:include>
29639 @end ifnotinfo
29640
29641 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
29642 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
29643 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
29644 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
29645 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
29646
29647 @smallexample
29648 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
29649 @end smallexample
29650
29651 @noindent
29652 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
29653 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
29654 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
29655 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
29656 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
29657 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
29658 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
29659 original description.
29660
29661 @subsection Architecture
29662 @cindex <architecture>
29663
29664 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
29665
29666 @smallexample
29667 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
29668 @end smallexample
29669
29670 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
29671 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
29672 Debugging Target}).
29673
29674 @subsection Features
29675 @cindex <feature>
29676
29677 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
29678 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
29679 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
29680 has this form:
29681
29682 @smallexample
29683 <feature name="@var{name}">
29684 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
29685 @var{reg}@dots{}
29686 </feature>
29687 @end smallexample
29688
29689 @noindent
29690 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
29691 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
29692 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
29693 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
29694
29695 @subsection Types
29696
29697 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
29698 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
29699 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
29700 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
29701 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
29702
29703 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
29704 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
29705 Types must be defined before they are used.
29706
29707 @cindex <vector>
29708 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
29709 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
29710 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
29711 @var{count}:
29712
29713 @smallexample
29714 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
29715 @end smallexample
29716
29717 @cindex <union>
29718 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
29719 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
29720 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
29721 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
29722
29723 @smallexample
29724 <union id="@var{id}">
29725 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
29726 @dots{}
29727 </union>
29728 @end smallexample
29729
29730 @subsection Registers
29731 @cindex <reg>
29732
29733 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
29734
29735 @smallexample
29736 <reg name="@var{name}"
29737 bitsize="@var{size}"
29738 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
29739 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
29740 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
29741 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
29742 @end smallexample
29743
29744 @noindent
29745 The components are as follows:
29746
29747 @table @var
29748
29749 @item name
29750 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
29751
29752 @item bitsize
29753 The register's size, in bits.
29754
29755 @item regnum
29756 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
29757 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
29758 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
29759 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
29760 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
29761 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
29762 in order of increasing register number.
29763
29764 @item save-restore
29765 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
29766 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
29767 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
29768 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
29769 ABI.
29770
29771 @item type
29772 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
29773 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
29774 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
29775 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
29776 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
29777 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
29778
29779 @item group
29780 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
29781 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
29782 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
29783 in @code{info registers}.
29784
29785 @end table
29786
29787 @node Predefined Target Types
29788 @section Predefined Target Types
29789 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
29790
29791 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
29792 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
29793 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
29794 types. The currently supported types are:
29795
29796 @table @code
29797
29798 @item int8
29799 @itemx int16
29800 @itemx int32
29801 @itemx int64
29802 @itemx int128
29803 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
29804
29805 @item uint8
29806 @itemx uint16
29807 @itemx uint32
29808 @itemx uint64
29809 @itemx uint128
29810 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
29811
29812 @item code_ptr
29813 @itemx data_ptr
29814 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
29815 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
29816 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
29817 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
29818 may be marked as data pointers.
29819
29820 @item ieee_single
29821 Single precision IEEE floating point.
29822
29823 @item ieee_double
29824 Double precision IEEE floating point.
29825
29826 @item arm_fpa_ext
29827 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
29828
29829 @end table
29830
29831 @node Standard Target Features
29832 @section Standard Target Features
29833 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
29834
29835 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
29836 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
29837 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
29838 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
29839 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
29840 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
29841 can recognize them.
29842
29843 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
29844 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
29845 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
29846 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
29847 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
29848 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
29849 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
29850 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
29851
29852 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
29853 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
29854 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
29855
29856 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
29857 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
29858 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
29859 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
29860
29861 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
29862 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
29863 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
29864
29865 @menu
29866 * ARM Features::
29867 * MIPS Features::
29868 * M68K Features::
29869 * PowerPC Features::
29870 @end menu
29871
29872
29873 @node ARM Features
29874 @subsection ARM Features
29875 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
29876
29877 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
29878 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
29879 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
29880
29881 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
29882 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
29883
29884 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
29885 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
29886 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
29887 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
29888
29889 @node MIPS Features
29890 @subsection MIPS Features
29891 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
29892
29893 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
29894 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
29895 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
29896 on the target.
29897
29898 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
29899 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
29900 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29901
29902 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
29903 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
29904 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
29905 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29906
29907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
29908 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
29909 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
29910
29911 @node M68K Features
29912 @subsection M68K Features
29913 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
29914
29915 @table @code
29916 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
29917 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
29918 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
29919 One of those features must be always present.
29920 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
29921 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
29922 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
29923 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
29924
29925 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
29926 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
29927 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
29928 @samp{fpiaddr}.
29929 @end table
29930
29931 @node PowerPC Features
29932 @subsection PowerPC Features
29933 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
29934
29935 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
29936 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
29937 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
29938 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29939
29940 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
29941 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
29942
29943 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
29944 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
29945 and @samp{vrsave}.
29946
29947 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
29948 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
29949 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
29950 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
29951 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
29952 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
29953
29954 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
29955 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
29956 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
29957 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
29958 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
29959 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
29960 user.
29961
29962 @node Operating System Information
29963 @appendix Operating System Information
29964 @cindex operating system information
29965
29966 @menu
29967 * Process list::
29968 @end menu
29969
29970 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
29971 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
29972 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
29973 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
29974 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
29975 on a different aspect of target.
29976
29977 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
29978 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
29979 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
29980 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
29981
29982 @node Process list
29983 @appendixsection Process list
29984 @cindex operating system information, process list
29985
29986 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
29987 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
29988 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
29989 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
29990
29991 An example document is:
29992
29993 @smallexample
29994 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29995 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
29996 <osdata type="processes">
29997 <item>
29998 <column name="pid">1</column>
29999 <column name="user">root</column>
30000 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
30001 </item>
30002 </osdata>
30003 @end smallexample
30004
30005 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
30006 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
30007 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
30008 displayed by @value{GDBN}. Target may provide additional columns,
30009 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
30010
30011 @include gpl.texi
30012
30013 @raisesections
30014 @include fdl.texi
30015 @lowersections
30016
30017 @node Index
30018 @unnumbered Index
30019
30020 @printindex cp
30021
30022 @tex
30023 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
30024 % meantime:
30025 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
30026 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
30027 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
30028 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
30029 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
30030 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
30031 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
30032 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
30033 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
30034 \page\colophon
30035 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
30036 @end tex
30037
30038 @bye
This page took 0.719751 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.